2008-08-20 Craig Silverstein <csilvers@google.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
... / ...
CommitLineData
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
6@c %**start of header
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27@syncodeindex vr cp
28@syncodeindex fn cp
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31@c This is updated by GNU Press.
32@set EDITION Ninth
33
34@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35@set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40@c manuals to an info tree.
41@dircategory Software development
42@direntry
43* Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44@end direntry
45
46@ifinfo
47This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
53@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
54@end ifset
55Version @value{GDBVN}.
56
57Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
58 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
59 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
60
61Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
62under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
63any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
64Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
65Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
66and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
67
68(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
69this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
70developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
71@end ifinfo
72
73@titlepage
74@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
75@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
76@sp 1
77@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
78@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
79@sp 1
80@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
81@end ifset
82@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
83@page
84@tex
85{\parskip=0pt
86\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
87\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
88\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
89}
90@end tex
91
92@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
93Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
941996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
95Free Software Foundation, Inc.
96@sp 2
97Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9851 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
103under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
104any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
105Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
106Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
107and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
108
109(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
110this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
111developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
112@page
113This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
114Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
115software in general. We will miss him.
116@end titlepage
117@page
118
119@ifnottex
120@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
121
122@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
123
124This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
125
126This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
127@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
128@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
129@end ifset
130Version @value{GDBVN}.
131
132Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
133
134This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
135Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
136software in general. We will miss him.
137
138@menu
139* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
140* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
141
142* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
143* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
144* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
145* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
146* Stack:: Examining the stack
147* Source:: Examining source files
148* Data:: Examining data
149* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
150* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
151* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
152
153* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
154
155* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
156* Altering:: Altering execution
157* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
158* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
159* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
160* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
161* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
162* Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
163* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
164* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
165* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
166* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
167* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
168
169* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
170
171* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
172* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
173* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
174* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
175* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
176* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
177* Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
178* Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
179 @value{GDBN}
180* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
181 how you can copy and share GDB
182* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
183* Index:: Index
184@end menu
185
186@end ifnottex
187
188@contents
189
190@node Summary
191@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
192
193The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
194going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
195program was doing at the moment it crashed.
196
197@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
198these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
199
200@itemize @bullet
201@item
202Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
203
204@item
205Make your program stop on specified conditions.
206
207@item
208Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
209
210@item
211Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
212effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
213@end itemize
214
215You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
216For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
217For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
218
219@cindex Modula-2
220Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
221@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
222
223@cindex Pascal
224Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
225nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
226entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
227syntax.
228
229@cindex Fortran
230@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
231it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
232underscore.
233
234@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
235using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
236
237@menu
238* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
239* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
240@end menu
241
242@node Free Software
243@unnumberedsec Free Software
244
245@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
246General Public License
247(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
248program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
249freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
250the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
251Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
252Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
253
254Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
255you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
256from anyone else.
257
258@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
259
260The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
261the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
262include with the free software. Many of our most important
263programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
264texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
265when an important free software package does not come with a free
266manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
267gaps today.
268
269Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
270normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
271authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
272copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
273them from the free software world.
274
275That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
276from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
277manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
278only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
279contract to make it non-free.
280
281Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
282price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
283charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
284Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
285problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
286are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
287modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
288
289The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
290free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
291commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
292accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
293
294Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
295When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
296are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
297provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
298manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
299a changed version of the program is not really available to our
300community.
301
302Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
303acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
304author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
305authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
306to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
307may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
308with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
309are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
310of the manual.
311
312However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
313content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
314media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
315obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
316manual to replace it.
317
318Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
319lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
320free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
321the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
322realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
323the free software community.
324
325If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
326the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
327license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
328don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
329will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
330option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
331what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
332try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
333is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
334
335You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
336manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
337copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
338improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
339at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
340and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
341Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
342have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
343
344The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
345published by other publishers, at
346@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
347
348@node Contributors
349@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
350
351Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
352other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
353development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
354of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
355to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
356file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
357blow-by-blow account.
358
359Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
360
361@quotation
362@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
363or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
364omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
365@end quotation
366
367So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
368particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
369releases:
370Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
371Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
372Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
373Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
374Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
375Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
376John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
377Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
378and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
379
380Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
381Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
382
383Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
384in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
385Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
386demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
387much general update work leading to release 3.0).
388
389@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
390object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
391Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
392
393David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
394the original support for encapsulated COFF.
395
396Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
397
398Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
399Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
400support.
401Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
402Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
403Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
404David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
405Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
406Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
407Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
408Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
409Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
410Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
411Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
412Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
413Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
414Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
415Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
416Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
417
418Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
419
420Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
421libraries.
422
423Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
424about several machine instruction sets.
425
426Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
427remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
428contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
429and RDI targets, respectively.
430
431Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
432command-line editing and command history.
433
434Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
435Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
436
437Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
438He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
439symbols.
440
441Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
442H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
443
444NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
445
446Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
447processors.
448
449Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
450
451Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
452
453Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
454
455Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
456watchpoints.
457
458Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
459
460Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
461
462Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
463nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
464
465The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
466support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
467(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
468compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
469Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
470Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
471provided HP-specific information in this manual.
472
473DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
474Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
475
476Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
477development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
478fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
479Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
480Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
481Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
482Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
483addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
484JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
485Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
486Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
487Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
488Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
489Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
490Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
491
492Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
493Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
494
495Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
496Hat.
497
498Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
499people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
500Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
501Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
502Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
503with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
504
505Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
506unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
507frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
508Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
509libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
510trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
511complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
512Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
513Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
514Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
515Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
516Weigand.
517
518Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
519Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
520who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
521Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
522
523@node Sample Session
524@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
525
526You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
527However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
528debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
529
530@iftex
531In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
532to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
533@end iftex
534
535@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
536@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
537
538One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
539processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
540quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
541definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
542session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
543then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
544same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
545@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
546procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
547
548@smallexample
549$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
550$ @b{./m4}
551@b{define(foo,0000)}
552
553@b{foo}
5540000
555@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
556
557@b{bar}
5580000
559@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
560
561@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
562@b{baz}
563@b{Ctrl-d}
564m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
565@end smallexample
566
567@noindent
568Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
569
570@smallexample
571$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
572@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
573@c FIXME... format to come out better.
574@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
575 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
576 the conditions.
577There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
578 for details.
579
580@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
581(@value{GDBP})
582@end smallexample
583
584@noindent
585@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
586rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
587We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
588that examples fit in this manual.
589
590@smallexample
591(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
592@end smallexample
593
594@noindent
595We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
596Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
597@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
598@code{break} command.
599
600@smallexample
601(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
602Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
603@end smallexample
604
605@noindent
606Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
607control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
608subroutine, the program runs as usual:
609
610@smallexample
611(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
612Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
613@b{define(foo,0000)}
614
615@b{foo}
6160000
617@end smallexample
618
619@noindent
620To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
621suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
622context where it stops.
623
624@smallexample
625@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
626
627Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
628 at builtin.c:879
629879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
630@end smallexample
631
632@noindent
633Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
634the next line of the current function.
635
636@smallexample
637(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
638882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
639 : nil,
640@end smallexample
641
642@noindent
643@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
644by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
645@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
646subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
647
648@smallexample
649(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
650set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
651 at input.c:530
652530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
653@end smallexample
654
655@noindent
656The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
657suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
658shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
659command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
660in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
661stack frame for each active subroutine.
662
663@smallexample
664(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
665#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
666 at input.c:530
667#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
668 at builtin.c:882
669#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
670#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
671 at macro.c:71
672#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
673#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
674@end smallexample
675
676@noindent
677We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
678times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
679falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
680
681@smallexample
682(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6830x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
684(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6850x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
686def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
687(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
688536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
689 : xstrdup(rq);
690(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
691538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
692@end smallexample
693
694@noindent
695The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
696@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
697and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
698(@code{print}) to see their values.
699
700@smallexample
701(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
702$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
703(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
704$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
705@end smallexample
706
707@noindent
708@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
709To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
710surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
711
712@smallexample
713(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
714533 xfree(rquote);
715534
716535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
717 : xstrdup (lq);
718536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
719 : xstrdup (rq);
720537
721538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
722539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
723540 @}
724541
725542 void
726@end smallexample
727
728@noindent
729Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
730@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
731
732@smallexample
733(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
734539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
735(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
736540 @}
737(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
738$3 = 9
739(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
740$4 = 7
741@end smallexample
742
743@noindent
744That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
745@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
746@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
747the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
748any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
749assignments.
750
751@smallexample
752(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
753$5 = 7
754(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
755$6 = 9
756@end smallexample
757
758@noindent
759Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
760@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
761executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
762example that caused trouble initially:
763
764@smallexample
765(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
766Continuing.
767
768@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
769
770baz
7710000
772@end smallexample
773
774@noindent
775Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
776problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
777lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
778
779@smallexample
780@b{Ctrl-d}
781Program exited normally.
782@end smallexample
783
784@noindent
785The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
786indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
787session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
788
789@smallexample
790(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
791@end smallexample
792
793@node Invocation
794@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
795
796This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
797The essentials are:
798@itemize @bullet
799@item
800type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
801@item
802type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
803@end itemize
804
805@menu
806* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
807* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
808* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
809* Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
810@end menu
811
812@node Invoking GDB
813@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
814
815Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
816@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
817
818You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
819to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
820
821The command-line options described here are designed
822to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
823options may effectively be unavailable.
824
825The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
826specifying an executable program:
827
828@smallexample
829@value{GDBP} @var{program}
830@end smallexample
831
832@noindent
833You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
834specified:
835
836@smallexample
837@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
838@end smallexample
839
840You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
841to debug a running process:
842
843@smallexample
844@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
845@end smallexample
846
847@noindent
848would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
849named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
850
851Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
852complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
853debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
854``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
855will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
856
857You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
858executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
859option processing.
860@smallexample
861@value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
862@end smallexample
863This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
864@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
865
866You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
867@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
868
869@smallexample
870@value{GDBP} -silent
871@end smallexample
872
873@noindent
874You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
875options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
876
877@noindent
878Type
879
880@smallexample
881@value{GDBP} -help
882@end smallexample
883
884@noindent
885to display all available options and briefly describe their use
886(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
887
888All options and command line arguments you give are processed
889in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
890@samp{-x} option is used.
891
892
893@menu
894* File Options:: Choosing files
895* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
896* Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
897@end menu
898
899@node File Options
900@subsection Choosing Files
901
902When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
903specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
904the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
905@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
906first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
907equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
908second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
909equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
910If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
911first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
912to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
913a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
914prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
915
916If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
917such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
918argument and ignore it.
919
920Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
921following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
922them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
923(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
924than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
925
926@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
927@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
928@c it.
929
930@table @code
931@item -symbols @var{file}
932@itemx -s @var{file}
933@cindex @code{--symbols}
934@cindex @code{-s}
935Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
936
937@item -exec @var{file}
938@itemx -e @var{file}
939@cindex @code{--exec}
940@cindex @code{-e}
941Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
942and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
943
944@item -se @var{file}
945@cindex @code{--se}
946Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
947file.
948
949@item -core @var{file}
950@itemx -c @var{file}
951@cindex @code{--core}
952@cindex @code{-c}
953Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
954
955@item -pid @var{number}
956@itemx -p @var{number}
957@cindex @code{--pid}
958@cindex @code{-p}
959Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
960
961@item -command @var{file}
962@itemx -x @var{file}
963@cindex @code{--command}
964@cindex @code{-x}
965Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
966Files,, Command files}.
967
968@item -eval-command @var{command}
969@itemx -ex @var{command}
970@cindex @code{--eval-command}
971@cindex @code{-ex}
972Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
973
974This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
975also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
976
977@smallexample
978@value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
979 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
980@end smallexample
981
982@item -directory @var{directory}
983@itemx -d @var{directory}
984@cindex @code{--directory}
985@cindex @code{-d}
986Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
987
988@item -r
989@itemx -readnow
990@cindex @code{--readnow}
991@cindex @code{-r}
992Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
993the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
994This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
995
996@end table
997
998@node Mode Options
999@subsection Choosing Modes
1000
1001You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1002batch mode or quiet mode.
1003
1004@table @code
1005@item -nx
1006@itemx -n
1007@cindex @code{--nx}
1008@cindex @code{-n}
1009Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1010@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1011options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1012Files}.
1013
1014@item -quiet
1015@itemx -silent
1016@itemx -q
1017@cindex @code{--quiet}
1018@cindex @code{--silent}
1019@cindex @code{-q}
1020``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1021messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1022
1023@item -batch
1024@cindex @code{--batch}
1025Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1026command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1027initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1028nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1029in the command files.
1030
1031Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1032example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1033make this more useful, the message
1034
1035@smallexample
1036Program exited normally.
1037@end smallexample
1038
1039@noindent
1040(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1041@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1042mode.
1043
1044@item -batch-silent
1045@cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1046Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1047@value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1048unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1049for an interactive session.
1050
1051This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1052messages, for example.
1053
1054Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1055writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1056
1057@item -return-child-result
1058@cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1059The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1060process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1061
1062@itemize @bullet
1063@item
1064@value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1065internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1066without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1067@item
1068The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1069@item
1070The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1071the exit code will be -1.
1072@end itemize
1073
1074This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1075when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1076interface.
1077
1078@item -nowindows
1079@itemx -nw
1080@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1081@cindex @code{-nw}
1082``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1083(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1084interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1085
1086@item -windows
1087@itemx -w
1088@cindex @code{--windows}
1089@cindex @code{-w}
1090If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1091used if possible.
1092
1093@item -cd @var{directory}
1094@cindex @code{--cd}
1095Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1096instead of the current directory.
1097
1098@item -fullname
1099@itemx -f
1100@cindex @code{--fullname}
1101@cindex @code{-f}
1102@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1103subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1104number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1105displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1106recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1107the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1108and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1109@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1110frame.
1111
1112@item -epoch
1113@cindex @code{--epoch}
1114The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1115@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1116routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1117separate window.
1118
1119@item -annotate @var{level}
1120@cindex @code{--annotate}
1121This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1122effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1123(@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1124information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1125expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1126normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1127@sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1128that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1129
1130The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1131(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1132
1133@item --args
1134@cindex @code{--args}
1135Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1136executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1137This option stops option processing.
1138
1139@item -baud @var{bps}
1140@itemx -b @var{bps}
1141@cindex @code{--baud}
1142@cindex @code{-b}
1143Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1144interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1145
1146@item -l @var{timeout}
1147@cindex @code{-l}
1148Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1149for remote debugging.
1150
1151@item -tty @var{device}
1152@itemx -t @var{device}
1153@cindex @code{--tty}
1154@cindex @code{-t}
1155Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1156@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1157
1158@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1159@item -tui
1160@cindex @code{--tui}
1161Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1162Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1163source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1164(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1165Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1166@samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1167Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1168
1169@c @item -xdb
1170@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1171@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1172@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1173@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1174@c systems.
1175
1176@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1177@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1178Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1179program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1180communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1181@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1182
1183@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1184@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1185The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1186previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1187selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1188@sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1189
1190@item -write
1191@cindex @code{--write}
1192Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1193is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1194(@pxref{Patching}).
1195
1196@item -statistics
1197@cindex @code{--statistics}
1198This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1199memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1200
1201@item -version
1202@cindex @code{--version}
1203This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1204no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1205
1206@end table
1207
1208@node Startup
1209@subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1210@cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1211
1212Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1213
1214@enumerate
1215@item
1216Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1217(@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1218
1219@item
1220@cindex init file
1221Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1222DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1223@code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1224that file.
1225
1226@item
1227Processes command line options and operands.
1228
1229@item
1230Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1231working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1232different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1233init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1234to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1235@value{GDBN}.
1236
1237@item
1238Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1239Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1240
1241@item
1242Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1243@xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1244files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1245@end enumerate
1246
1247Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1248Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1249file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1250complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1251and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1252option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1253
1254@cindex init file name
1255@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1256@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1257The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1258The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1259the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1260ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1261@file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1262the file to the standard name.
1263
1264
1265@node Quitting GDB
1266@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1267@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1268@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1269
1270@table @code
1271@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1272@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1273@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1274@itemx q
1275To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1276@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1277do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1278otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1279error code.
1280@end table
1281
1282@cindex interrupt
1283An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1284terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1285returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1286character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1287until a time when it is safe.
1288
1289If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1290device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1291(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1292
1293@node Shell Commands
1294@section Shell Commands
1295
1296If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1297debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1298just use the @code{shell} command.
1299
1300@table @code
1301@kindex shell
1302@cindex shell escape
1303@item shell @var{command string}
1304Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1305If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1306shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1307(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1308@end table
1309
1310The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1311You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1312@value{GDBN}:
1313
1314@table @code
1315@kindex make
1316@cindex calling make
1317@item make @var{make-args}
1318Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1319arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1320@end table
1321
1322@node Logging Output
1323@section Logging Output
1324@cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1325@cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1326
1327You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1328There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1329
1330@table @code
1331@kindex set logging
1332@item set logging on
1333Enable logging.
1334@item set logging off
1335Disable logging.
1336@cindex logging file name
1337@item set logging file @var{file}
1338Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1339@item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1340By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1341you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1342@item set logging redirect [on|off]
1343By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1344Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1345@kindex show logging
1346@item show logging
1347Show the current values of the logging settings.
1348@end table
1349
1350@node Commands
1351@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1352
1353You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1354name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1355@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1356key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1357show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1358
1359@menu
1360* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1361* Completion:: Command completion
1362* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1363@end menu
1364
1365@node Command Syntax
1366@section Command Syntax
1367
1368A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1369how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1370arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1371command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1372step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1373with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1374
1375@cindex abbreviation
1376@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1377unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1378documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1379abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1380equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1381names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1382arguments to the @code{help} command.
1383
1384@cindex repeating commands
1385@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1386A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1387repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1388will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1389repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1390repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1391@ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1392
1393The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1394@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1395exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1396
1397@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1398output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1399(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1400@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1401repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1402
1403@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1404@cindex comment
1405Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1406nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1407Files,,Command Files}).
1408
1409@cindex repeating command sequences
1410@kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1411The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1412commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1413then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1414for editing.
1415
1416@node Completion
1417@section Command Completion
1418
1419@cindex completion
1420@cindex word completion
1421@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1422only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1423are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1424commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1425
1426Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1427of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1428word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1429enter it). For example, if you type
1430
1431@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1432@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1433@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1434@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1435@smallexample
1436(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1437@end smallexample
1438
1439@noindent
1440@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1441the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1442
1443@smallexample
1444(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1445@end smallexample
1446
1447@noindent
1448You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1449breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1450@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1451were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1452might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1453to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1454
1455If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1456@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1457characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1458@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1459example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1460begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1461just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1462function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1463example:
1464
1465@smallexample
1466(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1467@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1468make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1469make_abs_section make_function_type
1470make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1471make_cleanup make_reference_type
1472make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1473(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1474@end smallexample
1475
1476@noindent
1477After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1478partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1479command.
1480
1481If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1482can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1483means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1484key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1485one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1486
1487@cindex quotes in commands
1488@cindex completion of quoted strings
1489Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1490parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1491its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1492situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1493@value{GDBN} commands.
1494
1495The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1496name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1497overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1498by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1499may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1500that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1501that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1502word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1503@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1504@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1505when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1506
1507@smallexample
1508(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1509bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1510(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1511@end smallexample
1512
1513In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1514quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1515completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1516place:
1517
1518@smallexample
1519(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1520@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1521(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1522@end smallexample
1523
1524@noindent
1525In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1526you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1527completion on an overloaded symbol.
1528
1529For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1530Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1531overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1532see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1533
1534@cindex completion of structure field names
1535@cindex structure field name completion
1536@cindex completion of union field names
1537@cindex union field name completion
1538When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1539structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1540confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1541examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1542limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1543left-hand-side:
1544
1545@smallexample
1546(@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1547magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1548to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1549@end smallexample
1550
1551@noindent
1552This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1553@code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1554follows:
1555
1556@smallexample
1557struct ui_file
1558@{
1559 int *magic;
1560 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1561 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1562 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1563 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1564 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1565 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1566 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1567 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1568 void *to_data;
1569@}
1570@end smallexample
1571
1572
1573@node Help
1574@section Getting Help
1575@cindex online documentation
1576@kindex help
1577
1578You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1579using the command @code{help}.
1580
1581@table @code
1582@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1583@item help
1584@itemx h
1585You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1586display a short list of named classes of commands:
1587
1588@smallexample
1589(@value{GDBP}) help
1590List of classes of commands:
1591
1592aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1593breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1594data -- Examining data
1595files -- Specifying and examining files
1596internals -- Maintenance commands
1597obscure -- Obscure features
1598running -- Running the program
1599stack -- Examining the stack
1600status -- Status inquiries
1601support -- Support facilities
1602tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1603 stopping the program
1604user-defined -- User-defined commands
1605
1606Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1607commands in that class.
1608Type "help" followed by command name for full
1609documentation.
1610Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1611(@value{GDBP})
1612@end smallexample
1613@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1614
1615@item help @var{class}
1616Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1617list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1618help display for the class @code{status}:
1619
1620@smallexample
1621(@value{GDBP}) help status
1622Status inquiries.
1623
1624List of commands:
1625
1626@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1627@c to fit in smallbook page size.
1628info -- Generic command for showing things
1629 about the program being debugged
1630show -- Generic command for showing things
1631 about the debugger
1632
1633Type "help" followed by command name for full
1634documentation.
1635Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1636(@value{GDBP})
1637@end smallexample
1638
1639@item help @var{command}
1640With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1641short paragraph on how to use that command.
1642
1643@kindex apropos
1644@item apropos @var{args}
1645The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1646commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1647@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1648
1649@smallexample
1650apropos reload
1651@end smallexample
1652
1653@noindent
1654results in:
1655
1656@smallexample
1657@c @group
1658set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1659 multiple times in one run
1660show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1661 multiple times in one run
1662@c @end group
1663@end smallexample
1664
1665@kindex complete
1666@item complete @var{args}
1667The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1668for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1669command you want completed. For example:
1670
1671@smallexample
1672complete i
1673@end smallexample
1674
1675@noindent results in:
1676
1677@smallexample
1678@group
1679if
1680ignore
1681info
1682inspect
1683@end group
1684@end smallexample
1685
1686@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1687@end table
1688
1689In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1690and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1691of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1692manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1693under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1694all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1695
1696@c @group
1697@table @code
1698@kindex info
1699@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1700@item info
1701This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1702program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1703with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1704registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1705You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1706@w{@code{help info}}.
1707
1708@kindex set
1709@item set
1710You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1711@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1712@code{set prompt $}.
1713
1714@kindex show
1715@item show
1716In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1717@value{GDBN} itself.
1718You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1719related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1720system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1721which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1722
1723@kindex info set
1724To display all the settable parameters and their current
1725values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1726@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1727@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1728@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1729@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1730@end table
1731@c @end group
1732
1733Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1734exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1735
1736@table @code
1737@kindex show version
1738@cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1739@item show version
1740Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1741information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1742@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1743version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1744commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1745system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1746variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1747The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1748@value{GDBN}.
1749
1750@kindex show copying
1751@kindex info copying
1752@cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1753@item show copying
1754@itemx info copying
1755Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1756
1757@kindex show warranty
1758@kindex info warranty
1759@item show warranty
1760@itemx info warranty
1761Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1762if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1763
1764@end table
1765
1766@node Running
1767@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1768
1769When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1770debugging information when you compile it.
1771
1772You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1773of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1774your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1775kill a child process.
1776
1777@menu
1778* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1779* Starting:: Starting your program
1780* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1781* Environment:: Your program's environment
1782
1783* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1784* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1785* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1786* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1787
1788* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1789* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1790* Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1791@end menu
1792
1793@node Compilation
1794@section Compiling for Debugging
1795
1796In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1797debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1798is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1799variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1800and addresses in the executable code.
1801
1802To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1803the compiler.
1804
1805Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1806optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1807compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1808together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1809executables containing debugging information.
1810
1811@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1812without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1813recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1814program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1815in pushing your luck.
1816
1817@cindex optimized code, debugging
1818@cindex debugging optimized code
1819When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1820optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1821really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1822exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1823variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1824variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1825
1826Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1827@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1828doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1829please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1830@xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1831
1832Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1833@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1834format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1835
1836@value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1837expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1838about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1839the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1840Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1841provides macro information if you specify the options
1842@option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1843debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1844``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1845ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1846@option{-g} alone.
1847
1848@need 2000
1849@node Starting
1850@section Starting your Program
1851@cindex starting
1852@cindex running
1853
1854@table @code
1855@kindex run
1856@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1857@item run
1858@itemx r
1859Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1860You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1861argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1862@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1863(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1864
1865@end table
1866
1867If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1868supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1869that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1870@code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1871like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1872message like this one:
1873
1874@smallexample
1875The "remote" target does not support "run".
1876Try "help target" or "continue".
1877@end smallexample
1878
1879@noindent
1880then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1881first (@pxref{load}).
1882
1883The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1884receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1885information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1886can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1887your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1888divided into four categories:
1889
1890@table @asis
1891@item The @emph{arguments.}
1892Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1893@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1894is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1895(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1896the arguments.
1897In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1898@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1899@xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1900
1901@item The @emph{environment.}
1902Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1903use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1904environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1905your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1906
1907@item The @emph{working directory.}
1908Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1909the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1910@xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1911
1912@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1913Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1914standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1915in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1916set a different device for your program.
1917@xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1918
1919@cindex pipes
1920@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1921pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1922program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1923wrong program.
1924@end table
1925
1926When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1927immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1928of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1929stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1930or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1931
1932If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1933time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1934table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1935your current breakpoints.
1936
1937@table @code
1938@kindex start
1939@item start
1940@cindex run to main procedure
1941The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1942With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1943other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1944main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1945execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1946procedure, depending on the language used.
1947
1948The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1949breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1950the @samp{run} command.
1951
1952@cindex elaboration phase
1953Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1954executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1955languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1956constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1957@code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1958before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1959will remain to halt execution.
1960
1961Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1962@samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1963underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1964reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1965@samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1966
1967It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1968these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1969your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1970elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1971elaboration code before running your program.
1972
1973@kindex set exec-wrapper
1974@item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1975@itemx show exec-wrapper
1976@itemx unset exec-wrapper
1977When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1978launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1979with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1980@var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1981arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1982appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1983your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1984
1985You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1986its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1987this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1988with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1989
1990For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1991the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1992environment:
1993
1994@smallexample
1995(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1996(@value{GDBP}) run
1997@end smallexample
1998
1999This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2000@sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2001
2002@kindex set disable-randomization
2003@item set disable-randomization
2004@itemx set disable-randomization on
2005This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2006randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2007is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2008reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2009
2010This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2011behavior using
2012
2013@smallexample
2014(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2015@end smallexample
2016
2017@item set disable-randomization off
2018Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2019ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2020disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2021@value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2022as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2023disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2024
2025The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2026It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2027cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2028code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2029a code at its expected addresses.
2030
2031Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2032makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2033having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2034library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2035misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2036random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2037startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2038a randomly chosen address.
2039
2040Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2041similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2042a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2043already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2044executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2045
2046Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2047(as long as the randomization is enabled).
2048
2049@item show disable-randomization
2050Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2051the virtual address space of the started program.
2052
2053@end table
2054
2055@node Arguments
2056@section Your Program's Arguments
2057
2058@cindex arguments (to your program)
2059The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2060@code{run} command.
2061They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2062performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2063@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2064@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2065the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2066
2067On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2068@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2069calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2070the program, not by the shell.
2071
2072@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2073@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2074
2075@table @code
2076@kindex set args
2077@item set args
2078Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2079@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2080with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2081using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2082it again without arguments.
2083
2084@kindex show args
2085@item show args
2086Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2087@end table
2088
2089@node Environment
2090@section Your Program's Environment
2091
2092@cindex environment (of your program)
2093The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2094their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2095your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2096path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2097the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2098debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2099environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2100
2101@table @code
2102@kindex path
2103@item path @var{directory}
2104Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2105(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2106The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2107You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2108system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2109MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2110is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2111
2112You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2113working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2114use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2115@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2116@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2117@var{directory} to the search path.
2118@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2119@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2120
2121@kindex show paths
2122@item show paths
2123Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2124environment variable).
2125
2126@kindex show environment
2127@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2128Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2129your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2130print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2131your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2132
2133@kindex set environment
2134@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2135Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2136changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2137be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2138any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2139parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2140null value.
2141@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2142@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2143
2144For example, this command:
2145
2146@smallexample
2147set env USER = foo
2148@end smallexample
2149
2150@noindent
2151tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2152@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2153are not actually required.)
2154
2155@kindex unset environment
2156@item unset environment @var{varname}
2157Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2158program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2159@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2160rather than assigning it an empty value.
2161@end table
2162
2163@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2164the shell indicated
2165by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2166@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2167that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2168@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2169your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2170files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2171@file{.profile}.
2172
2173@node Working Directory
2174@section Your Program's Working Directory
2175
2176@cindex working directory (of your program)
2177Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2178working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2179The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2180from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2181working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2182
2183The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2184that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2185Specify Files}.
2186
2187@table @code
2188@kindex cd
2189@cindex change working directory
2190@item cd @var{directory}
2191Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2192
2193@kindex pwd
2194@item pwd
2195Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2196@end table
2197
2198It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2199the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2200during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2201configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2202proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2203current working directory of the debuggee.
2204
2205@node Input/Output
2206@section Your Program's Input and Output
2207
2208@cindex redirection
2209@cindex i/o
2210@cindex terminal
2211By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2212the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2213to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2214modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2215running your program.
2216
2217@table @code
2218@kindex info terminal
2219@item info terminal
2220Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2221program is using.
2222@end table
2223
2224You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2225redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2226
2227@smallexample
2228run > outfile
2229@end smallexample
2230
2231@noindent
2232starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2233
2234@kindex tty
2235@cindex controlling terminal
2236Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2237with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2238argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2239commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2240process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2241
2242@smallexample
2243tty /dev/ttyb
2244@end smallexample
2245
2246@noindent
2247directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2248default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2249that as their controlling terminal.
2250
2251An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2252effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2253terminal.
2254
2255When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2256command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2257for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2258for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2259
2260@cindex inferior tty
2261@cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2262You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2263display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2264program.
2265
2266@table @code
2267@item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2268@kindex set inferior-tty
2269Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2270
2271@item show inferior-tty
2272@kindex show inferior-tty
2273Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2274@end table
2275
2276@node Attach
2277@section Debugging an Already-running Process
2278@kindex attach
2279@cindex attach
2280
2281@table @code
2282@item attach @var{process-id}
2283This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2284outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2285targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2286find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2287or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2288
2289@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2290executing the command.
2291@end table
2292
2293To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2294which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2295programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2296also have permission to send the process a signal.
2297
2298When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2299the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2300the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2301(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2302the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2303Specify Files}.
2304
2305The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2306process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2307with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2308you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2309can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2310process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2311attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2312
2313@table @code
2314@kindex detach
2315@item detach
2316When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2317@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2318the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2319that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2320are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2321@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2322executing the command.
2323@end table
2324
2325If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2326that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2327By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2328things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2329@code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2330Messages}).
2331
2332@node Kill Process
2333@section Killing the Child Process
2334
2335@table @code
2336@kindex kill
2337@item kill
2338Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2339@end table
2340
2341This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2342running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2343is running.
2344
2345On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2346while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2347@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2348outside the debugger.
2349
2350The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2351relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2352executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2353next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2354reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2355breakpoint settings).
2356
2357@node Threads
2358@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2359
2360@cindex threads of execution
2361@cindex multiple threads
2362@cindex switching threads
2363In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2364may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2365of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2366the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2367that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2368modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2369registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2370
2371@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2372programs:
2373
2374@itemize @bullet
2375@item automatic notification of new threads
2376@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2377@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2378@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2379a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2380@item thread-specific breakpoints
2381@item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2382messages on thread start and exit.
2383@end itemize
2384
2385@quotation
2386@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2387@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2388If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2389effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2390from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2391like this:
2392
2393@smallexample
2394(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2395(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2396Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2397see the IDs of currently known threads.
2398@end smallexample
2399@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2400@c doesn't support threads"?
2401@end quotation
2402
2403@cindex focus of debugging
2404@cindex current thread
2405The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2406threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2407control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2408This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2409program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2410
2411@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2412@cindex thread identifier (system)
2413@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2414@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2415@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2416Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2417the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2418form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2419whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2420@sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2421
2422@smallexample
2423[New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2424@end smallexample
2425
2426@noindent
2427when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2428the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2429further qualifier.
2430
2431@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2432@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2433@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2434@c program?
2435@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2436@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2437@c threads ab initio?
2438
2439@cindex thread number
2440@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2441For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2442number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2443
2444@table @code
2445@kindex info threads
2446@item info threads
2447Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2448program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2449
2450@enumerate
2451@item
2452the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2453
2454@item
2455the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2456
2457@item
2458the current stack frame summary for that thread
2459@end enumerate
2460
2461@noindent
2462An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2463indicates the current thread.
2464
2465For example,
2466@end table
2467@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2468
2469@smallexample
2470(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2471 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2472 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2473* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2474 at threadtest.c:68
2475@end smallexample
2476
2477On HP-UX systems:
2478
2479@cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2480@cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2481For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2482number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2483thread in your program.
2484
2485@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2486@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2487@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2488@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2489@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2490Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2491both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2492form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2493whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2494HP-UX, you see
2495
2496@smallexample
2497[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2498@end smallexample
2499
2500@noindent
2501when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2502
2503@table @code
2504@kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2505@item info threads
2506Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2507program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2508
2509@enumerate
2510@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2511
2512@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2513
2514@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2515@end enumerate
2516
2517@noindent
2518An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2519indicates the current thread.
2520
2521For example,
2522@end table
2523@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2524
2525@smallexample
2526(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2527 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2528 at quicksort.c:137
2529 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2530 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2531 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2532 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2533@end smallexample
2534
2535On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2536Solaris-specific command:
2537
2538@table @code
2539@item maint info sol-threads
2540@kindex maint info sol-threads
2541@cindex thread info (Solaris)
2542Display info on Solaris user threads.
2543@end table
2544
2545@table @code
2546@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2547@item thread @var{threadno}
2548Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2549argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2550shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2551@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2552you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2553
2554@smallexample
2555@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2556(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2557[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
25580x34e5 in sigpause ()
2559@end smallexample
2560
2561@noindent
2562As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2563@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2564threads.
2565
2566@kindex thread apply
2567@cindex apply command to several threads
2568@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2569The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2570@var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2571threads that you want affected with the command argument
2572@var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2573shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2574could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2575command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2576
2577@kindex set print thread-events
2578@cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2579@item set print thread-events
2580@itemx set print thread-events on
2581@itemx set print thread-events off
2582The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2583disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2584started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2585be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2586Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2587
2588@kindex show print thread-events
2589@item show print thread-events
2590Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2591have started and exited.
2592@end table
2593
2594@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2595more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2596programs with multiple threads.
2597
2598@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2599watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2600
2601@node Processes
2602@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2603
2604@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2605@cindex multiple processes
2606@cindex processes, multiple
2607On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2608programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2609function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2610parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2611set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2612will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2613will cause it to terminate.
2614
2615However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2616which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2617the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2618only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2619so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2620on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2621get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2622@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2623the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2624the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2625
2626On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2627create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2628Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2629only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2630
2631By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2632the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2633
2634If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2635use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2636
2637@table @code
2638@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2639@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2640Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2641@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2642process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2643
2644@table @code
2645@item parent
2646The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2647unimpeded. This is the default.
2648
2649@item child
2650The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2651unimpeded.
2652
2653@end table
2654
2655@kindex show follow-fork-mode
2656@item show follow-fork-mode
2657Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2658@end table
2659
2660@cindex debugging multiple processes
2661On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2662command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2663
2664@table @code
2665@kindex set detach-on-fork
2666@item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2667Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2668retain debugger control over them both.
2669
2670@table @code
2671@item on
2672The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2673@code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2674independently. This is the default.
2675
2676@item off
2677Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2678One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2679@code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2680is held suspended.
2681
2682@end table
2683
2684@kindex show detach-on-fork
2685@item show detach-on-fork
2686Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2687@end table
2688
2689If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2690@value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2691nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2692@value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2693from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2694
2695@table @code
2696@kindex info forks
2697@item info forks
2698Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2699The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2700position (program counter) of the process.
2701
2702@kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2703@item fork @var{fork-id}
2704Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2705@var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2706as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2707
2708@kindex process @var{process-id}
2709@item process @var{process-id}
2710Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2711argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2712@samp{info forks}.
2713
2714@end table
2715
2716To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2717from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2718run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2719@w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2720
2721@table @code
2722@kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2723@item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2724Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2725@var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2726allowed to run independently.
2727
2728@kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2729@item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2730Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2731and remove it from the fork list.
2732
2733@end table
2734
2735If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2736@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2737breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2738@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2739the child process's @code{main}.
2740
2741When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2742child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2743
2744If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2745call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2746use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2747argument.
2748
2749You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2750a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2751Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2752
2753@node Checkpoint/Restart
2754@section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2755
2756@cindex checkpoint
2757@cindex restart
2758@cindex bookmark
2759@cindex snapshot of a process
2760@cindex rewind program state
2761
2762On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2763@sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2764program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2765later.
2766
2767Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2768happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2769includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2770system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2771moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2772
2773Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2774getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2775a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2776the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2777from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2778start again from there.
2779
2780This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2781steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2782
2783To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2784
2785@table @code
2786@kindex checkpoint
2787@item checkpoint
2788Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2789The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2790is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2791
2792@kindex info checkpoints
2793@item info checkpoints
2794List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2795session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2796listed:
2797
2798@table @code
2799@item Checkpoint ID
2800@item Process ID
2801@item Code Address
2802@item Source line, or label
2803@end table
2804
2805@kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2806@item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2807Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2808@var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2809etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2810was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2811in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2812
2813Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2814are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2815only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2816the debugger.
2817
2818@kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2819@item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2820Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2821
2822@end table
2823
2824Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2825of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2826(OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2827a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2828so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2829opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2830previously read data can be read again.
2831
2832Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2833external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2834from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2835but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2836be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2837been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2838
2839However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2840program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2841again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2842different execution path this time.
2843
2844@cindex checkpoints and process id
2845Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2846different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2847id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2848and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2849If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2850potentially pose a problem.
2851
2852@subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2853
2854On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2855is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2856difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2857absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2858absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2859next.
2860
2861A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2862Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2863and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2864process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2865your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2866
2867@node Stopping
2868@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2869
2870The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2871program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2872trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2873
2874Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2875such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2876@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2877change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2878continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2879ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2880explicitly request this information at any time.
2881
2882@table @code
2883@kindex info program
2884@item info program
2885Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2886running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2887@end table
2888
2889@menu
2890* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2891* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2892* Signals:: Signals
2893* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2894@end menu
2895
2896@node Breakpoints
2897@section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2898
2899@cindex breakpoints
2900A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2901the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2902control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2903breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2904Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2905should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2906program.
2907
2908On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2909the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2910you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2911in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2912(for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2913call).
2914
2915@cindex watchpoints
2916@cindex data breakpoints
2917@cindex memory tracing
2918@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2919@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2920A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2921when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2922of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2923combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2924@dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2925watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2926from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2927enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2928same commands.
2929
2930You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2931whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2932Automatic Display}.
2933
2934@cindex catchpoints
2935@cindex breakpoint on events
2936A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2937when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2938exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2939different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2940Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2941other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2942@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2943
2944@cindex breakpoint numbers
2945@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2946@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2947catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2948starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2949features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2950breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2951@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2952enable it again.
2953
2954@cindex breakpoint ranges
2955@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2956Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2957operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2958@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2959hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2960all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2961
2962@menu
2963* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2964* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2965* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2966* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2967* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2968* Conditions:: Break conditions
2969* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2970* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2971* Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2972@end menu
2973
2974@node Set Breaks
2975@subsection Setting Breakpoints
2976
2977@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2978@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2979@c
2980@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2981
2982@kindex break
2983@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2984@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2985@cindex latest breakpoint
2986Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2987@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2988number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2989Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2990convenience variables.
2991
2992@table @code
2993@item break @var{location}
2994Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
2995function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
2996(@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
2997specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
2998before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
2999
3000When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3001C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3002@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3003that situation.
3004
3005@item break
3006When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3007the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3008(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3009innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3010returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3011@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3012that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3013@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3014the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3015inside loops.
3016
3017@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3018least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3019would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3020breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3021existed when your program stopped.
3022
3023@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3024Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3025@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3026value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3027@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3028above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3029,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3030
3031@kindex tbreak
3032@item tbreak @var{args}
3033Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3034same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3035way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3036program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3037
3038@kindex hbreak
3039@cindex hardware breakpoints
3040@item hbreak @var{args}
3041Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3042@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3043breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3044have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3045debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3046changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3047provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3048will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3049address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3050breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3051example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3052@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3053or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3054(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3055@xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3056For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3057breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3058hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3059
3060@kindex thbreak
3061@item thbreak @var{args}
3062Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3063are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3064the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3065the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3066first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3067command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3068may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3069See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3070
3071@kindex rbreak
3072@cindex regular expression
3073@cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3074@cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3075@item rbreak @var{regex}
3076Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3077@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3078matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3079breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3080the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3081them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3082
3083The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3084like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3085shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3086an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3087@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3088match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3089
3090@cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3091When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3092breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3093classes.
3094
3095@cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3096The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3097@strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3098
3099@smallexample
3100(@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3101@end smallexample
3102
3103@kindex info breakpoints
3104@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3105@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3106@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3107@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3108Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3109not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3110about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3111each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3112
3113@table @emph
3114@item Breakpoint Numbers
3115@item Type
3116Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3117@item Disposition
3118Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3119@item Enabled or Disabled
3120Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3121that are not enabled.
3122@item Address
3123Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3124pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3125contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3126library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3127See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3128have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3129@item What
3130Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3131line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3132the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3133the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3134@end table
3135
3136@noindent
3137If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3138the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3139are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3140specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3141library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3142valid location.
3143
3144@noindent
3145@code{info break} with a breakpoint
3146number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3147convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3148the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3149listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3150
3151@noindent
3152@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3153has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3154@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3155hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3156was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3157will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3158@end table
3159
3160@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3161your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3162the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3163(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3164
3165@cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3166@cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3167It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3168in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3169
3170@itemize @bullet
3171@item
3172For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3173instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3174
3175@item
3176For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3177correspond to any number of instantiations.
3178
3179@item
3180For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3181several places where that function is inlined.
3182@end itemize
3183
3184In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3185the relevant locations@footnote{
3186As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3187line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3188will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3189info with line numbers for them.}.
3190
3191A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3192table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3193each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3194address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3195addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3196locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3197@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3198
3199For example:
3200
3201@smallexample
3202Num Type Disp Enb Address What
32031 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3204 stop only if i==1
3205 breakpoint already hit 1 time
32061.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
32071.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3208@end smallexample
3209
3210Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3211@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3212@code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3213delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3214entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3215the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3216the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3217the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3218that belong to that breakpoint.
3219
3220@cindex pending breakpoints
3221It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3222Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3223and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3224this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3225any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3226set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3227debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3228symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3229breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3230a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3231is not yet resolved.
3232
3233After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3234@value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3235shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3236pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3237ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3238that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3239
3240This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3241example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3242a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3243a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3244
3245Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3246differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3247enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3248
3249@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3250happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3251address specification to an address:
3252
3253@kindex set breakpoint pending
3254@kindex show breakpoint pending
3255@table @code
3256@item set breakpoint pending auto
3257This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3258location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3259
3260@item set breakpoint pending on
3261This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3262result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3263
3264@item set breakpoint pending off
3265This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3266unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3267not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3268
3269@item show breakpoint pending
3270Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3271@end table
3272
3273The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3274variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3275as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3276
3277@cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3278For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3279software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3280breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3281breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3282breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3283breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3284breakpoints.
3285
3286You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3287
3288@kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3289@kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3290@table @code
3291@item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3292This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3293will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3294breakpoint must be used.
3295
3296@item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3297This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3298type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3299trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3300@end table
3301
3302@value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3303at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3304executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3305code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3306the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3307behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3308target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3309targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3310This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3311
3312@kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3313@kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3314@table @code
3315@item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3316All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3317the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3318removed from the target when it stops.
3319
3320@item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3321Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3322the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3323breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3324removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3325
3326@cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3327@item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3328This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3329in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3330@code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3331controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3332@code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3333@end table
3334
3335@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3336@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3337@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3338special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3339programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3340starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3341You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3342@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3343
3344
3345@node Set Watchpoints
3346@subsection Setting Watchpoints
3347
3348@cindex setting watchpoints
3349You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3350expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3351this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3352The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3353as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3354
3355@itemize @bullet
3356@item
3357A reference to the value of a single variable.
3358
3359@item
3360An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3361@samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3362address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3363
3364@item
3365An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3366expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3367language (@pxref{Languages}).
3368@end itemize
3369
3370You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3371not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3372@samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3373@value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3374the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3375valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3376pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3377@code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3378the expression changes.
3379
3380@cindex software watchpoints
3381@cindex hardware watchpoints
3382Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3383hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3384program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3385times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3386catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3387culprit.)
3388
3389On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3390x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3391watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3392
3393@table @code
3394@kindex watch
3395@item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3396Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3397expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3398changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3399to watch the value of a single variable:
3400
3401@smallexample
3402(@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3403@end smallexample
3404
3405If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3406clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3407@var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3408change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3409that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3410with Hardware Watchpoints.
3411
3412@kindex rwatch
3413@item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3414Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3415by the program.
3416
3417@kindex awatch
3418@item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3419Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3420or written into by the program.
3421
3422@kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3423@item info watchpoints
3424This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3425it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3426@end table
3427
3428@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3429watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3430value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3431cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3432executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3433@emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3434
3435@cindex use only software watchpoints
3436You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3437@kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3438zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3439the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3440watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3441@code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3442mechanism of watching expression values.)
3443
3444@table @code
3445@item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3446@kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3447Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3448
3449@item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3450@kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3451Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3452@end table
3453
3454For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3455watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3456hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3457
3458When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3459
3460@smallexample
3461Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3462@end smallexample
3463
3464@noindent
3465if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3466
3467Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3468hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3469value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3470every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3471that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3472hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3473will print a message like this:
3474
3475@smallexample
3476Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3477@end smallexample
3478
3479Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3480data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3481watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3482can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3483cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3484double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3485wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3486into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3487
3488If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3489to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3490Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3491time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3492able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3493warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3494
3495@smallexample
3496Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3497@end smallexample
3498
3499@noindent
3500If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3501
3502Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3503exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3504That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3505expression with separately allocated resources.
3506
3507If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3508any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3509kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3510
3511@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3512(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3513they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3514which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3515being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3516and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3517rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3518way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3519@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3520
3521@cindex watchpoints and threads
3522@cindex threads and watchpoints
3523In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3524watched expression from every thread.
3525
3526@quotation
3527@emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3528have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3529watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3530single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3531change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3532confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3533software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3534when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3535watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3536@end quotation
3537
3538@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3539
3540@node Set Catchpoints
3541@subsection Setting Catchpoints
3542@cindex catchpoints, setting
3543@cindex exception handlers
3544@cindex event handling
3545
3546You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3547kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3548shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3549
3550@table @code
3551@kindex catch
3552@item catch @var{event}
3553Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3554@table @code
3555@item throw
3556@cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3557The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3558
3559@item catch
3560The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3561
3562@item exception
3563@cindex Ada exception catching
3564@cindex catch Ada exceptions
3565An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3566at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3567the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3568Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3569
3570@item exception unhandled
3571An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3572
3573@item assert
3574A failed Ada assertion.
3575
3576@item exec
3577@cindex break on fork/exec
3578A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3579and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3580
3581@item fork
3582A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3583and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3584
3585@item vfork
3586A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3587and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3588
3589@item load
3590@itemx load @var{libname}
3591@cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3592The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3593@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3594
3595@item unload
3596@itemx unload @var{libname}
3597The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3598of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3599@end table
3600
3601@item tcatch @var{event}
3602Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3603automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3604
3605@end table
3606
3607Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3608
3609There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3610(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3611
3612@itemize @bullet
3613@item
3614If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3615control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3616raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3617returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3618simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3619that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3620you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3621disabled within interactive calls.
3622
3623@item
3624You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3625
3626@item
3627You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3628@end itemize
3629
3630@cindex raise exceptions
3631Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3632if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3633stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3634can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3635breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3636out where the exception was raised.
3637
3638To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3639knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3640raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3641which has the following ANSI C interface:
3642
3643@smallexample
3644 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3645 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3646 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3647@end smallexample
3648
3649@noindent
3650To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3651unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3652(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3653
3654With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3655that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3656a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3657breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3658raised.
3659
3660
3661@node Delete Breaks
3662@subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3663
3664@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3665@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3666It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3667catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3668to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3669breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3670
3671With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3672where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3673delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3674their breakpoint numbers.
3675
3676It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3677automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3678when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3679
3680@table @code
3681@kindex clear
3682@item clear
3683Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3684selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3685the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3686breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3687
3688@item clear @var{location}
3689Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3690@xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3691most useful ones are listed below:
3692
3693@table @code
3694@item clear @var{function}
3695@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3696Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3697
3698@item clear @var{linenum}
3699@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3700Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3701@var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3702@end table
3703
3704@cindex delete breakpoints
3705@kindex delete
3706@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3707@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3708Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3709ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3710breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3711confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3712@end table
3713
3714@node Disabling
3715@subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3716
3717@cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3718Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3719prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3720it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3721that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3722
3723You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3724the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3725or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3726@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3727catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3728
3729Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3730affects all of its locations.
3731
3732A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3733states of enablement:
3734
3735@itemize @bullet
3736@item
3737Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3738with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3739@item
3740Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3741@item
3742Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3743disabled.
3744@item
3745Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3746immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3747set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3748@end itemize
3749
3750You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3751watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3752
3753@table @code
3754@kindex disable
3755@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3756@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3757Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3758listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3759options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3760case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3761@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3762
3763@kindex enable
3764@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3765Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3766become effective once again in stopping your program.
3767
3768@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3769Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3770of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3771
3772@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3773Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3774deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3775Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3776@end table
3777
3778@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3779@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3780Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3781,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3782subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3783the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3784breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3785breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3786Stepping}.)
3787
3788@node Conditions
3789@subsection Break Conditions
3790@cindex conditional breakpoints
3791@cindex breakpoint conditions
3792
3793@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3794@c in particular for a watchpoint?
3795The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3796specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3797breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3798programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3799a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3800and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3801
3802This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3803situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3804when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3805by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3806@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3807
3808Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3809since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3810it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3811and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3812one.
3813
3814Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3815your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3816that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3817format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3818unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3819that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3820program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3821breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3822conditions for the
3823purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3824(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3825
3826Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3827@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3828Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3829with the @code{condition} command.
3830
3831You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3832The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3833@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3834catchpoint.
3835
3836@table @code
3837@kindex condition
3838@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3839Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3840watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3841breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3842@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3843@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3844syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3845referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3846symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3847prints an error message:
3848
3849@smallexample
3850No symbol "foo" in current context.
3851@end smallexample
3852
3853@noindent
3854@value{GDBN} does
3855not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3856command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3857@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3858
3859@item condition @var{bnum}
3860Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3861an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3862@end table
3863
3864@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3865A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3866breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3867useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3868count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3869is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3870therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3871ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3872the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3873value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3874your program reaches it.
3875
3876@table @code
3877@kindex ignore
3878@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3879Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3880The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3881execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3882takes no action.
3883
3884To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3885a count of zero.
3886
3887When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3888breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3889@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3890Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3891
3892If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3893condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3894@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3895
3896You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3897as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3898is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3899Variables}.
3900@end table
3901
3902Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3903
3904
3905@node Break Commands
3906@subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3907
3908@cindex breakpoint commands
3909You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3910commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3911example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3912enable other breakpoints.
3913
3914@table @code
3915@kindex commands
3916@kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3917@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3918@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3919@itemx end
3920Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3921themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3922@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3923
3924To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3925follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3926
3927With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3928breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3929recently encountered).
3930@end table
3931
3932Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3933disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3934
3935You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3936use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3937that resumes execution.
3938
3939Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3940execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3941(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3942another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3943ambiguities about which list to execute.
3944
3945@kindex silent
3946If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3947usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3948be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3949then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3950see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3951meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3952
3953The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3954print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3955breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3956
3957For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3958value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3959
3960@smallexample
3961break foo if x>0
3962commands
3963silent
3964printf "x is %d\n",x
3965cont
3966end
3967@end smallexample
3968
3969One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3970you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3971of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3972erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3973to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3974so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3975command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3976
3977@smallexample
3978break 403
3979commands
3980silent
3981set x = y + 4
3982cont
3983end
3984@end smallexample
3985
3986@c @ifclear BARETARGET
3987@node Error in Breakpoints
3988@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3989@c
3990@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3991@c
3992Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3993any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3994attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3995@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3996
3997@smallexample
3998Cannot insert breakpoints.
3999The same program may be running in another process.
4000@end smallexample
4001
4002When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
4003
4004@enumerate
4005@item
4006Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
4007
4008@item
4009Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
4010name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
4011that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
4012Then start your program again.
4013
4014@item
4015Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
4016linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
4017to nonsharable executables.
4018@end enumerate
4019@c @end ifclear
4020
4021A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
4022hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
4023
4024@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4025@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4026@smallexample
4027Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4028You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4029@end smallexample
4030
4031@noindent
4032This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4033only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4034watchpoints it needs to insert.
4035
4036When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4037hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4038
4039@node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4040@subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4041@cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4042
4043Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4044which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4045@value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4046with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4047
4048One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4049a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4050bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4051constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4052bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4053honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4054first in the bundle.
4055
4056It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4057instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4058a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4059another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4060breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4061printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4062is hit.
4063
4064A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4065that's been subject to address adjustment:
4066
4067@smallexample
4068warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4069@end smallexample
4070
4071Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4072internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4073verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4074desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4075other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4076E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4077instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4078cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4079
4080@value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4081adjusted breakpoints:
4082
4083@smallexample
4084warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4085to 0x00010410.
4086@end smallexample
4087
4088When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4089action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4090frequently than expected.
4091
4092@node Continuing and Stepping
4093@section Continuing and Stepping
4094
4095@cindex stepping
4096@cindex continuing
4097@cindex resuming execution
4098@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4099completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4100one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4101line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4102particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4103your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4104it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4105@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4106
4107@table @code
4108@kindex continue
4109@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4110@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4111@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4112@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4113@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4114Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4115any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4116@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4117ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4118@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4119
4120The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4121stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4122@code{continue} is ignored.
4123
4124The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4125debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4126purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4127@code{continue}.
4128@end table
4129
4130To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4131(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4132calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4133Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4134
4135A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4136(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4137beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4138is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4139and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4140interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4141
4142@table @code
4143@kindex step
4144@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4145@item step
4146Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4147line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4148abbreviated @code{s}.
4149
4150@quotation
4151@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4152@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4153@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4154@c distinction here.
4155@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4156within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4157execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4158debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4159is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4160without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4161below.
4162@end quotation
4163
4164The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4165line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4166@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4167to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4168the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4169called within the line.
4170
4171Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4172number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4173@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4174on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4175was any debugging information about the routine.
4176
4177@item step @var{count}
4178Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4179breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4180@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4181
4182@kindex next
4183@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4184@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4185Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4186This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4187the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4188control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4189that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4190is abbreviated @code{n}.
4191
4192An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4193
4194
4195@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4196@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4197@c
4198@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4199@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4200@c function are executed without stopping.
4201
4202The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4203source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4204@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4205
4206@kindex set step-mode
4207@item set step-mode
4208@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4209@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4210@itemx set step-mode on
4211The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4212stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4213information rather than stepping over it.
4214
4215This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4216machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4217want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4218
4219@item set step-mode off
4220Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4221debug information. This is the default.
4222
4223@item show step-mode
4224Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4225source line debug information.
4226
4227@kindex finish
4228@kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4229@item finish
4230Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4231returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4232abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4233
4234Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4235,Returning from a Function}).
4236
4237@kindex until
4238@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4239@cindex run until specified location
4240@item until
4241@itemx u
4242Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4243current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4244stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4245command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4246automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4247than the address of the jump.
4248
4249This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4250though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4251exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4252simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4253through the next iteration.
4254
4255@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4256stack frame.
4257
4258@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4259of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4260example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4261(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4262@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4263
4264@smallexample
4265(@value{GDBP}) f
4266#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4267206 expand_input();
4268(@value{GDBP}) until
4269195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4270@end smallexample
4271
4272This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4273generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4274start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4275written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4276to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4277expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4278statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4279
4280@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4281instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4282argument.
4283
4284@item until @var{location}
4285@itemx u @var{location}
4286Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4287reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4288the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4289This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4290hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4291location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4292implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4293invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4294line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4295line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4296invocations have returned.
4297
4298@smallexample
429994 int factorial (int value)
430095 @{
430196 if (value > 1) @{
430297 value *= factorial (value - 1);
430398 @}
430499 return (value);
4305100 @}
4306@end smallexample
4307
4308
4309@kindex advance @var{location}
4310@itemx advance @var{location}
4311Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4312required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4313@ref{Specify Location}.
4314Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4315frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4316not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4317have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4318
4319
4320@kindex stepi
4321@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4322@item stepi
4323@itemx stepi @var{arg}
4324@itemx si
4325Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4326
4327It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4328instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4329instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4330Display,, Automatic Display}.
4331
4332An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4333
4334@need 750
4335@kindex nexti
4336@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4337@item nexti
4338@itemx nexti @var{arg}
4339@itemx ni
4340Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4341proceed until the function returns.
4342
4343An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4344@end table
4345
4346@node Signals
4347@section Signals
4348@cindex signals
4349
4350A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4351operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4352kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4353signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4354@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4355memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4356the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4357requested an alarm).
4358
4359@cindex fatal signals
4360Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4361functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4362errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4363program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4364@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4365fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4366
4367@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4368program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4369signal.
4370
4371@cindex handling signals
4372Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4373@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4374(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4375but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4376You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4377
4378@table @code
4379@kindex info signals
4380@kindex info handle
4381@item info signals
4382@itemx info handle
4383Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4384handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4385the defined types of signals.
4386
4387@item info signals @var{sig}
4388Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4389
4390@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4391
4392@kindex handle
4393@item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4394Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4395can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4396@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4397@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4398known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4399say what change to make.
4400@end table
4401
4402@c @group
4403The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4404Their full names are:
4405
4406@table @code
4407@item nostop
4408@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4409still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4410
4411@item stop
4412@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4413the @code{print} keyword as well.
4414
4415@item print
4416@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4417
4418@item noprint
4419@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4420implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4421
4422@item pass
4423@itemx noignore
4424@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4425can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4426and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4427
4428@item nopass
4429@itemx ignore
4430@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4431@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4432@end table
4433@c @end group
4434
4435When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4436program until you
4437continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4438effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4439after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4440command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4441program sees that signal when you continue.
4442
4443The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4444non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4445@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4446erroneous signals.
4447
4448You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4449seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4450or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4451due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4452values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4453execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4454a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4455you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4456Program a Signal}.
4457
4458@node Thread Stops
4459@section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4460
4461@cindex stopped threads
4462@cindex threads, stopped
4463
4464@cindex continuing threads
4465@cindex threads, continuing
4466
4467@value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4468(@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4469are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4470debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4471when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4472or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4473@value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4474@dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4475you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4476
4477@menu
4478* All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4479* Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4480* Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4481* Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4482* Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4483@end menu
4484
4485@node All-Stop Mode
4486@subsection All-Stop Mode
4487
4488@cindex all-stop mode
4489
4490In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4491@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4492allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4493switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4494underfoot.
4495
4496Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4497executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4498like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4499
4500In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4501Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4502system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4503execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4504single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4505statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4506stops.
4507
4508You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4509continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4510thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4511first thread completes whatever you requested.
4512
4513@cindex automatic thread selection
4514@cindex switching threads automatically
4515@cindex threads, automatic switching
4516Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4517signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4518signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4519message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4520thread.
4521
4522On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
4523locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
4524
4525@table @code
4526@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4527@cindex scheduler locking mode
4528@cindex lock scheduler
4529Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4530locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4531current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4532mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
4533from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
4534the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
4535Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4536when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4537function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4538like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4539thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
4540the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
4541
4542@item show scheduler-locking
4543Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4544@end table
4545
4546@node Non-Stop Mode
4547@subsection Non-Stop Mode
4548
4549@cindex non-stop mode
4550
4551@c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
4552@c with more details.
4553
4554For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
4555mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
4556the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
4557minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
4558where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
4559respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
4560
4561In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
4562@emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
4563threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
4564execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
4565only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
4566in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
4567ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
4568one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
4569one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
4570independently and simultaneously.
4571
4572To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
4573or attach to your program:
4574
4575@smallexample
4576# Enable the async interface.
4577set target-async 1
4578
4579# If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
4580set pagination off
4581
4582# Finally, turn it on!
4583set non-stop on
4584@end smallexample
4585
4586You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
4587
4588@table @code
4589@kindex set non-stop
4590@item set non-stop on
4591Enable selection of non-stop mode.
4592@item set non-stop off
4593Disable selection of non-stop mode.
4594@kindex show non-stop
4595@item show non-stop
4596Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
4597@end table
4598
4599Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
4600not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
4601In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
4602@value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
4603not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
4604since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
4605non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
4606default.
4607
4608In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
4609by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
4610To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
4611
4612You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
4613(@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
4614while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
4615The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
4616always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
4617
4618Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
4619running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
4620In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
4621but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
4622To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
4623
4624Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
4625
4626In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
4627that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
4628thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
4629command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
4630changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
4631previously current thread.
4632
4633@node Background Execution
4634@subsection Background Execution
4635
4636@cindex foreground execution
4637@cindex background execution
4638@cindex asynchronous execution
4639@cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
4640
4641@value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
4642foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
4643(asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
4644the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
4645another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
4646a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
4647
4648To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
4649the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
4650just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
4651are:
4652
4653@table @code
4654@kindex run&
4655@item run
4656@xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
4657
4658@item attach
4659@kindex attach&
4660@xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
4661
4662@item step
4663@kindex step&
4664@xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
4665
4666@item stepi
4667@kindex stepi&
4668@xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
4669
4670@item next
4671@kindex next&
4672@xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
4673
4674@item continue
4675@kindex continue&
4676@xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
4677
4678@item finish
4679@kindex finish&
4680@xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
4681
4682@item until
4683@kindex until&
4684@xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
4685
4686@end table
4687
4688Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
4689mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
4690However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
4691the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
4692previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
4693mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
4694
4695You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
4696using the @code{interrupt} command.
4697
4698@table @code
4699@kindex interrupt
4700@item interrupt
4701@itemx interrupt -a
4702
4703Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
4704@code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
4705only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
4706use @code{interrupt -a}.
4707@end table
4708
4709You may need to explicitly enable async mode before you can use background
4710execution commands, with the @code{set target-async 1} command. If the
4711target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error message
4712if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
4713
4714@node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4715@subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4716
4717When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4718Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4719breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4720
4721@table @code
4722@cindex breakpoints and threads
4723@cindex thread breakpoints
4724@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4725@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4726@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4727@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4728writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4729specify some source line.
4730
4731Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4732to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4733particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4734numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4735column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4736
4737If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4738breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4739program.
4740
4741You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4742well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4743breakpoint condition, like this:
4744
4745@smallexample
4746(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4747@end smallexample
4748
4749@end table
4750
4751@node Interrupted System Calls
4752@subsection Interrupted System Calls
4753
4754@cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4755@cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4756@cindex premature return from system calls
4757There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
4758multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
4759breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4760system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4761consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4762that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4763stop execution.
4764
4765To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4766each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4767style anyways.
4768
4769For example, do not write code like this:
4770
4771@smallexample
4772 sleep (10);
4773@end smallexample
4774
4775The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4776at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4777
4778Instead, write this:
4779
4780@smallexample
4781 int unslept = 10;
4782 while (unslept > 0)
4783 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4784@end smallexample
4785
4786A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4787conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4788multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4789@value{GDBN}.
4790
4791Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4792monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4793When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4794prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4795
4796
4797
4798@node Stack
4799@chapter Examining the Stack
4800
4801When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4802stopped and how it got there.
4803
4804@cindex call stack
4805Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4806is generated.
4807That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4808the arguments of the call,
4809and the local variables of the function being called.
4810The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4811The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4812stack}.
4813
4814When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4815stack allow you to see all of this information.
4816
4817@cindex selected frame
4818One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4819@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4820particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4821your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4822special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4823interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4824
4825When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4826currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4827@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4828
4829@menu
4830* Frames:: Stack frames
4831* Backtrace:: Backtraces
4832* Selection:: Selecting a frame
4833* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4834
4835@end menu
4836
4837@node Frames
4838@section Stack Frames
4839
4840@cindex frame, definition
4841@cindex stack frame
4842The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4843frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4844with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4845to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4846which the function is executing.
4847
4848@cindex initial frame
4849@cindex outermost frame
4850@cindex innermost frame
4851When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4852function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4853@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4854made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4855is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4856the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4857actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4858recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4859
4860@cindex frame pointer
4861Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4862stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4863kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4864address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4865in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4866(@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4867
4868@cindex frame number
4869@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4870zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4871and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4872they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4873frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4874
4875@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4876@c underflow problems.
4877@cindex frameless execution
4878Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4879without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4880@smallexample
4881@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4882@end smallexample
4883generates functions without a frame.)
4884This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4885the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4886with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4887has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4888it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4889correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4890no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4891
4892@table @code
4893@kindex frame@r{, command}
4894@cindex current stack frame
4895@item frame @var{args}
4896The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4897and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4898address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4899@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4900
4901@kindex select-frame
4902@cindex selecting frame silently
4903@item select-frame
4904The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4905to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4906@code{frame}.
4907@end table
4908
4909@node Backtrace
4910@section Backtraces
4911
4912@cindex traceback
4913@cindex call stack traces
4914A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4915line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4916frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4917stack.
4918
4919@table @code
4920@kindex backtrace
4921@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4922@item backtrace
4923@itemx bt
4924Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4925frames in the stack.
4926
4927You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4928character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4929
4930@item backtrace @var{n}
4931@itemx bt @var{n}
4932Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4933
4934@item backtrace -@var{n}
4935@itemx bt -@var{n}
4936Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4937
4938@item backtrace full
4939@itemx bt full
4940@itemx bt full @var{n}
4941@itemx bt full -@var{n}
4942Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4943number of frames to print, as described above.
4944@end table
4945
4946@kindex where
4947@kindex info stack
4948The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4949are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4950
4951@cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4952In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4953backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4954several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4955(@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4956apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4957the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4958multi-threaded program.
4959
4960Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4961The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4962print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4963line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4964counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4965line number.
4966
4967Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4968@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4969
4970@smallexample
4971@group
4972#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4973 at builtin.c:993
4974#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4975#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4976 at macro.c:71
4977(More stack frames follow...)
4978@end group
4979@end smallexample
4980
4981@noindent
4982The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4983value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4984code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4985
4986@cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4987@cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4988If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4989optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4990never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4991passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4992in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4993arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4994such a backtrace might look like:
4995
4996@smallexample
4997@group
4998#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4999 at builtin.c:993
5000#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5001#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5002 at macro.c:71
5003(More stack frames follow...)
5004@end group
5005@end smallexample
5006
5007@noindent
5008The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5009shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5010
5011If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5012either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5013you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5014
5015@cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5016@cindex program entry point
5017@cindex startup code, and backtrace
5018Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5019libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5020@code{main}@footnote{
5021Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5022environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5023entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5024When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5025it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5026system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5027
5028If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5029in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5030
5031@table @code
5032@item set backtrace past-main
5033@itemx set backtrace past-main on
5034@kindex set backtrace
5035Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5036
5037@item set backtrace past-main off
5038Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5039default.
5040
5041@item show backtrace past-main
5042@kindex show backtrace
5043Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5044
5045@item set backtrace past-entry
5046@itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5047Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5048This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5049and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5050
5051@item set backtrace past-entry off
5052Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5053application. This is the default.
5054
5055@item show backtrace past-entry
5056Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5057
5058@item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5059@itemx set backtrace limit 0
5060@cindex backtrace limit
5061Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5062unlimited.
5063
5064@item show backtrace limit
5065Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5066@end table
5067
5068@node Selection
5069@section Selecting a Frame
5070
5071Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5072whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5073selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5074of the stack frame just selected.
5075
5076@table @code
5077@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5078@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5079@item frame @var{n}
5080@itemx f @var{n}
5081Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5082(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5083innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5084@code{main}.
5085
5086@item frame @var{addr}
5087@itemx f @var{addr}
5088Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5089chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5090impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5091addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5092switches between them.
5093
5094On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5095select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5096
5097On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5098pointer and a program counter.
5099
5100On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5101pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5102
5103@kindex up
5104@item up @var{n}
5105Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5106advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5107that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5108
5109@kindex down
5110@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5111@item down @var{n}
5112Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5113advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5114that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5115abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5116@end table
5117
5118All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5119frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5120arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5121frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5122
5123@need 1000
5124For example:
5125
5126@smallexample
5127@group
5128(@value{GDBP}) up
5129#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5130 at env.c:10
513110 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5132@end group
5133@end smallexample
5134
5135After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5136prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5137You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5138editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5139@xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5140for details.
5141
5142@table @code
5143@kindex down-silently
5144@kindex up-silently
5145@item up-silently @var{n}
5146@itemx down-silently @var{n}
5147These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5148respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5149causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5150in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5151distracting.
5152@end table
5153
5154@node Frame Info
5155@section Information About a Frame
5156
5157There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5158stack frame.
5159
5160@table @code
5161@item frame
5162@itemx f
5163When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5164frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5165selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5166argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5167@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5168
5169@kindex info frame
5170@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5171@item info frame
5172@itemx info f
5173This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5174including:
5175
5176@itemize @bullet
5177@item
5178the address of the frame
5179@item
5180the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5181@item
5182the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5183@item
5184the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5185@item
5186the address of the frame's arguments
5187@item
5188the address of the frame's local variables
5189@item
5190the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5191@item
5192which registers were saved in the frame
5193@end itemize
5194
5195@noindent The verbose description is useful when
5196something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
5197the usual conventions.
5198
5199@item info frame @var{addr}
5200@itemx info f @var{addr}
5201Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
5202selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
5203command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
5204architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
5205@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5206
5207@kindex info args
5208@item info args
5209Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5210
5211@item info locals
5212@kindex info locals
5213Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5214line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5215accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5216
5217@kindex info catch
5218@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5219@cindex exception handlers, how to list
5220@item info catch
5221Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5222current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5223exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5224@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5225@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5226
5227@end table
5228
5229
5230@node Source
5231@chapter Examining Source Files
5232
5233@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5234information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5235used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5236the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5237(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5238execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5239source files by explicit command.
5240
5241If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
5242prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
5243@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
5244
5245@menu
5246* List:: Printing source lines
5247* Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
5248* Edit:: Editing source files
5249* Search:: Searching source files
5250* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
5251* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
5252@end menu
5253
5254@node List
5255@section Printing Source Lines
5256
5257@kindex list
5258@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
5259To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5260(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
5261There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
5262print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
5263
5264Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
5265
5266@table @code
5267@item list @var{linenum}
5268Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
5269current source file.
5270
5271@item list @var{function}
5272Print lines centered around the beginning of function
5273@var{function}.
5274
5275@item list
5276Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
5277@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
5278printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
5279as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
5280Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
5281
5282@item list -
5283Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5284@end table
5285
5286@cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
5287By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
5288the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
5289
5290@table @code
5291@kindex set listsize
5292@item set listsize @var{count}
5293Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
5294the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
5295
5296@kindex show listsize
5297@item show listsize
5298Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
5299@end table
5300
5301Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
5302so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
5303than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
5304argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
5305each repetition moves up in the source file.
5306
5307In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
5308@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5309of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5310to specify some source line.
5311
5312Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5313
5314@table @code
5315@item list @var{linespec}
5316Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5317
5318@item list @var{first},@var{last}
5319Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5320linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5321source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5322the same source file as the first linespec.
5323
5324@item list ,@var{last}
5325Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5326
5327@item list @var{first},
5328Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5329
5330@item list +
5331Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5332
5333@item list -
5334Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5335
5336@item list
5337As described in the preceding table.
5338@end table
5339
5340@node Specify Location
5341@section Specifying a Location
5342@cindex specifying location
5343@cindex linespec
5344
5345Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5346of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5347debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5348for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5349
5350Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5351@value{GDBN} understands:
5352
5353@table @code
5354@item @var{linenum}
5355Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5356
5357@item -@var{offset}
5358@itemx +@var{offset}
5359Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5360line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5361printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5362execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5363(@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5364used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5365this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5366linespec.
5367
5368@item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5369Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5370
5371@item @var{function}
5372Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5373For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5374
5375@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5376Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5377in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5378function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5379functions in different source files.
5380
5381@item *@var{address}
5382Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5383commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5384line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5385breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5386parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5387source files.
5388
5389Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5390language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5391address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5392semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5393that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5394of @var{address}:
5395
5396@table @code
5397@item @var{expression}
5398Any expression valid in the current working language.
5399
5400@item @var{funcaddr}
5401An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5402C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5403simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5404of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5405@code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5406(although the Pascal form also works).
5407
5408This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5409before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5410
5411@item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5412Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5413file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5414specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5415functions with identical names in different source files.
5416@end table
5417
5418@end table
5419
5420
5421@node Edit
5422@section Editing Source Files
5423@cindex editing source files
5424
5425@kindex edit
5426@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5427To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5428The editing program of your choice
5429is invoked with the current line set to
5430the active line in the program.
5431Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5432want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5433
5434@table @code
5435@item edit @var{location}
5436Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5437that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5438specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5439of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5440command most commonly used:
5441
5442@table @code
5443@item edit @var{number}
5444Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5445
5446@item edit @var{function}
5447Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5448@end table
5449
5450@end table
5451
5452@subsection Choosing your Editor
5453You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5454@footnote{
5455The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5456following command-line syntax:
5457@smallexample
5458ex +@var{number} file
5459@end smallexample
5460The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5461the file where to start editing.}.
5462By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5463by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5464@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5465@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5466@smallexample
5467EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5468export EDITOR
5469gdb @dots{}
5470@end smallexample
5471or in the @code{csh} shell,
5472@smallexample
5473setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5474gdb @dots{}
5475@end smallexample
5476
5477@node Search
5478@section Searching Source Files
5479@cindex searching source files
5480
5481There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5482regular expression.
5483
5484@table @code
5485@kindex search
5486@kindex forward-search
5487@item forward-search @var{regexp}
5488@itemx search @var{regexp}
5489The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5490starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5491@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5492synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5493@code{fo}.
5494
5495@kindex reverse-search
5496@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5497The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5498with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5499for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5500this command as @code{rev}.
5501@end table
5502
5503@node Source Path
5504@section Specifying Source Directories
5505
5506@cindex source path
5507@cindex directories for source files
5508Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5509files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5510the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5511session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5512this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5513it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5514in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5515
5516For example, suppose an executable references the file
5517@file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5518@file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5519fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5520fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5521message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5522source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5523Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5524the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5525@file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5526@file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5527
5528Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5529names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5530instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5531is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5532@file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5533that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5534
5535Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5536source files.
5537
5538Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5539any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5540each line is in the file.
5541
5542@kindex directory
5543@kindex dir
5544When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5545and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5546To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5547
5548The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5549script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5550
5551In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5552that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5553rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5554debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5555directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5556two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5557the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5558In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5559@var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5560of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5561source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5562name to look up the sources.
5563
5564Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5565moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5566@value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5567@file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5568@file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5569of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5570substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5571(@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5572
5573To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5574@var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5575For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5576@file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5577not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5578is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5579not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5580
5581In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5582command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5583the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5584subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5585subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5586preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5587allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5588command.
5589
5590@code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5591The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5592longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5593the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5594for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5595located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5596method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5597
5598@table @code
5599@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5600@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5601Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5602directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5603(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5604part of absolute file names) or
5605whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5606path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5607
5608@kindex cdir
5609@kindex cwd
5610@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5611@vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5612@cindex compilation directory
5613@cindex current directory
5614@cindex working directory
5615@cindex directory, current
5616@cindex directory, compilation
5617You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5618directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5619working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5620tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5621session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5622directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5623
5624@item directory
5625Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5626
5627@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5628@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5629
5630@item show directories
5631@kindex show directories
5632Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5633
5634@anchor{set substitute-path}
5635@item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5636@kindex set substitute-path
5637Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5638current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5639@var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5640
5641For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5642@file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5643
5644@smallexample
5645(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5646@end smallexample
5647
5648@noindent
5649will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5650@samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5651@file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5652
5653In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5654the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5655defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5656the substitution.
5657
5658For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5659
5660@smallexample
5661(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5662(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5663@end smallexample
5664
5665@noindent
5666@value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5667@file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5668use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5669@file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5670
5671
5672@item unset substitute-path [path]
5673@kindex unset substitute-path
5674If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5675for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5676A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5677
5678If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5679
5680@item show substitute-path [path]
5681@kindex show substitute-path
5682If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5683which would rewrite that path, if any.
5684
5685If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5686rules.
5687
5688@end table
5689
5690If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5691interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5692versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5693
5694@enumerate
5695@item
5696Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5697
5698@item
5699Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5700directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5701directories in one command.
5702@end enumerate
5703
5704@node Machine Code
5705@section Source and Machine Code
5706@cindex source line and its code address
5707
5708You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5709addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5710a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5711mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5712line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5713well as hex.
5714
5715@table @code
5716@kindex info line
5717@item info line @var{linespec}
5718Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5719source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5720the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5721@end table
5722
5723For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5724the object code for the first line of function
5725@code{m4_changequote}:
5726
5727@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5728@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5729@smallexample
5730(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5731Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5732@end smallexample
5733
5734@noindent
5735@cindex code address and its source line
5736We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5737@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5738@smallexample
5739(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5740Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5741@end smallexample
5742
5743@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5744@cindex @code{x} command, default address
5745@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5746After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5747is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5748sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5749,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5750convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5751Variables}).
5752
5753@table @code
5754@kindex disassemble
5755@cindex assembly instructions
5756@cindex instructions, assembly
5757@cindex machine instructions
5758@cindex listing machine instructions
5759@item disassemble
5760@itemx disassemble /m
5761This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5762instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
5763the @code{/m} modifier.
5764The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5765program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5766command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5767surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5768(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5769@end table
5770
5771The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5772HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5773
5774@smallexample
5775(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5776Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
57770x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
57780x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
57790x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
57800x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
57810x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
57820x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
57830x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
57840x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5785End of assembler dump.
5786@end smallexample
5787
5788Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
5789
5790@smallexample
5791(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
5792Dump of assembler code for function main:
57935 @{
57940x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
57950x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
57960x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
57970x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
57980x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
5799
58006 printf ("Hello.\n");
58010x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
58020x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
5803
58047 return 0;
58058 @}
58060x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
58070x0804834d <main+29>: leave
58080x0804834e <main+30>: ret
5809
5810End of assembler dump.
5811@end smallexample
5812
5813Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5814mnemonics or other syntax.
5815
5816For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5817instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5818libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5819location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5820might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5821
5822@table @code
5823@kindex set disassembly-flavor
5824@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5825@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5826@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5827Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5828program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5829
5830Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5831can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5832The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5833assemblers for x86-based targets.
5834
5835@kindex show disassembly-flavor
5836@item show disassembly-flavor
5837Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5838@end table
5839
5840
5841@node Data
5842@chapter Examining Data
5843
5844@cindex printing data
5845@cindex examining data
5846@kindex print
5847@kindex inspect
5848@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5849@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5850@c different window or something like that.
5851The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5852command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5853evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5854program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5855Different Languages}).
5856
5857@table @code
5858@item print @var{expr}
5859@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5860@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5861value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5862you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5863@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5864Formats}.
5865
5866@item print
5867@itemx print /@var{f}
5868@cindex reprint the last value
5869If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5870@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5871conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5872@end table
5873
5874A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5875It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5876specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5877
5878If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5879fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5880command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5881Table}.
5882
5883@menu
5884* Expressions:: Expressions
5885* Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
5886* Variables:: Program variables
5887* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5888* Output Formats:: Output formats
5889* Memory:: Examining memory
5890* Auto Display:: Automatic display
5891* Print Settings:: Print settings
5892* Value History:: Value history
5893* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5894* Registers:: Registers
5895* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5896* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5897* OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5898* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5899* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5900* Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5901* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5902 character set than GDB does
5903* Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5904* Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
5905@end menu
5906
5907@node Expressions
5908@section Expressions
5909
5910@cindex expressions
5911@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5912compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5913by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5914@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5915casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5916you compiled your program to include this information; see
5917@ref{Compilation}.
5918
5919@cindex arrays in expressions
5920@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5921the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5922you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
5923of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
5924to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
5925is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5926
5927Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5928this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5929Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5930languages.
5931
5932In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5933expressions regardless of your programming language.
5934
5935@cindex casts, in expressions
5936Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5937useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5938at that address in memory.
5939@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5940
5941@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5942to programming languages:
5943
5944@table @code
5945@item @@
5946@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5947@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5948
5949@item ::
5950@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5951function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5952
5953@cindex @{@var{type}@}
5954@cindex type casting memory
5955@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5956@cindex casts, to view memory
5957@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5958Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5959memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5960pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5961a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5962normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5963@end table
5964
5965@node Ambiguous Expressions
5966@section Ambiguous Expressions
5967@cindex ambiguous expressions
5968
5969Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
5970some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
5971a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
5972different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
5973involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
5974templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
5975the same function name being defined in different contexts.
5976
5977In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
5978the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
5979can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
5980@kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
5981qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
5982as well.
5983
5984When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
5985has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
5986possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
5987The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
5988aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
5989used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
5990menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
5991choices.
5992
5993For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
5994breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
5995We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
5996
5997@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
5998@smallexample
5999@group
6000(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6001[0] cancel
6002[1] all
6003[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6004[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6005[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6006[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6007[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6008[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6009> 2 4 6
6010Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6011Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6012Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6013Multiple breakpoints were set.
6014Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6015 breakpoints.
6016(@value{GDBP})
6017@end group
6018@end smallexample
6019
6020@table @code
6021@kindex set multiple-symbols
6022@item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6023@cindex multiple-symbols menu
6024
6025This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6026is ambiguous.
6027
6028By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6029the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6030automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6031a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6032inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6033then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6034For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6035in the use of the menu.
6036
6037When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6038when an ambiguity is detected.
6039
6040Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6041an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6042
6043@kindex show multiple-symbols
6044@item show multiple-symbols
6045Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6046@end table
6047
6048@node Variables
6049@section Program Variables
6050
6051The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6052in your program.
6053
6054Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6055(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6056
6057@itemize @bullet
6058@item
6059global (or file-static)
6060@end itemize
6061
6062@noindent or
6063
6064@itemize @bullet
6065@item
6066visible according to the scope rules of the
6067programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6068@end itemize
6069
6070@noindent This means that in the function
6071
6072@smallexample
6073foo (a)
6074 int a;
6075@{
6076 bar (a);
6077 @{
6078 int b = test ();
6079 bar (b);
6080 @}
6081@}
6082@end smallexample
6083
6084@noindent
6085you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6086executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6087examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6088the block where @code{b} is declared.
6089
6090@cindex variable name conflict
6091There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6092scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6093in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6094function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6095happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6096you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6097using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6098
6099@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6100@ifnotinfo
6101@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6102@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6103@end ifnotinfo
6104@smallexample
6105@var{file}::@var{variable}
6106@var{function}::@var{variable}
6107@end smallexample
6108
6109@noindent
6110Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6111static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6112make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6113to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6114
6115@smallexample
6116(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6117@end smallexample
6118
6119@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6120This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6121use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6122scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6123@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6124@c conflict?? --mew
6125
6126@cindex wrong values
6127@cindex variable values, wrong
6128@cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6129@cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6130@quotation
6131@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6132wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6133scope, and just before exit.
6134@end quotation
6135You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6136This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6137set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6138stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6139values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6140also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
6141after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
6142variable definitions may be gone.
6143
6144This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
6145To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
6146when compiling.
6147
6148@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
6149Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
6150unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
6151opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
6152offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
6153might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
6154happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
6155
6156@smallexample
6157No symbol "foo" in current context.
6158@end smallexample
6159
6160To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
6161different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
6162formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
6163usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
6164produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
6165COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
6166an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
6167for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
6168Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
6169@xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
6170that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
6171
6172If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
6173@value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
6174by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
6175type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
6176
6177Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
6178signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
6179printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
6180@code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
6181defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
6182For program code
6183
6184@smallexample
6185char var0[] = "A";
6186signed char var1[] = "A";
6187@end smallexample
6188
6189You get during debugging
6190@smallexample
6191(gdb) print var0
6192$1 = "A"
6193(gdb) print var1
6194$2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
6195@end smallexample
6196
6197@node Arrays
6198@section Artificial Arrays
6199
6200@cindex artificial array
6201@cindex arrays
6202@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
6203It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
6204same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
6205dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
6206program.
6207
6208You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
6209@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
6210operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
6211and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
6212of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
6213the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
6214argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
6215following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
6216example. If a program says
6217
6218@smallexample
6219int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
6220@end smallexample
6221
6222@noindent
6223you can print the contents of @code{array} with
6224
6225@smallexample
6226p *array@@len
6227@end smallexample
6228
6229The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
6230with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
6231subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
6232Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
6233(@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
6234
6235Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
6236This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
6237The value need not be in memory:
6238@smallexample
6239(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
6240$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6241@end smallexample
6242
6243As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
6244@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
6245the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
6246@smallexample
6247(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
6248$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6249@end smallexample
6250
6251Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
6252moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
6253actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
6254of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
6255to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6256Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
6257interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
6258instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
6259structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
6260in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
6261
6262@smallexample
6263set $i = 0
6264p dtab[$i++]->fv
6265@key{RET}
6266@key{RET}
6267@dots{}
6268@end smallexample
6269
6270@node Output Formats
6271@section Output Formats
6272
6273@cindex formatted output
6274@cindex output formats
6275By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
6276this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
6277in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
6278at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
6279these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
6280
6281The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
6282already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
6283@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
6284letters supported are:
6285
6286@table @code
6287@item x
6288Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
6289hexadecimal.
6290
6291@item d
6292Print as integer in signed decimal.
6293
6294@item u
6295Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
6296
6297@item o
6298Print as integer in octal.
6299
6300@item t
6301Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
6302@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
6303used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
6304see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
6305
6306@item a
6307@cindex unknown address, locating
6308@cindex locate address
6309Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6310the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6311where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6312
6313@smallexample
6314(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6315$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6316@end smallexample
6317
6318@noindent
6319The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6320@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6321
6322@item c
6323Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6324prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6325character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6326for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6327
6328Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6329@w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6330constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6331data.
6332
6333@item f
6334Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6335using typical floating point syntax.
6336
6337@item s
6338@cindex printing strings
6339@cindex printing byte arrays
6340Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6341data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6342are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6343natural types.
6344
6345Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6346@code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6347strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6348array.
6349@end table
6350
6351For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6352
6353@smallexample
6354p/x $pc
6355@end smallexample
6356
6357@noindent
6358Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6359names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6360
6361To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6362you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6363expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6364
6365@node Memory
6366@section Examining Memory
6367
6368You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6369any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6370
6371@cindex examining memory
6372@table @code
6373@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6374@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6375@itemx x @var{addr}
6376@itemx x
6377Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6378@end table
6379
6380@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6381much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6382expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6383If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6384Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6385
6386@table @r
6387@item @var{n}, the repeat count
6388The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6389how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6390@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6391@c 4.1.2.
6392
6393@item @var{f}, the display format
6394The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6395(@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6396@samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6397The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6398each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6399
6400@item @var{u}, the unit size
6401The unit size is any of
6402
6403@table @code
6404@item b
6405Bytes.
6406@item h
6407Halfwords (two bytes).
6408@item w
6409Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6410@item g
6411Giant words (eight bytes).
6412@end table
6413
6414Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6415default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6416@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6417
6418@item @var{addr}, starting display address
6419@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6420memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6421it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6422@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6423@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6424other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6425the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6426starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6427a value from memory).
6428@end table
6429
6430For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6431(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6432starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6433words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6434@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6435
6436Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6437letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6438unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6439specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6440(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6441
6442Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6443and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6444@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6445including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6446the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6447slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6448follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6449@code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6450instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6451
6452All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6453easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6454you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6455instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6456with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6457the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6458for successive uses of @code{x}.
6459
6460@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6461The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6462in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6463would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6464subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6465@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6466examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6467@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6468the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6469
6470If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6471are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6472address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6473
6474@cindex remote memory comparison
6475@cindex verify remote memory image
6476When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6477(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6478remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6479the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6480situations.
6481
6482@table @code
6483@kindex compare-sections
6484@item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6485Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6486executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6487the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6488arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6489availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6490remote request.
6491@end table
6492
6493@node Auto Display
6494@section Automatic Display
6495@cindex automatic display
6496@cindex display of expressions
6497
6498If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6499(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6500display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6501Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6502to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6503The automatic display looks like this:
6504
6505@smallexample
65062: foo = 38
65073: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6508@end smallexample
6509
6510@noindent
6511This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6512displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6513specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6514whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6515specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6516or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6517
6518@table @code
6519@kindex display
6520@item display @var{expr}
6521Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6522each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6523
6524@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6525
6526@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6527For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6528count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6529arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6530@xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6531
6532@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6533For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6534number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6535be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6536doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6537@end table
6538
6539For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6540instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6541is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6542
6543@table @code
6544@kindex delete display
6545@kindex undisplay
6546@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6547@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6548Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6549
6550@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6551(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6552
6553@kindex disable display
6554@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6555Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6556item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6557enabled again later.
6558
6559@kindex enable display
6560@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6561Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6562again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6563
6564@item display
6565Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6566done when your program stops.
6567
6568@kindex info display
6569@item info display
6570Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6571automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6572values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6573It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6574because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6575@end table
6576
6577@cindex display disabled out of scope
6578If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6579sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6580expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6581variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6582@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6583@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6584continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6585there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6586automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6587is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6588
6589@node Print Settings
6590@section Print Settings
6591
6592@cindex format options
6593@cindex print settings
6594@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6595and symbols are printed.
6596
6597@noindent
6598These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6599
6600@table @code
6601@kindex set print
6602@item set print address
6603@itemx set print address on
6604@cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6605@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6606traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6607even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6608is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6609@code{set print address on}:
6610
6611@smallexample
6612@group
6613(@value{GDBP}) f
6614#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6615 at input.c:530
6616530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6617@end group
6618@end smallexample
6619
6620@item set print address off
6621Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6622this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6623
6624@smallexample
6625@group
6626(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6627(@value{GDBP}) f
6628#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6629530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6630@end group
6631@end smallexample
6632
6633You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6634dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6635@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6636all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6637
6638@kindex show print
6639@item show print address
6640Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6641@end table
6642
6643When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6644closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6645identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6646source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6647@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6648you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6649it prints a symbolic address:
6650
6651@table @code
6652@item set print symbol-filename on
6653@cindex source file and line of a symbol
6654@cindex symbol, source file and line
6655Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6656symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6657
6658@item set print symbol-filename off
6659Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6660default.
6661
6662@item show print symbol-filename
6663Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6664line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6665@end table
6666
6667Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6668numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6669number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6670
6671Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6672printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6673
6674@table @code
6675@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6676@cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6677Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6678offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6679@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6680to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6681
6682@item show print max-symbolic-offset
6683Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6684symbolic address.
6685@end table
6686
6687@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6688@cindex pointer, finding referent
6689If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6690@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6691and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6692@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6693For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6694at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6695
6696@smallexample
6697(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6698(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6699$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6700@end smallexample
6701
6702@quotation
6703@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6704does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6705the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6706@end quotation
6707
6708Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6709
6710@table @code
6711@item set print array
6712@itemx set print array on
6713@cindex pretty print arrays
6714Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6715but uses more space. The default is off.
6716
6717@item set print array off
6718Return to compressed format for arrays.
6719
6720@item show print array
6721Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6722arrays.
6723
6724@cindex print array indexes
6725@item set print array-indexes
6726@itemx set print array-indexes on
6727Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6728convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6729index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6730
6731@item set print array-indexes off
6732Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6733
6734@item show print array-indexes
6735Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6736arrays.
6737
6738@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6739@cindex number of array elements to print
6740@cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6741Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6742If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6743printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6744This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6745When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6746Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6747
6748@item show print elements
6749Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6750If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6751
6752@item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6753@cindex printing frame argument values
6754@cindex print all frame argument values
6755@cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6756@cindex do not print frame argument values
6757This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6758when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6759values are:
6760
6761@table @code
6762@item all
6763The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6764
6765@item scalars
6766Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6767complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6768by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6769
6770@smallexample
6771#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6772 at frame-args.c:23
6773@end smallexample
6774
6775@item none
6776None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6777is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6778
6779@smallexample
6780#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6781 at frame-args.c:23
6782@end smallexample
6783@end table
6784
6785By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6786can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6787the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6788more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6789when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6790can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6791Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6792avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6793
6794@item show print frame-arguments
6795Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6796
6797@item set print repeats
6798@cindex repeated array elements
6799Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6800elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6801array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6802@code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6803identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6804themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6805be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6806
6807@item show print repeats
6808Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6809elements.
6810
6811@item set print null-stop
6812@cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6813Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6814@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6815contain only short strings.
6816The default is off.
6817
6818@item show print null-stop
6819Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6820@sc{null} character.
6821
6822@item set print pretty on
6823@cindex print structures in indented form
6824@cindex indentation in structure display
6825Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6826per line, like this:
6827
6828@smallexample
6829@group
6830$1 = @{
6831 next = 0x0,
6832 flags = @{
6833 sweet = 1,
6834 sour = 1
6835 @},
6836 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6837@}
6838@end group
6839@end smallexample
6840
6841@item set print pretty off
6842Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6843
6844@smallexample
6845@group
6846$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6847meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6848@end group
6849@end smallexample
6850
6851@noindent
6852This is the default format.
6853
6854@item show print pretty
6855Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6856
6857@item set print sevenbit-strings on
6858@cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6859@cindex octal escapes in strings
6860Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6861@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6862character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6863best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6864high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6865
6866@item set print sevenbit-strings off
6867Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6868international character sets, and is the default.
6869
6870@item show print sevenbit-strings
6871Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6872
6873@item set print union on
6874@cindex unions in structures, printing
6875Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6876and other unions. This is the default setting.
6877
6878@item set print union off
6879Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6880structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6881instead.
6882
6883@item show print union
6884Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6885structures and other unions.
6886
6887For example, given the declarations
6888
6889@smallexample
6890typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6891typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6892typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6893 Bug_forms;
6894
6895struct thing @{
6896 Species it;
6897 union @{
6898 Tree_forms tree;
6899 Bug_forms bug;
6900 @} form;
6901@};
6902
6903struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6904@end smallexample
6905
6906@noindent
6907with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6908
6909@smallexample
6910$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6911@end smallexample
6912
6913@noindent
6914and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6915
6916@smallexample
6917$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6918@end smallexample
6919
6920@noindent
6921@code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6922and in Pascal.
6923@end table
6924
6925@need 1000
6926@noindent
6927These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6928
6929@table @code
6930@cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6931@item set print demangle
6932@itemx set print demangle on
6933Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6934(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6935linkage. The default is on.
6936
6937@item show print demangle
6938Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6939
6940@item set print asm-demangle
6941@itemx set print asm-demangle on
6942Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6943in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6944The default is off.
6945
6946@item show print asm-demangle
6947Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6948or demangled form.
6949
6950@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6951@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6952@kindex set demangle-style
6953@item set demangle-style @var{style}
6954Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6955represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6956
6957@table @code
6958@item auto
6959Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6960
6961@item gnu
6962Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6963This is the default.
6964
6965@item hp
6966Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6967
6968@item lucid
6969Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6970
6971@item arm
6972Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6973@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6974debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6975require further enhancement to permit that.
6976
6977@end table
6978If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6979
6980@item show demangle-style
6981Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6982
6983@item set print object
6984@itemx set print object on
6985@cindex derived type of an object, printing
6986@cindex display derived types
6987When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6988(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6989the virtual function table.
6990
6991@item set print object off
6992Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6993virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6994
6995@item show print object
6996Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6997
6998@item set print static-members
6999@itemx set print static-members on
7000@cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7001Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7002
7003@item set print static-members off
7004Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7005
7006@item show print static-members
7007Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7008
7009@item set print pascal_static-members
7010@itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7011@cindex static members of Pascal objects
7012@cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7013Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7014
7015@item set print pascal_static-members off
7016Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7017
7018@item show print pascal_static-members
7019Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7020
7021@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7022@item set print vtbl
7023@itemx set print vtbl on
7024@cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7025@cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7026@cindex VTBL display
7027Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7028(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7029ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7030
7031@item set print vtbl off
7032Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7033
7034@item show print vtbl
7035Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7036@end table
7037
7038@node Value History
7039@section Value History
7040
7041@cindex value history
7042@cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7043Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7044@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7045Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7046(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7047When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7048since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7049symbol table.
7050
7051@cindex @code{$}
7052@cindex @code{$$}
7053@cindex history number
7054The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7055refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7056@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7057printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7058history number.
7059
7060To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7061history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7062remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7063the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7064@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7065is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7066@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7067
7068For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7069want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7070
7071@smallexample
7072p *$
7073@end smallexample
7074
7075If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
7076to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
7077
7078@smallexample
7079p *$.next
7080@end smallexample
7081
7082@noindent
7083You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
7084command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
7085
7086Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
7087@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
7088
7089@smallexample
7090print x
7091set x=5
7092@end smallexample
7093
7094@noindent
7095then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
7096remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
7097
7098@table @code
7099@kindex show values
7100@item show values
7101Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
7102This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
7103values} does not change the history.
7104
7105@item show values @var{n}
7106Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
7107
7108@item show values +
7109Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
7110values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
7111@end table
7112
7113Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
7114same effect as @samp{show values +}.
7115
7116@node Convenience Vars
7117@section Convenience Variables
7118
7119@cindex convenience variables
7120@cindex user-defined variables
7121@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
7122@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
7123exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
7124setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
7125of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
7126
7127Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
7128@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
7129the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7130(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
7131by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
7132
7133You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
7134expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
7135For example:
7136
7137@smallexample
7138set $foo = *object_ptr
7139@end smallexample
7140
7141@noindent
7142would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
7143@code{object_ptr}.
7144
7145Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
7146value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
7147value with another assignment at any time.
7148
7149Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
7150variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
7151that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
7152variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
7153
7154@table @code
7155@kindex show convenience
7156@cindex show all user variables
7157@item show convenience
7158Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
7159Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
7160
7161@kindex init-if-undefined
7162@cindex convenience variables, initializing
7163@item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
7164Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
7165for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
7166to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
7167convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
7168override default values used in a command script.
7169
7170If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
7171any side-effects do not occur.
7172@end table
7173
7174One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
7175incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
7176a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
7177
7178@smallexample
7179set $i = 0
7180print bar[$i++]->contents
7181@end smallexample
7182
7183@noindent
7184Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
7185
7186Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
7187values likely to be useful.
7188
7189@table @code
7190@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
7191@item $_
7192The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
7193the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
7194commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
7195set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
7196and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
7197except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
7198to the type of @code{$__}.
7199
7200@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
7201@item $__
7202The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
7203to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
7204to match the format in which the data was printed.
7205
7206@item $_exitcode
7207@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
7208The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
7209the program being debugged terminates.
7210@end table
7211
7212On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
7213begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
7214name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
7215
7216@node Registers
7217@section Registers
7218
7219@cindex registers
7220You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
7221with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
7222for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
7223your machine.
7224
7225@table @code
7226@kindex info registers
7227@item info registers
7228Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
7229and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7230
7231@kindex info all-registers
7232@cindex floating point registers
7233@item info all-registers
7234Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
7235and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7236
7237@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
7238Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
7239As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
7240the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
7241the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
7242@end table
7243
7244@cindex stack pointer register
7245@cindex program counter register
7246@cindex process status register
7247@cindex frame pointer register
7248@cindex standard registers
7249@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
7250expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
7251architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
7252@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
7253the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
7254pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
7255register that contains the processor status. For example,
7256you could print the program counter in hex with
7257
7258@smallexample
7259p/x $pc
7260@end smallexample
7261
7262@noindent
7263or print the instruction to be executed next with
7264
7265@smallexample
7266x/i $pc
7267@end smallexample
7268
7269@noindent
7270or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
7271one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
7272memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
7273stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
7274stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
7275regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
7276see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
7277
7278@smallexample
7279set $sp += 4
7280@end smallexample
7281
7282Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
7283your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
7284so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
7285shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
7286registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
7287can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
7288is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
7289
7290@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
7291integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
7292special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
7293registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
7294to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
7295(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
7296@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
7297
7298Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
7299means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
7300the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
7301sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
7302coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
7303programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
7304cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
7305that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
7306prints the data in both formats.
7307
7308@cindex SSE registers (x86)
7309@cindex MMX registers (x86)
7310Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7311in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7312have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7313together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7314registers in @code{struct} notation:
7315
7316@smallexample
7317(@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7318$1 = @{
7319 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7320 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7321 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7322 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7323 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7324 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7325 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7326@}
7327@end smallexample
7328
7329@noindent
7330To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7331view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7332value to a @code{struct} member:
7333
7334@smallexample
7335 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7336@end smallexample
7337
7338Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7339(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7340value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7341were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7342true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7343frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7344
7345However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7346code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7347@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7348frame makes no difference.
7349
7350@node Floating Point Hardware
7351@section Floating Point Hardware
7352@cindex floating point
7353
7354Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7355you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7356
7357@table @code
7358@kindex info float
7359@item info float
7360Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7361point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7362floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7363the ARM and x86 machines.
7364@end table
7365
7366@node Vector Unit
7367@section Vector Unit
7368@cindex vector unit
7369
7370Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7371more information about the status of the vector unit.
7372
7373@table @code
7374@kindex info vector
7375@item info vector
7376Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7377layout vary depending on the hardware.
7378@end table
7379
7380@node OS Information
7381@section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7382@cindex OS information
7383
7384@value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7385you debug your program.
7386
7387@cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7388@cindex @code{struct user} contents
7389When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7390machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7391system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7392called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7393command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7394structure.
7395
7396@table @code
7397@item info udot
7398@kindex info udot
7399Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7400kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7401contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7402the @code{examine} command.
7403@end table
7404
7405@cindex auxiliary vector
7406@cindex vector, auxiliary
7407Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7408startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7409specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7410binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7411hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7412identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7413Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7414@value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7415targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7416support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7417@ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7418
7419@table @code
7420@kindex info auxv
7421@item info auxv
7422Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7423live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7424numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7425tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7426pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7427most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7428an unrecognized tag.
7429@end table
7430
7431
7432@node Memory Region Attributes
7433@section Memory Region Attributes
7434@cindex memory region attributes
7435
7436@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7437required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7438attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7439accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7440target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7441fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7442user can override the fetched regions.
7443
7444Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7445memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7446accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7447been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7448all memory.
7449
7450When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7451to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7452
7453@table @code
7454@kindex mem
7455@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7456Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7457attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7458monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7459case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7460(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7461
7462@item mem auto
7463Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7464regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7465
7466@kindex delete mem
7467@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7468Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7469monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7470
7471@kindex disable mem
7472@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7473Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7474A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7475It may be enabled again later.
7476
7477@kindex enable mem
7478@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7479Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7480
7481@kindex info mem
7482@item info mem
7483Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7484for each region:
7485
7486@table @emph
7487@item Memory Region Number
7488@item Enabled or Disabled.
7489Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7490Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7491
7492@item Lo Address
7493The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7494
7495@item Hi Address
7496The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7497
7498@item Attributes
7499The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7500@end table
7501@end table
7502
7503
7504@subsection Attributes
7505
7506@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7507The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7508write accesses to a memory region.
7509
7510While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7511memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7512etc.@: from accessing memory.
7513
7514@table @code
7515@item ro
7516Memory is read only.
7517@item wo
7518Memory is write only.
7519@item rw
7520Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7521@end table
7522
7523@subsubsection Memory Access Size
7524The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7525accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7526require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7527specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7528
7529@table @code
7530@item 8
7531Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7532@item 16
7533Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7534@item 32
7535Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7536@item 64
7537Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7538@end table
7539
7540@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7541@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7542@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7543@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7544@c
7545@c @table @code
7546@c @item hwbreak
7547@c Always use hardware breakpoints
7548@c @item swbreak (default)
7549@c @end table
7550
7551@subsubsection Data Cache
7552The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7553memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7554protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7555does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7556registers.
7557
7558@table @code
7559@item cache
7560Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7561@item nocache
7562Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7563@end table
7564
7565@subsection Memory Access Checking
7566@value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7567not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7568regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7569better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7570
7571@table @code
7572@kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7573@item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7574If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7575explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7576to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7577memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7578treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7579The default value is @code{on}.
7580@kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7581@item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7582Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7583@end table
7584
7585
7586@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7587@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7588@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7589@c
7590@c @table @code
7591@c @item verify
7592@c @item noverify (default)
7593@c @end table
7594
7595@node Dump/Restore Files
7596@section Copy Between Memory and a File
7597@cindex dump/restore files
7598@cindex append data to a file
7599@cindex dump data to a file
7600@cindex restore data from a file
7601
7602You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7603@code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7604@code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7605@code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7606memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7607Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7608files.
7609
7610@table @code
7611
7612@kindex dump
7613@item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7614@itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7615Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7616or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7617
7618The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7619@table @code
7620@item binary
7621Raw binary form.
7622@item ihex
7623Intel hex format.
7624@item srec
7625Motorola S-record format.
7626@item tekhex
7627Tektronix Hex format.
7628@end table
7629
7630@value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7631@sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7632@var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7633form.
7634
7635@kindex append
7636@item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7637@itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7638Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7639or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7640(@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7641
7642@kindex restore
7643@item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7644Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7645@code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7646file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7647must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7648
7649If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7650contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7651they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7652a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7653from that location.
7654
7655If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7656file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7657These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7658the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7659
7660@end table
7661
7662@node Core File Generation
7663@section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7664@cindex dump core from inferior
7665
7666A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7667image of a running process and its process status (register values
7668etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7669crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7670automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7671the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7672the post-mortem debugging mode.
7673
7674Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7675are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7676@value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7677
7678@table @code
7679@kindex gcore
7680@kindex generate-core-file
7681@item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7682@itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7683Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7684@var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7685specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7686@var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7687
7688Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7689this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7690@end table
7691
7692@node Character Sets
7693@section Character Sets
7694@cindex character sets
7695@cindex charset
7696@cindex translating between character sets
7697@cindex host character set
7698@cindex target character set
7699
7700If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7701represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7702@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7703you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7704character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7705@dfn{target character set}.
7706
7707For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7708uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7709remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7710running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7711then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7712@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7713target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7714@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7715character and string literals in expressions.
7716
7717@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7718the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7719target-charset} command, described below.
7720
7721Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7722support:
7723
7724@table @code
7725@item set target-charset @var{charset}
7726@kindex set target-charset
7727Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7728character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7729@code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7730list the target character sets it supports.
7731@end table
7732
7733@table @code
7734@item set host-charset @var{charset}
7735@kindex set host-charset
7736Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7737
7738By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7739system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7740@code{set host-charset} command.
7741
7742@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7743set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7744indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7745@code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7746list the host character sets it supports.
7747
7748@item set charset @var{charset}
7749@kindex set charset
7750Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7751above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7752@value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7753for both host and target.
7754
7755
7756@item show charset
7757@kindex show charset
7758Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7759
7760@itemx show host-charset
7761@kindex show host-charset
7762Show the name of the current host charset.
7763
7764@itemx show target-charset
7765@kindex show target-charset
7766Show the name of the current target charset.
7767
7768@end table
7769
7770@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7771sets:
7772
7773@table @code
7774
7775@item ASCII
7776@cindex ASCII character set
7777Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7778character set.
7779
7780@item ISO-8859-1
7781@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7782@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7783The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7784characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7785this as its host character set.
7786
7787@item EBCDIC-US
7788@itemx IBM1047
7789@cindex EBCDIC character set
7790@cindex IBM1047 character set
7791Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7792mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7793@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7794
7795@end table
7796
7797Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7798@value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7799encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7800
7801Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7802Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7803@file{charset-test.c}:
7804
7805@smallexample
7806#include <stdio.h>
7807
7808char ascii_hello[]
7809 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7810 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7811char ibm1047_hello[]
7812 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7813 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7814
7815main ()
7816@{
7817 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7818@}
7819@end smallexample
7820
7821In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7822containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7823encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7824
7825We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7826
7827@smallexample
7828$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7829$ gdb -nw charset-test
7830GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7831Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7832@dots{}
7833(@value{GDBP})
7834@end smallexample
7835
7836We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7837@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7838strings:
7839
7840@smallexample
7841(@value{GDBP}) show charset
7842The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7843(@value{GDBP})
7844@end smallexample
7845
7846For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7847initial character set:
7848@smallexample
7849(@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7850(@value{GDBP}) show charset
7851The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7852(@value{GDBP})
7853@end smallexample
7854
7855Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7856host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7857characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7858them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7859@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7860
7861@smallexample
7862(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7863$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7864(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7865$2 = 72 'H'
7866(@value{GDBP})
7867@end smallexample
7868
7869@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7870literals you use in expressions:
7871
7872@smallexample
7873(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7874$3 = 43 '+'
7875(@value{GDBP})
7876@end smallexample
7877
7878The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7879character.
7880
7881@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7882target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7883character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7884
7885@smallexample
7886(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7887$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7888(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7889$5 = 200 '\310'
7890(@value{GDBP})
7891@end smallexample
7892
7893If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7894@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7895
7896@smallexample
7897(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7898ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7899(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7900@end smallexample
7901
7902We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7903program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7904@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7905target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7906@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7907
7908@smallexample
7909(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7910(@value{GDBP}) show charset
7911The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7912The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7913(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7914$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7915(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7916$7 = 72 '\110'
7917(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7918$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7919(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7920$9 = 200 'H'
7921(@value{GDBP})
7922@end smallexample
7923
7924As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7925string literals you use in expressions:
7926
7927@smallexample
7928(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7929$10 = 78 '+'
7930(@value{GDBP})
7931@end smallexample
7932
7933The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7934character.
7935
7936@node Caching Remote Data
7937@section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7938@cindex caching data of remote targets
7939
7940@value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7941remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7942performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7943bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7944@value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7945registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7946volatile registers are in use.
7947
7948@table @code
7949@kindex set remotecache
7950@item set remotecache on
7951@itemx set remotecache off
7952Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7953caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7954
7955@kindex show remotecache
7956@item show remotecache
7957Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7958
7959@kindex info dcache
7960@item info dcache
7961Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7962information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7963each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7964state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7965the data cache operation.
7966@end table
7967
7968@node Searching Memory
7969@section Search Memory
7970@cindex searching memory
7971
7972Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
7973@code{find} command.
7974
7975@table @code
7976@kindex find
7977@item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
7978@itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
7979Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
7980etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
7981@var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
7982@end table
7983
7984@var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
7985They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
7986
7987@table @r
7988@item @var{s}, search query size
7989The size of each search query value.
7990
7991@table @code
7992@item b
7993bytes
7994@item h
7995halfwords (two bytes)
7996@item w
7997words (four bytes)
7998@item g
7999giant words (eight bytes)
8000@end table
8001
8002All values are interpreted in the current language.
8003This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8004then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8005
8006If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8007value's type in the current language.
8008This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8009pattern as a mixture of types.
8010Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8011a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8012which is typically four bytes.
8013
8014@item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8015The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8016@end table
8017
8018You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8019 (@code{"}).
8020The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8021regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8022
8023The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8024number of matches found.
8025
8026The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8027@samp{$_}.
8028A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8029
8030For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8031
8032@smallexample
8033void
8034hello ()
8035@{
8036 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
8037 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
8038 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
8039 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
8040 printf ("%s\n", hello);
8041@}
8042@end smallexample
8043
8044@noindent
8045you get during debugging:
8046
8047@smallexample
8048(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
80490x804956d <hello.1620+6>
80501 pattern found
8051(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
80520x8049567 <hello.1620>
80530x804956d <hello.1620+6>
80542 patterns found
8055(gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
80560x8049567 <hello.1620>
80571 pattern found
8058(gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
80590x8049560 <mixed.1625>
80601 pattern found
8061(gdb) print $numfound
8062$1 = 1
8063(gdb) print $_
8064$2 = (void *) 0x8049560
8065@end smallexample
8066
8067@node Macros
8068@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
8069
8070Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
8071``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
8072@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
8073the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
8074where it was defined.
8075
8076You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
8077with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
8078include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
8079with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
8080
8081A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
8082and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
8083points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
8084no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
8085uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
8086@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
8087see @ref{List}.
8088
8089At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
8090token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
8091variable-arity macros.
8092
8093Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
8094macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
8095the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
8096
8097@table @code
8098
8099@kindex macro expand
8100@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
8101@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
8102@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
8103@item macro expand @var{expression}
8104@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
8105Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
8106@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
8107not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
8108it can be any string of tokens.
8109
8110@kindex macro exp1
8111@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
8112@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
8113@cindex expand macro once
8114@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
8115expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
8116@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
8117left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
8118particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
8119expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
8120parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
8121can be any string of tokens.
8122
8123@kindex info macro
8124@cindex macro definition, showing
8125@cindex definition, showing a macro's
8126@item info macro @var{macro}
8127Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
8128source location where that definition was established.
8129
8130@kindex macro define
8131@cindex user-defined macros
8132@cindex defining macros interactively
8133@cindex macros, user-defined
8134@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
8135@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
8136Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
8137invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
8138@var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
8139``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
8140defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
8141@var{arglist}.
8142
8143A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
8144expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
8145@code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
8146all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
8147as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
8148
8149@kindex macro undef
8150@item macro undef @var{macro}
8151Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
8152This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
8153define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
8154in the program being debugged.
8155
8156@kindex macro list
8157@item macro list
8158List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
8159@end table
8160
8161@cindex macros, example of debugging with
8162Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
8163show our source files:
8164
8165@smallexample
8166$ cat sample.c
8167#include <stdio.h>
8168#include "sample.h"
8169
8170#define M 42
8171#define ADD(x) (M + x)
8172
8173main ()
8174@{
8175#define N 28
8176 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8177#undef N
8178 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8179#define N 1729
8180 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8181@}
8182$ cat sample.h
8183#define Q <
8184$
8185@end smallexample
8186
8187Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
8188We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
8189compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
8190information.
8191
8192@smallexample
8193$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
8194$
8195@end smallexample
8196
8197Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
8198
8199@smallexample
8200$ gdb -nw sample
8201GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
8202Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8203GDB is free software, @dots{}
8204(@value{GDBP})
8205@end smallexample
8206
8207We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
8208program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
8209to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
8210
8211@smallexample
8212(@value{GDBP}) list main
82133
82144 #define M 42
82155 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
82166
82177 main ()
82188 @{
82199 #define N 28
822010 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
822111 #undef N
822212 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8223(@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
8224Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
8225#define ADD(x) (M + x)
8226(@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
8227Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
8228 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
8229#define Q <
8230(@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
8231expands to: (42 + 1)
8232(@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
8233expands to: once (M + 1)
8234(@value{GDBP})
8235@end smallexample
8236
8237In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
8238the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
8239@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
8240which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
8241
8242Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
8243force at the source line of the current stack frame:
8244
8245@smallexample
8246(@value{GDBP}) break main
8247Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
8248(@value{GDBP}) run
8249Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
8250
8251Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
825210 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8253(@value{GDBP})
8254@end smallexample
8255
8256At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
8257
8258@smallexample
8259(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8260Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
8261#define N 28
8262(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8263expands to: 28 < 42
8264(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8265$1 = 1
8266(@value{GDBP})
8267@end smallexample
8268
8269As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
8270give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
8271thereof) in force at each point:
8272
8273@smallexample
8274(@value{GDBP}) next
8275Hello, world!
827612 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8277(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8278The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
8279at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
8280(@value{GDBP}) next
8281We're so creative.
828214 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8283(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8284Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
8285#define N 1729
8286(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8287expands to: 1729 < 42
8288(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8289$2 = 0
8290(@value{GDBP})
8291@end smallexample
8292
8293
8294@node Tracepoints
8295@chapter Tracepoints
8296@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
8297@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
8298
8299@cindex tracepoints
8300In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
8301the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
8302anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
8303depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
8304might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
8305fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
8306to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8307
8308Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8309specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8310arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8311Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8312those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8313expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8314for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8315a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8316in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8317values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8318unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8319
8320The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8321targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8322how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8323remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8324support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8325packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8326Packets}.
8327
8328This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8329
8330@menu
8331* Set Tracepoints::
8332* Analyze Collected Data::
8333* Tracepoint Variables::
8334@end menu
8335
8336@node Set Tracepoints
8337@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8338
8339Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8340tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
8341tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
8342breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
8343one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
8344tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
8345work on.
8346
8347For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8348of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8349it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8350local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8351commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8352tracepoint was hit.
8353
8354This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8355conditions and actions.
8356
8357@menu
8358* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8359* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8360* Tracepoint Passcounts::
8361* Tracepoint Actions::
8362* Listing Tracepoints::
8363* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8364@end menu
8365
8366@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8367@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8368
8369@table @code
8370@cindex set tracepoint
8371@kindex trace
8372@item trace
8373The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8374Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
8375the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
8376defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
8377debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
8378program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
8379doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
8380cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
8381running.
8382
8383Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8384
8385@smallexample
8386(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8387
8388(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8389
8390(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8391
8392(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8393
8394(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8395@end smallexample
8396
8397@noindent
8398You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8399
8400@vindex $tpnum
8401@cindex last tracepoint number
8402@cindex recent tracepoint number
8403@cindex tracepoint number
8404The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
8405of the most recently set tracepoint.
8406
8407@kindex delete tracepoint
8408@cindex tracepoint deletion
8409@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8410Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
8411default is to delete all tracepoints.
8412
8413Examples:
8414
8415@smallexample
8416(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
8417
8418(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
8419@end smallexample
8420
8421@noindent
8422You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
8423@end table
8424
8425@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8426@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8427
8428@table @code
8429@kindex disable tracepoint
8430@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8431Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
8432@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
8433the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
8434a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
8435
8436@kindex enable tracepoint
8437@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8438Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8439tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8440run.
8441@end table
8442
8443@node Tracepoint Passcounts
8444@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8445
8446@table @code
8447@kindex passcount
8448@cindex tracepoint pass count
8449@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8450Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8451automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8452@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8453the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8454@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8455passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8456given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8457user.
8458
8459Examples:
8460
8461@smallexample
8462(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8463@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8464
8465(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8466@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8467(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8468(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8469(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8470(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8471(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8472(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8473@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8474@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8475@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8476@end smallexample
8477@end table
8478
8479@node Tracepoint Actions
8480@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8481
8482@table @code
8483@kindex actions
8484@cindex tracepoint actions
8485@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8486This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8487tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8488specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8489recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8490@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8491actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8492terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8493far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8494@code{while-stepping}.
8495
8496@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8497To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8498and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8499
8500@smallexample
8501(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8502
8503(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8504
8505(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8506@end smallexample
8507
8508In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8509commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8510hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8511following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8512followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8513@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8514@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8515@code{end} command.
8516
8517@smallexample
8518(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8519(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8520Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8521> collect bar,baz
8522> collect $regs
8523> while-stepping 12
8524 > collect $fp, $sp
8525 > end
8526end
8527@end smallexample
8528
8529@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8530@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8531Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8532This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8533In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8534special arguments are supported:
8535
8536@table @code
8537@item $regs
8538collect all registers
8539
8540@item $args
8541collect all function arguments
8542
8543@item $locals
8544collect all local variables.
8545@end table
8546
8547You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8548with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8549arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8550
8551The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8552particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8553
8554@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8555@item while-stepping @var{n}
8556Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8557new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8558followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8559its own @code{end} command):
8560
8561@smallexample
8562> while-stepping 12
8563 > collect $regs, myglobal
8564 > end
8565>
8566@end smallexample
8567
8568@noindent
8569You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8570@code{stepping}.
8571@end table
8572
8573@node Listing Tracepoints
8574@subsection Listing Tracepoints
8575
8576@table @code
8577@kindex info tracepoints
8578@kindex info tp
8579@cindex information about tracepoints
8580@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8581Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8582a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8583defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8584shown:
8585
8586@itemize @bullet
8587@item
8588its number
8589@item
8590whether it is enabled or disabled
8591@item
8592its address
8593@item
8594its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8595@item
8596its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8597@item
8598where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8599@item
8600its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8601@end itemize
8602
8603@smallexample
8604(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8605Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
86061 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
86072 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
86083 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8609(@value{GDBP})
8610@end smallexample
8611
8612@noindent
8613This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8614@end table
8615
8616@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8617@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8618
8619@table @code
8620@kindex tstart
8621@cindex start a new trace experiment
8622@cindex collected data discarded
8623@item tstart
8624This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8625begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8626the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8627experiment.
8628
8629@kindex tstop
8630@cindex stop a running trace experiment
8631@item tstop
8632This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8633stops collecting data.
8634
8635@strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8636automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8637(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8638
8639@kindex tstatus
8640@cindex status of trace data collection
8641@cindex trace experiment, status of
8642@item tstatus
8643This command displays the status of the current trace data
8644collection.
8645@end table
8646
8647Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8648
8649@smallexample
8650(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8651(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8652Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8653> collect $regs,$locals,$args
8654> while-stepping 11
8655 > collect $regs
8656 > end
8657> end
8658(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8659 [time passes @dots{}]
8660(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8661@end smallexample
8662
8663
8664@node Analyze Collected Data
8665@section Using the Collected Data
8666
8667After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8668for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8669collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8670snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8671consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8672examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8673specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8674snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8675registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8676rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8677debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8678(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8679behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8680when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8681the buffer will fail.
8682
8683@menu
8684* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8685* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8686* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8687@end menu
8688
8689@node tfind
8690@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8691
8692@kindex tfind
8693@cindex select trace snapshot
8694@cindex find trace snapshot
8695The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8696@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8697counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8698snapshot is selected.
8699
8700Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8701
8702@table @code
8703@item tfind start
8704Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8705@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8706
8707@item tfind none
8708Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8709
8710@item tfind end
8711Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8712
8713@item tfind
8714No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8715
8716@item tfind -
8717Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8718retracing earlier steps.
8719
8720@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8721Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8722proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8723argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8724for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8725
8726@item tfind pc @var{addr}
8727Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8728program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8729snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8730snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8731
8732@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8733Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8734addresses.
8735
8736@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8737Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8738@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8739
8740@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8741Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8742the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8743that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8744trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8745next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8746@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8747stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8748@end table
8749
8750The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8751designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8752instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8753snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8754trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8755simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8756snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8757@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8758The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8759for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8760no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8761(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8762no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8763tracepoint as the current one.
8764
8765In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8766these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8767scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8768you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8769registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8770
8771@smallexample
8772(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8773(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8774> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8775 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8776> tfind
8777> end
8778
8779Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8780Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8781Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8782Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8783Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8784Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8785Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8786Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8787Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8788Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8789Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8790@end smallexample
8791
8792Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8793the buffer:
8794
8795@smallexample
8796(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8797(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8798> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8799> tfind line
8800> end
8801
8802Frame 0, X = 1
8803Frame 7, X = 2
8804Frame 13, X = 255
8805@end smallexample
8806
8807@node tdump
8808@subsection @code{tdump}
8809@kindex tdump
8810@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8811@cindex tracepoint data, display
8812
8813This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8814the current trace snapshot.
8815
8816@smallexample
8817(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8818(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8819Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8820> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8821> end
8822
8823(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8824
8825(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8826#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8827at gdb_test.c:444
8828444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8829
8830(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8831Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8832d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8833d1 0x18 24
8834d2 0x80 128
8835d3 0x33 51
8836d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8837d5 0x22 34
8838d6 0xe0 224
8839d7 0x380035 3670069
8840a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8841a1 0x3000668 50333288
8842a2 0x100 256
8843a3 0x322000 3284992
8844a4 0x3000698 50333336
8845a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8846fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8847sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8848ps 0x0 0
8849pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8850fpcontrol 0x0 0
8851fpstatus 0x0 0
8852fpiaddr 0x0 0
8853p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8854p1 = (void *) 0x11
8855p2 = (void *) 0x22
8856p3 = (void *) 0x33
8857p4 = (void *) 0x44
8858p5 = (void *) 0x55
8859p6 = (void *) 0x66
8860gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8861
8862(@value{GDBP})
8863@end smallexample
8864
8865@node save-tracepoints
8866@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8867@kindex save-tracepoints
8868@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8869
8870This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8871their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8872suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8873tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8874Files}).
8875
8876@node Tracepoint Variables
8877@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8878@cindex tracepoint variables
8879@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8880
8881@table @code
8882@vindex $trace_frame
8883@item (int) $trace_frame
8884The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8885snapshot is selected.
8886
8887@vindex $tracepoint
8888@item (int) $tracepoint
8889The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8890
8891@vindex $trace_line
8892@item (int) $trace_line
8893The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8894
8895@vindex $trace_file
8896@item (char []) $trace_file
8897The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8898
8899@vindex $trace_func
8900@item (char []) $trace_func
8901The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8902@end table
8903
8904Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8905use @code{output} instead.
8906
8907Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8908stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8909data.
8910
8911@smallexample
8912(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8913
8914(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8915> output $trace_file
8916> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8917> tfind
8918> end
8919@end smallexample
8920
8921@node Overlays
8922@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8923@cindex overlays
8924
8925If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8926memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8927problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8928use overlays.
8929
8930@menu
8931* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8932* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8933* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8934 mapped by asking the inferior.
8935* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8936@end menu
8937
8938@node How Overlays Work
8939@section How Overlays Work
8940@cindex mapped overlays
8941@cindex unmapped overlays
8942@cindex load address, overlay's
8943@cindex mapped address
8944@cindex overlay area
8945
8946Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8947kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8948other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8949management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8950adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8951
8952One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8953independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8954@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8955their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8956instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8957largest overlay as well.
8958
8959Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8960overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8961for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8962there.
8963
8964@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8965@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8966@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8967
8968@smallexample
8969@group
8970 Data Instruction Larger
8971Address Space Address Space Address Space
8972+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8973| | | | | |
8974+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8975| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8976| variables | | program | | +-----------+
8977| and heap | | | | | |
8978+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8979| | +-----------+ | | | load address
8980+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8981 | | | | | |
8982 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8983 address | | | | | |
8984 | overlay | <-' | | |
8985 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8986 | | <---. | | load address
8987 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8988 | | | |
8989 +-----------+ | |
8990 +-----------+
8991 | |
8992 +-----------+
8993
8994 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8995@end group
8996@end smallexample
8997
8998The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8999and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
9000its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
9001Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
9002may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
9003data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
9004program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
9005program and the overlay area.
9006
9007An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
9008@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
9009instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
9010in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
9011is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
9012the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
9013called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
9014
9015Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
9016program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
9017global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
9018
9019@itemize @bullet
9020
9021@item
9022Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
9023must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
9024return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
9025overlay, and your program will probably crash.
9026
9027@item
9028If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
9029will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
9030your program's performance.
9031
9032@item
9033The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
9034overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
9035mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
9036and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
9037You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
9038addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
9039ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
9040
9041@item
9042The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
9043to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
9044instruction and data spaces.
9045
9046@end itemize
9047
9048The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
9049improved in many ways:
9050
9051@itemize @bullet
9052
9053@item
9054If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
9055hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
9056contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
9057This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
9058area in the usual way.
9059
9060@item
9061If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
9062overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
9063
9064@item
9065You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
9066general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
9067code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
9068return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
9069the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
9070must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
9071different data overlay into the same mapped area.
9072
9073@end itemize
9074
9075
9076@node Overlay Commands
9077@section Overlay Commands
9078
9079To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
9080correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
9081virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
9082mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
9083@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
9084variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
9085
9086@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
9087you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
9088
9089@table @code
9090@item overlay off
9091@kindex overlay
9092Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
9093disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
9094always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
9095overlay support is disabled.
9096
9097@item overlay manual
9098@cindex manual overlay debugging
9099Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9100relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
9101using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
9102commands described below.
9103
9104@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
9105@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
9106@cindex map an overlay
9107Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
9108be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
9109overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
9110functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
9111that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
9112@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
9113
9114@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
9115@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
9116@cindex unmap an overlay
9117Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
9118must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
9119When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
9120overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
9121
9122@item overlay auto
9123Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9124consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
9125to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
9126Overlay Debugging}.
9127
9128@item overlay load-target
9129@itemx overlay load
9130@cindex reloading the overlay table
9131Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
9132re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
9133stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
9134overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
9135useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
9136
9137@item overlay list-overlays
9138@itemx overlay list
9139@cindex listing mapped overlays
9140Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
9141addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
9142
9143@end table
9144
9145Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
9146of the function the address falls in:
9147
9148@smallexample
9149(@value{GDBP}) print main
9150$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
9151@end smallexample
9152@noindent
9153When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
9154unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
9155asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
9156unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
9157
9158@smallexample
9159(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9160No sections are mapped.
9161(@value{GDBP}) print foo
9162$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
9163@end smallexample
9164@noindent
9165When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
9166name normally:
9167
9168@smallexample
9169(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9170Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
9171 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
9172(@value{GDBP}) print foo
9173$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
9174@end smallexample
9175
9176When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
9177address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
9178overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
9179@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
9180code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
9181
9182@itemize @bullet
9183@item
9184@cindex breakpoints in overlays
9185@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
9186You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
9187@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
9188@item
9189@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
9190unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
9191overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
9192you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
9193breakpoints properly.
9194@end itemize
9195
9196
9197@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
9198@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
9199@cindex automatic overlay debugging
9200
9201@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
9202are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
9203inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
9204@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
9205looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
9206current state of the overlays.
9207
9208Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
9209@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
9210
9211@table @asis
9212
9213@item @code{_ovly_table}:
9214This variable must be an array of the following structures:
9215
9216@smallexample
9217struct
9218@{
9219 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
9220 unsigned long vma;
9221
9222 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
9223 unsigned long size;
9224
9225 /* The overlay's load address. */
9226 unsigned long lma;
9227
9228 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
9229 zero otherwise. */
9230 unsigned long mapped;
9231@}
9232@end smallexample
9233
9234@item @code{_novlys}:
9235This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
9236number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
9237
9238@end table
9239
9240To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
9241looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
9242@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
9243executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
9244the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
9245currently mapped.
9246
9247In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
9248@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
9249will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
9250calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
9251will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
9252are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
9253in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
9254overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
9255are not being executed.
9256
9257@node Overlay Sample Program
9258@section Overlay Sample Program
9259@cindex overlay example program
9260
9261When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
9262at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
9263addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
9264Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
9265since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
9266architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
9267portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
9268
9269However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
9270program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
9271suite. The program consists of the following files from
9272@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
9273
9274@table @file
9275@item overlays.c
9276The main program file.
9277@item ovlymgr.c
9278A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
9279@item foo.c
9280@itemx bar.c
9281@itemx baz.c
9282@itemx grbx.c
9283Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
9284@item d10v.ld
9285@itemx m32r.ld
9286Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
9287and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
9288@end table
9289
9290You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
9291cross-compiler like this:
9292
9293@smallexample
9294$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
9295$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
9296$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
9297$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
9298$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
9299$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
9300$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
9301 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
9302@end smallexample
9303
9304The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
9305you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
9306target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9307
9308
9309@node Languages
9310@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9311@cindex languages
9312
9313Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9314rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9315dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9316Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9317represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9318@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9319
9320@cindex working language
9321Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9322allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9323native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9324consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9325language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9326language}.
9327
9328@menu
9329* Setting:: Switching between source languages
9330* Show:: Displaying the language
9331* Checks:: Type and range checks
9332* Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9333* Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9334@end menu
9335
9336@node Setting
9337@section Switching Between Source Languages
9338
9339There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9340set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9341@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9342defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9343used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9344are printed, etc.
9345
9346In addition to the working language, every source file that
9347@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9348file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9349source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9350language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
9351controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
9352show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
9353set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
9354set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
9355Displaying the Language}.
9356
9357This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
9358as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
9359another language. In that case, make the
9360program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
9361@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
9362program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
9363
9364@menu
9365* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
9366* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
9367* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
9368@end menu
9369
9370@node Filenames
9371@subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
9372
9373If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
9374@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
9375
9376@table @file
9377@item .ada
9378@itemx .ads
9379@itemx .adb
9380@itemx .a
9381Ada source file.
9382
9383@item .c
9384C source file
9385
9386@item .C
9387@itemx .cc
9388@itemx .cp
9389@itemx .cpp
9390@itemx .cxx
9391@itemx .c++
9392C@t{++} source file
9393
9394@item .m
9395Objective-C source file
9396
9397@item .f
9398@itemx .F
9399Fortran source file
9400
9401@item .mod
9402Modula-2 source file
9403
9404@item .s
9405@itemx .S
9406Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
9407@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
9408@end table
9409
9410In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
9411extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
9412
9413@node Manually
9414@subsection Setting the Working Language
9415
9416If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
9417expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
9418your program.
9419
9420@kindex set language
9421If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
9422command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
9423a language, such as
9424@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
9425For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
9426
9427Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
9428language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
9429to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
9430source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
9431languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
9432source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
9433command such as:
9434
9435@smallexample
9436print a = b + c
9437@end smallexample
9438
9439@noindent
9440might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9441@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9442printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9443@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9444
9445@node Automatically
9446@subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9447
9448To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9449@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9450then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9451frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9452working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9453frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9454or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9455does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9456not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9457
9458This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9459entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9460written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9461a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9462case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9463
9464@node Show
9465@section Displaying the Language
9466
9467The following commands help you find out which language is the
9468working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9469
9470@table @code
9471@item show language
9472@kindex show language
9473Display the current working language. This is the
9474language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9475build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9476
9477@item info frame
9478@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9479Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9480working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9481@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9482information listed here.
9483
9484@item info source
9485@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9486Display the source language of this source file.
9487@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9488information listed here.
9489@end table
9490
9491In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9492not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9493with a language explicitly:
9494
9495@table @code
9496@item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9497@kindex set extension-language
9498Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9499assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9500
9501@item info extensions
9502@kindex info extensions
9503List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9504@end table
9505
9506@node Checks
9507@section Type and Range Checking
9508
9509@quotation
9510@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9511checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9512section documents the intended facilities.
9513@end quotation
9514@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9515
9516Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9517errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9518checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9519sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9520these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9521by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9522errors when your program is running.
9523
9524@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9525Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9526it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9527evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9528working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9529automatically based on your program's source language.
9530@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9531settings of supported languages.
9532
9533@menu
9534* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9535* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9536@end menu
9537
9538@cindex type checking
9539@cindex checks, type
9540@node Type Checking
9541@subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9542
9543Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9544arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9545otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9546errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9547
9548@smallexample
95491 + 2 @result{} 3
9550@exdent but
9551@error{} 1 + 2.3
9552@end smallexample
9553
9554The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9555type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9556
9557For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9558@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9559to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9560or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9561but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9562these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9563also issues a warning.
9564
9565Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9566related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9567For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9568a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9569with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9570the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9571
9572Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9573instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9574operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9575represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9576operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9577details on specific languages.
9578
9579@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9580
9581@kindex set check type
9582@kindex show check type
9583@table @code
9584@item set check type auto
9585Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9586@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9587each language.
9588
9589@item set check type on
9590@itemx set check type off
9591Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9592current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9593match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9594evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9595message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9596
9597@item set check type warn
9598Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9599evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9600be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9601numbers and structures.
9602
9603@item show type
9604Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9605is setting it automatically.
9606@end table
9607
9608@cindex range checking
9609@cindex checks, range
9610@node Range Checking
9611@subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9612
9613In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9614bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9615checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9616computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9617not exceed the bounds of the array.
9618
9619For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9620@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9621always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9622warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9623
9624A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9625array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9626of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9627error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9628result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9629the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9630
9631@smallexample
9632@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9633@end smallexample
9634
9635This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9636specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9637Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9638
9639@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9640
9641@kindex set check range
9642@kindex show check range
9643@table @code
9644@item set check range auto
9645Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9646@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9647each language.
9648
9649@item set check range on
9650@itemx set check range off
9651Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9652current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9653match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9654then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9655
9656@item set check range warn
9657Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9658but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9659expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9660memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9661systems).
9662
9663@item show range
9664Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9665being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9666@end table
9667
9668@node Supported Languages
9669@section Supported Languages
9670
9671@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9672assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9673@c This is false ...
9674Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9675language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9676and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9677,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9678language.
9679
9680The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9681supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9682tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9683@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9684formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9685books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9686language reference or tutorial.
9687
9688@menu
9689* C:: C and C@t{++}
9690* Objective-C:: Objective-C
9691* Fortran:: Fortran
9692* Pascal:: Pascal
9693* Modula-2:: Modula-2
9694* Ada:: Ada
9695@end menu
9696
9697@node C
9698@subsection C and C@t{++}
9699
9700@cindex C and C@t{++}
9701@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9702
9703Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9704to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9705together.
9706
9707@cindex C@t{++}
9708@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9709@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9710The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9711compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9712effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9713C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9714compiler (@code{aCC}).
9715
9716For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9717format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9718format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9719command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9720@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9721gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9722
9723@menu
9724* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9725* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9726* C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9727* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9728* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9729* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9730* Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9731* Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9732@end menu
9733
9734@node C Operators
9735@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9736
9737@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9738
9739Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9740@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9741often defined on groups of types.
9742
9743For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9744
9745@itemize @bullet
9746
9747@item
9748@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9749specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9750
9751@item
9752@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9753@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9754
9755@item
9756@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9757
9758@item
9759@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9760
9761@end itemize
9762
9763@noindent
9764The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9765in order of increasing precedence:
9766
9767@table @code
9768@item ,
9769The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9770are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9771expression being the last expression evaluated.
9772
9773@item =
9774Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9775assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9776
9777@item @var{op}=
9778Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9779and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9780@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9781@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9782@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9783
9784@item ?:
9785The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9786of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9787integral type.
9788
9789@item ||
9790Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9791
9792@item &&
9793Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9794
9795@item |
9796Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9797
9798@item ^
9799Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9800
9801@item &
9802Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9803
9804@item ==@r{, }!=
9805Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9806expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9807
9808@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9809Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9810Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9811and non-zero for true.
9812
9813@item <<@r{, }>>
9814left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9815
9816@item @@
9817The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9818
9819@item +@r{, }-
9820Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9821pointer types.
9822
9823@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9824Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9825defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9826integral types.
9827
9828@item ++@r{, }--
9829Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9830operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9831when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9832operation takes place.
9833
9834@item *
9835Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9836@code{++}.
9837
9838@item &
9839Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9840
9841For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9842allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9843to examine the address
9844where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9845stored.
9846
9847@item -
9848Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9849precedence as @code{++}.
9850
9851@item !
9852Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9853@code{++}.
9854
9855@item ~
9856Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9857@code{++}.
9858
9859
9860@item .@r{, }->
9861Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9862@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9863pointer based on the stored type information.
9864Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9865
9866@item .*@r{, }->*
9867Dereferences of pointers to members.
9868
9869@item []
9870Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9871@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9872
9873@item ()
9874Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9875
9876@item ::
9877C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9878and @code{class} types.
9879
9880@item ::
9881Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9882(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9883above.
9884@end table
9885
9886If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9887attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9888predefined meaning.
9889
9890@node C Constants
9891@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9892
9893@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9894
9895@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9896following ways:
9897
9898@itemize @bullet
9899@item
9900Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9901specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9902by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9903@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9904@code{long} value.
9905
9906@item
9907Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9908point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9909exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9910@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9911sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9912A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9913@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9914the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9915a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9916constant.
9917
9918@item
9919Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9920integral equivalents.
9921
9922@item
9923Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9924(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9925(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9926be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9927the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9928of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9929@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9930@samp{\n} for newline.
9931
9932@item
9933String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9934double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9935above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9936a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9937characters.
9938
9939@item
9940Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9941to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9942
9943@item
9944Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9945and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9946integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9947and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9948@end itemize
9949
9950@node C Plus Plus Expressions
9951@subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9952
9953@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9954@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9955
9956@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9957@cindex C@t{++} compilers
9958@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9959@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9960@quotation
9961@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9962proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9963works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9964@value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9965@option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9966stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9967stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9968specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9969are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9970C@t{++} code.
9971@end quotation
9972
9973@enumerate
9974
9975@cindex member functions
9976@item
9977Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9978
9979@smallexample
9980count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9981@end smallexample
9982
9983@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9984@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9985@item
9986While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9987expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9988that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9989pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9990
9991@cindex call overloaded functions
9992@cindex overloaded functions, calling
9993@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9994@item
9995You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9996call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9997perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9998calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9999in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
10000default arguments.
10001
10002It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
10003promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
10004class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
10005functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
10006number of function arguments.
10007
10008Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
10009@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
10010,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
10011
10012You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
10013explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
10014@smallexample
10015p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
10016@end smallexample
10017
10018The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
10019see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
10020
10021@cindex reference declarations
10022@item
10023@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
10024them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
10025dereferenced.
10026
10027In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
10028reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
10029avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
10030The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
10031you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
10032
10033@item
10034@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
10035expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
10036one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
10037necessary, for example in an expression like
10038@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
10039resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
10040debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
10041@end enumerate
10042
10043In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
10044calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
10045objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
10046invoking user-defined operators.
10047
10048@node C Defaults
10049@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
10050
10051@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
10052
10053If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
10054both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
10055C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10056selects the working language.
10057
10058If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
10059recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
10060@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
10061these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
10062@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
10063for further details.
10064
10065@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
10066@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
10067@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
10068
10069@node C Checks
10070@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
10071
10072@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
10073
10074By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
10075is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
10076considers two variables type equivalent if:
10077
10078@itemize @bullet
10079@item
10080The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
10081enumerated tag.
10082
10083@item
10084The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
10085declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
10086
10087@ignore
10088@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
10089@c FIXME--beers?
10090@item
10091The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
10092declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
10093compilers.)
10094@end ignore
10095@end itemize
10096
10097Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
10098indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
10099that is not itself an array.
10100
10101@node Debugging C
10102@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
10103
10104The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
10105the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
10106inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
10107appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
10108
10109The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
10110with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
10111,Expressions}.
10112
10113@node Debugging C Plus Plus
10114@subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
10115
10116@cindex commands for C@t{++}
10117
10118Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
10119designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
10120
10121@table @code
10122@cindex break in overloaded functions
10123@item @r{breakpoint menus}
10124When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
10125@value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
10126locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
10127@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
10128
10129@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
10130@item rbreak @var{regex}
10131Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
10132breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
10133classes.
10134@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
10135
10136@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
10137@item catch throw
10138@itemx catch catch
10139Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
10140Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
10141
10142@cindex inheritance
10143@item ptype @var{typename}
10144Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
10145@var{typename}.
10146@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
10147
10148@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
10149@item set print demangle
10150@itemx show print demangle
10151@itemx set print asm-demangle
10152@itemx show print asm-demangle
10153Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
10154displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
10155@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10156
10157@item set print object
10158@itemx show print object
10159Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
10160@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10161
10162@item set print vtbl
10163@itemx show print vtbl
10164Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
10165@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10166(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10167ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10168
10169@kindex set overload-resolution
10170@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
10171@item set overload-resolution on
10172Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
10173is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
10174and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
10175using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
10176Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
10177If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
10178
10179@item set overload-resolution off
10180Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
10181overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10182chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
10183symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
10184overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10185searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
10186argument types.
10187
10188@kindex show overload-resolution
10189@item show overload-resolution
10190Show the current setting of overload resolution.
10191
10192@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
10193You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
10194the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
10195@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
10196also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
10197available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
10198@xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
10199@end table
10200
10201@node Decimal Floating Point
10202@subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
10203@cindex decimal floating point format
10204
10205@value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
10206decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
10207@code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
10208specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
10209
10210There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
10211Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
10212PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
10213target.
10214
10215Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
10216to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
10217(using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
10218
10219In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
10220point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
10221underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
10222
10223In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
10224to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
10225@ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
10226
10227@node Objective-C
10228@subsection Objective-C
10229
10230@cindex Objective-C
10231This section provides information about some commands and command
10232options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
10233@ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
10234few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
10235
10236@menu
10237* Method Names in Commands::
10238* The Print Command with Objective-C::
10239@end menu
10240
10241@node Method Names in Commands
10242@subsubsection Method Names in Commands
10243
10244The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
10245names as line specifications:
10246
10247@kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
10248@kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
10249@kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
10250@kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
10251@kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
10252@itemize
10253@item @code{clear}
10254@item @code{break}
10255@item @code{info line}
10256@item @code{jump}
10257@item @code{list}
10258@end itemize
10259
10260A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
10261
10262@smallexample
10263-[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
10264@end smallexample
10265
10266where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
10267plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
10268name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
10269brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
10270source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
10271instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
10272debugged, enter:
10273
10274@smallexample
10275break -[Fruit create]
10276@end smallexample
10277
10278To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
10279enter:
10280
10281@smallexample
10282list +[NSText initialize]
10283@end smallexample
10284
10285In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
10286required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
10287sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
10288is also possible to specify just a method name:
10289
10290@smallexample
10291break create
10292@end smallexample
10293
10294You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
10295your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
10296you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
10297method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
10298none apply.
10299
10300As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
10301@code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
10302
10303@smallexample
10304clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
10305@end smallexample
10306
10307@node The Print Command with Objective-C
10308@subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10309@cindex Objective-C, print objects
10310@kindex print-object
10311@kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10312
10313The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10314
10315@smallexample
10316print -[@var{object} hash]
10317@end smallexample
10318
10319@cindex print an Objective-C object description
10320@cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10321@noindent
10322will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10323and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10324@code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10325the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10326with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10327function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10328
10329@node Fortran
10330@subsection Fortran
10331@cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10332
10333@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10334currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10335
10336@cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10337Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10338among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10339functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10340will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10341underscore.
10342
10343@menu
10344* Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10345* Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10346* Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10347@end menu
10348
10349@node Fortran Operators
10350@subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
10351
10352@cindex Fortran operators and expressions
10353
10354Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10355@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
10356arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
10357
10358@table @code
10359@item **
10360The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
10361of the second one.
10362
10363@item :
10364The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
10365represent a section of array.
10366
10367@item %
10368The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
10369types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
10370this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
10371union type.
10372@end table
10373
10374@node Fortran Defaults
10375@subsubsection Fortran Defaults
10376
10377@cindex Fortran Defaults
10378
10379Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
10380default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
10381change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
10382@ref{Symbols}, for the details.
10383
10384@node Special Fortran Commands
10385@subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
10386
10387@cindex Special Fortran commands
10388
10389@value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
10390such as displaying common blocks.
10391
10392@table @code
10393@cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
10394@kindex info common
10395@item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
10396This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
10397block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
10398all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
10399printed.
10400@end table
10401
10402@node Pascal
10403@subsection Pascal
10404
10405@cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
10406Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
10407nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
10408entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
10409syntax.
10410
10411The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
10412controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
10413@xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
10414
10415@node Modula-2
10416@subsection Modula-2
10417
10418@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
10419
10420The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
10421output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
10422developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
10423attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10424to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
10425table.
10426
10427@cindex expressions in Modula-2
10428@menu
10429* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
10430* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
10431* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
10432* M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
10433* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
10434* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
10435* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10436* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10437* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10438@end menu
10439
10440@node M2 Operators
10441@subsubsection Operators
10442@cindex Modula-2 operators
10443
10444Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10445@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10446often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10447following definitions hold:
10448
10449@itemize @bullet
10450
10451@item
10452@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10453their subranges.
10454
10455@item
10456@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10457
10458@item
10459@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10460
10461@item
10462@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10463@var{type}}.
10464
10465@item
10466@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10467
10468@item
10469@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10470
10471@item
10472@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10473@end itemize
10474
10475@noindent
10476The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10477increasing precedence:
10478
10479@table @code
10480@item ,
10481Function argument or array index separator.
10482
10483@item :=
10484Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10485@var{value}.
10486
10487@item <@r{, }>
10488Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10489types.
10490
10491@item <=@r{, }>=
10492Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10493on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10494set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10495
10496@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10497Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10498Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10499available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10500comment character.
10501
10502@item IN
10503Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10504Same precedence as @code{<}.
10505
10506@item OR
10507Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10508
10509@item AND@r{, }&
10510Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10511
10512@item @@
10513The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10514
10515@item +@r{, }-
10516Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10517and difference on set types.
10518
10519@item *
10520Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10521on set types.
10522
10523@item /
10524Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10525types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10526
10527@item DIV@r{, }MOD
10528Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10529precedence as @code{*}.
10530
10531@item -
10532Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10533
10534@item ^
10535Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10536
10537@item NOT
10538Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10539@code{^}.
10540
10541@item .
10542@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10543precedence as @code{^}.
10544
10545@item []
10546Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10547
10548@item ()
10549Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10550as @code{^}.
10551
10552@item ::@r{, }.
10553@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10554@end table
10555
10556@quotation
10557@emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10558treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10559@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10560@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10561@end quotation
10562
10563
10564@node Built-In Func/Proc
10565@subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10566@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10567
10568Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10569In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10570
10571@table @var
10572
10573@item a
10574represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10575
10576@item c
10577represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10578
10579@item i
10580represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10581
10582@item m
10583represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10584same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10585be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10586
10587@item n
10588represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10589
10590@item r
10591represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10592
10593@item t
10594represents a type.
10595
10596@item v
10597represents a variable.
10598
10599@item x
10600represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10601explanation of the function for details.
10602@end table
10603
10604All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10605
10606@table @code
10607@item ABS(@var{n})
10608Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10609
10610@item CAP(@var{c})
10611If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10612equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10613
10614@item CHR(@var{i})
10615Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10616
10617@item DEC(@var{v})
10618Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10619
10620@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10621Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10622new value.
10623
10624@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10625Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10626set.
10627
10628@item FLOAT(@var{i})
10629Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10630
10631@item HIGH(@var{a})
10632Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10633
10634@item INC(@var{v})
10635Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10636
10637@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10638Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10639new value.
10640
10641@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10642Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10643there. Returns the new set.
10644
10645@item MAX(@var{t})
10646Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10647
10648@item MIN(@var{t})
10649Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10650
10651@item ODD(@var{i})
10652Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10653
10654@item ORD(@var{x})
10655Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10656value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10657@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10658integral, character and enumerated types.
10659
10660@item SIZE(@var{x})
10661Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10662
10663@item TRUNC(@var{r})
10664Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10665
10666@item TSIZE(@var{x})
10667Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10668
10669@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10670Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10671@end table
10672
10673@quotation
10674@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10675@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10676an error.
10677@end quotation
10678
10679@cindex Modula-2 constants
10680@node M2 Constants
10681@subsubsection Constants
10682
10683@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10684ways:
10685
10686@itemize @bullet
10687
10688@item
10689Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10690expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10691rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10692trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10693
10694@item
10695Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10696decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10697then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10698@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10699digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10700digits.
10701
10702@item
10703Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10704like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10705also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10706followed by a @samp{C}.
10707
10708@item
10709String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10710pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10711Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10712Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10713sequences.
10714
10715@item
10716Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10717
10718@item
10719Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10720@code{FALSE}.
10721
10722@item
10723Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10724
10725@item
10726Set constants are not yet supported.
10727@end itemize
10728
10729@node M2 Types
10730@subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10731@cindex Modula-2 types
10732
10733Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10734syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10735types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10736print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10737This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10738sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10739
10740The first example contains the following section of code:
10741
10742@smallexample
10743VAR
10744 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10745 r: [20..40] ;
10746@end smallexample
10747
10748@noindent
10749and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10750@code{r} and @code{s}.
10751
10752@smallexample
10753(@value{GDBP}) print s
10754@{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10755(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10756SET OF CHAR
10757(@value{GDBP}) print r
1075821
10759(@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10760[20..40]
10761@end smallexample
10762
10763@noindent
10764Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10765
10766@smallexample
10767VAR
10768 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10769@end smallexample
10770
10771@noindent
10772then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10773
10774@smallexample
10775(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10776type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10777@end smallexample
10778
10779@noindent
10780Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10781expressions using the debugger.
10782
10783The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10784and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10785
10786@smallexample
10787VAR
10788 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10789@end smallexample
10790
10791@smallexample
10792(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10793ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10794@end smallexample
10795
10796Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10797is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10798arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10799above.
10800
10801Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10802
10803@smallexample
10804TYPE
10805 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10806 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10807VAR
10808 s: t ;
10809BEGIN
10810 s := blue ;
10811@end smallexample
10812
10813@noindent
10814The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10815and value of a variable.
10816
10817@smallexample
10818(@value{GDBP}) print s
10819$1 = blue
10820(@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10821type = [blue..yellow]
10822@end smallexample
10823
10824@noindent
10825In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10826displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10827their @code{C} counterparts.
10828
10829@smallexample
10830VAR
10831 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10832BEGIN
10833 s[1] := 1 ;
10834@end smallexample
10835
10836@smallexample
10837(@value{GDBP}) print s
10838$1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10839(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10840type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10841@end smallexample
10842
10843The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10844pointer types as shown in this example:
10845
10846@smallexample
10847VAR
10848 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10849BEGIN
10850 NEW(s) ;
10851 s^[1] := 1 ;
10852@end smallexample
10853
10854@noindent
10855and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10856
10857@smallexample
10858(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10859type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10860@end smallexample
10861
10862@value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10863Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10864types:
10865
10866@smallexample
10867TYPE
10868 foo = RECORD
10869 f1: CARDINAL ;
10870 f2: CHAR ;
10871 f3: myarray ;
10872 END ;
10873
10874 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10875 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10876VAR
10877 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10878@end smallexample
10879
10880@noindent
10881and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10882below.
10883
10884@smallexample
10885(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10886type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10887 f1 : CARDINAL;
10888 f2 : CHAR;
10889 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10890END
10891@end smallexample
10892
10893@node M2 Defaults
10894@subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10895@cindex Modula-2 defaults
10896
10897If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10898both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10899Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10900selected the working language.
10901
10902If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10903code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10904working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10905Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10906
10907@node Deviations
10908@subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10909@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10910
10911A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10912This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10913
10914@itemize @bullet
10915@item
10916Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10917integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10918debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10919pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10920through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10921returned a pointer.)
10922
10923@item
10924C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10925non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10926escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10927printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10928
10929@item
10930The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10931argument.
10932
10933@item
10934All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10935@end itemize
10936
10937@node M2 Checks
10938@subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10939@cindex Modula-2 checks
10940
10941@quotation
10942@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10943range checking.
10944@end quotation
10945@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10946
10947@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10948
10949@itemize @bullet
10950@item
10951They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10952@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10953
10954@item
10955They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10956@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10957@end itemize
10958
10959As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10960whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10961
10962Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10963index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10964
10965@node M2 Scope
10966@subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10967@cindex scope
10968@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10969@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10970@ifinfo
10971@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10972@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10973@end ifinfo
10974@iftex
10975@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10976@end iftex
10977
10978There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10979(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10980similar syntax:
10981
10982@smallexample
10983
10984@var{module} . @var{id}
10985@var{scope} :: @var{id}
10986@end smallexample
10987
10988@noindent
10989where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10990@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10991identifier within your program, except another module.
10992
10993Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10994specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10995found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10996enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10997
10998Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10999the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
11000definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
11001an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
11002module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
11003@var{module}.
11004
11005@node GDB/M2
11006@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11007
11008Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
11009Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
11010specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
11011@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
11012apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
11013analogue in Modula-2.
11014
11015The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
11016with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
11017intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
11018created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
11019address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
11020@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
11021
11022@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
11023In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
11024interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
11025
11026@node Ada
11027@subsection Ada
11028@cindex Ada
11029
11030The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
11031output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
11032Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
11033attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11034to be difficult.
11035
11036
11037@cindex expressions in Ada
11038@menu
11039* Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
11040 and semantics supported by Ada mode
11041 in @value{GDBN}.
11042* Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
11043* Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
11044* Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
11045* Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
11046@end menu
11047
11048@node Ada Mode Intro
11049@subsubsection Introduction
11050@cindex Ada mode, general
11051
11052The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
11053syntax, with some extensions.
11054The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
11055
11056@itemize @bullet
11057@item
11058That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
11059arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
11060leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
11061program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
11062
11063@item
11064That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
11065are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11066
11067@item
11068That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11069@end itemize
11070
11071Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
11072user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
11073according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
11074names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
11075ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
11076
11077The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
11078As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
11079was translated from an Ada source file.
11080
11081While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
11082mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
11083(@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
11084middle (to allow based literals).
11085
11086The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
11087the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
11088actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
11089the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
11090procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
11091functions to procedures elsewhere.
11092
11093@node Omissions from Ada
11094@subsubsection Omissions from Ada
11095@cindex Ada, omissions from
11096
11097Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
11098
11099@itemize @bullet
11100@item
11101Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
11102
11103@itemize @minus
11104@item
11105@t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
11106 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
11107
11108@item
11109@t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
11110
11111@item
11112@t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
11113
11114@item
11115@t{'Tag}.
11116
11117@item
11118@t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
11119operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
11120
11121@item
11122@t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
11123@t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
11124
11125@item
11126@t{'Address}.
11127@end itemize
11128
11129@item
11130The names in
11131@code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
11132concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
11133not currently available.
11134
11135@item
11136Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
11137equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
11138for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
11139They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
11140types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
11141(in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
11142zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
11143indeterminate values.
11144
11145@item
11146The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
11147@code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
11148are not implemented.
11149
11150@item
11151@cindex array aggregates (Ada)
11152@cindex record aggregates (Ada)
11153@cindex aggregates (Ada)
11154There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
11155permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
11156
11157@smallexample
11158set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
11159set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
11160set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
11161set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
11162set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
11163set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
11164@end smallexample
11165
11166Changing a
11167discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
11168undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
11169However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
11170them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
11171aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
11172declared to have a type such as:
11173
11174@smallexample
11175type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
11176 Id : Integer;
11177 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
11178end record;
11179@end smallexample
11180
11181you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
11182assignments:
11183
11184@smallexample
11185set A_Rec.Len := 4
11186set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
11187@end smallexample
11188
11189As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
11190rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
11191components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
11192component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
11193original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
11194indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
11195redundant component associations, although which component values are
11196assigned in such cases is not defined.
11197
11198@item
11199Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
11200
11201@item
11202The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
11203than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
11204which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
11205looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
11206function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
11207the proper resolution.
11208
11209@item
11210The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
11211
11212@item
11213Entry calls are not implemented.
11214
11215@item
11216Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
11217formats are not supported.
11218
11219@item
11220It is not possible to slice a packed array.
11221@end itemize
11222
11223@node Additions to Ada
11224@subsubsection Additions to Ada
11225@cindex Ada, deviations from
11226
11227As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
11228extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
11229
11230@itemize @bullet
11231@item
11232If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
11233a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
11234then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
11235@var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
11236Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
11237in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
11238Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
11239which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
11240
11241@item
11242@code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
11243appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
11244you must typically surround it in single quotes.
11245
11246@item
11247The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
11248@var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
11249
11250@item
11251A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
11252(@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
11253@end itemize
11254
11255In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
11256additions specific to Ada:
11257
11258@itemize @bullet
11259@item
11260The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
11261its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
11262
11263@smallexample
11264set x := y + 3
11265print A(tmp := y + 1)
11266@end smallexample
11267
11268@item
11269The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
11270the value of its right-hand operand.
11271This allows, for example,
11272complex conditional breaks:
11273
11274@smallexample
11275break f
11276condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
11277@end smallexample
11278
11279@item
11280Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
11281characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
11282which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
11283@samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
11284(single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
11285sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
11286in strings. For example,
11287@smallexample
11288 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
11289@end smallexample
11290@noindent
11291contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
11292after each period.
11293
11294@item
11295The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
11296@t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
11297to write
11298
11299@smallexample
11300print 'max(x, y)
11301@end smallexample
11302
11303@item
11304When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
11305array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
11306For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11307of 3 might print as
11308
11309@smallexample
11310(3 => 10, 17, 1)
11311@end smallexample
11312
11313@noindent
11314That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11315clause.
11316
11317@item
11318You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11319multi-character subsequence of
11320their names (an exact match gets preference).
11321For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11322in place of @t{a'length}.
11323
11324@item
11325@cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11326Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11327to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11328some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11329For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11330enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11331For example,
11332@smallexample
11333@value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11334@end smallexample
11335
11336@item
11337Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11338access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11339specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11340selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
11341object.
11342
11343@end itemize
11344
11345@node Stopping Before Main Program
11346@subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
11347
11348@cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
11349It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
11350before reaching the main procedure.
11351As defined in the Ada Reference
11352Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
11353@code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
11354elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
11355@code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
11356
11357@node Ada Glitches
11358@subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
11359@cindex Ada, problems
11360
11361Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
11362we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
11363@value{GDBN},
11364some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
11365and the GNU Ada compiler.
11366
11367@itemize @bullet
11368@item
11369Currently, the debugger
11370has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
11371pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
11372Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
11373to get it printed properly.
11374
11375@item
11376Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
11377storage are invisible to the debugger.
11378
11379@item
11380Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
11381argument lists are treated as positional).
11382
11383@item
11384Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
11385
11386@item
11387Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
11388floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
11389the host machine.
11390
11391@item
11392The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
11393
11394@item
11395The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
11396the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
11397this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
11398look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
11399symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
11400defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
11401local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
11402GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
11403you can usually resolve the confusion
11404by qualifying the problematic names with package
11405@code{Standard} explicitly.
11406@end itemize
11407
11408@node Unsupported Languages
11409@section Unsupported Languages
11410
11411@cindex unsupported languages
11412@cindex minimal language
11413In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
11414@value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
11415It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
11416of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
11417This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
11418an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
11419
11420If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
11421select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
11422language.
11423
11424@node Symbols
11425@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
11426
11427The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
11428symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
11429program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
11430does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
11431program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
11432(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
11433file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
11434
11435@cindex symbol names
11436@cindex names of symbols
11437@cindex quoting names
11438Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
11439characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
11440most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
11441source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
11442are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
11443ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
11444@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
11445@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
11446
11447@smallexample
11448p 'foo.c'::x
11449@end smallexample
11450
11451@noindent
11452looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
11453
11454@table @code
11455@cindex case-insensitive symbol names
11456@cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
11457@kindex set case-sensitive
11458@item set case-sensitive on
11459@itemx set case-sensitive off
11460@itemx set case-sensitive auto
11461Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
11462with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
11463Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
11464case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
11465case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
11466you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
11467suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
11468matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
11469case-insensitive matches.
11470
11471@kindex show case-sensitive
11472@item show case-sensitive
11473This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
11474lookups.
11475
11476@kindex info address
11477@cindex address of a symbol
11478@item info address @var{symbol}
11479Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
11480variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
11481local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
11482is always stored.
11483
11484Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
11485at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
11486the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
11487
11488@kindex info symbol
11489@cindex symbol from address
11490@cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
11491@item info symbol @var{addr}
11492Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
11493If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
11494nearest symbol and an offset from it:
11495
11496@smallexample
11497(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
11498_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
11499@end smallexample
11500
11501@noindent
11502This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
11503it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
11504
11505@kindex whatis
11506@item whatis [@var{arg}]
11507Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
11508a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
11509last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
11510not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
11511assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
11512@var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
11513for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
11514@samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
11515@samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
11516@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11517
11518@kindex ptype
11519@item ptype [@var{arg}]
11520@code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
11521detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
11522@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11523
11524For example, for this variable declaration:
11525
11526@smallexample
11527struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
11528@end smallexample
11529
11530@noindent
11531the two commands give this output:
11532
11533@smallexample
11534@group
11535(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
11536type = struct complex
11537(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
11538type = struct complex @{
11539 double real;
11540 double imag;
11541@}
11542@end group
11543@end smallexample
11544
11545@noindent
11546As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11547the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11548
11549@cindex incomplete type
11550Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11551of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11552program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11553the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11554given these declarations:
11555
11556@smallexample
11557 struct foo;
11558 struct foo *fooptr;
11559@end smallexample
11560
11561@noindent
11562but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11563
11564@smallexample
11565 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11566 $1 = <incomplete type>
11567@end smallexample
11568
11569@noindent
11570``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11571completely specified.
11572
11573@kindex info types
11574@item info types @var{regexp}
11575@itemx info types
11576Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11577expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11578no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11579complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11580types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11581@samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11582name is @code{value}.
11583
11584This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11585@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11586lists all source files where a type is defined.
11587
11588@kindex info scope
11589@cindex local variables
11590@item info scope @var{location}
11591List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11592accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11593an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11594to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11595details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11596
11597@smallexample
11598(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11599Scope for command_line_handler:
11600Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11601Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11602Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11603Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11604Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11605Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11606Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11607@end smallexample
11608
11609@noindent
11610This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11611during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11612collect}.
11613
11614@kindex info source
11615@item info source
11616Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11617the function containing the current point of execution:
11618@itemize @bullet
11619@item
11620the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11621@item
11622the directory it was compiled in,
11623@item
11624its length, in lines,
11625@item
11626which programming language it is written in,
11627@item
11628whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11629if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11630@item
11631whether the debugging information includes information about
11632preprocessor macros.
11633@end itemize
11634
11635
11636@kindex info sources
11637@item info sources
11638Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11639debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11640have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11641
11642@kindex info functions
11643@item info functions
11644Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11645
11646@item info functions @var{regexp}
11647Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11648whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11649Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11650include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11651start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11652that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11653@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11654
11655@kindex info variables
11656@item info variables
11657Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11658outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11659
11660@item info variables @var{regexp}
11661Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11662variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11663@var{regexp}.
11664
11665@kindex info classes
11666@cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11667@item info classes
11668@itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11669Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11670(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11671expression.
11672
11673@kindex info selectors
11674@item info selectors
11675@itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11676Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11677(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11678expression.
11679
11680@ignore
11681This was never implemented.
11682@kindex info methods
11683@item info methods
11684@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11685The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11686methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11687specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11688C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11689from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11690@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11691which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11692@end ignore
11693
11694@cindex reloading symbols
11695Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11696be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11697in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11698running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11699@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11700
11701@table @code
11702@kindex set symbol-reloading
11703@item set symbol-reloading on
11704Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11705object file with a particular name is seen again.
11706
11707@item set symbol-reloading off
11708Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11709same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11710running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11711should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11712may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11713several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11714name.
11715
11716@kindex show symbol-reloading
11717@item show symbol-reloading
11718Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11719@end table
11720
11721@cindex opaque data types
11722@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11723@item set opaque-type-resolution on
11724Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11725declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11726@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11727source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11728another source file. The default is on.
11729
11730A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11731the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11732
11733@item set opaque-type-resolution off
11734Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11735is printed as follows:
11736@smallexample
11737@{<no data fields>@}
11738@end smallexample
11739
11740@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11741@item show opaque-type-resolution
11742Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11743
11744@kindex set print symbol-loading
11745@cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
11746@item set print symbol-loading
11747@itemx set print symbol-loading on
11748@itemx set print symbol-loading off
11749The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to enable or
11750disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
11751By default, these messages will be printed, and normally this is what
11752you want. Disabling these messages is useful when debugging applications
11753with lots of shared libraries where the quantity of output can be more
11754annoying than useful.
11755
11756@kindex show print symbol-loading
11757@item show print symbol-loading
11758Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
11759
11760@kindex maint print symbols
11761@cindex symbol dump
11762@kindex maint print psymbols
11763@cindex partial symbol dump
11764@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11765@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11766@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11767Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11768These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11769symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11770symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11771collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11772only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11773command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11774use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11775symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11776files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11777@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11778required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11779@xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11780@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11781
11782@kindex maint info symtabs
11783@kindex maint info psymtabs
11784@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11785@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11786@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11787@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11788@item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11789@itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11790
11791List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11792structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11793given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11794copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11795structure in more detail. For example:
11796
11797@smallexample
11798(@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11799@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11800 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11801 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11802 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11803 readin no
11804 fullname (null)
11805 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11806 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11807 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11808 dependencies (none)
11809 @}
11810@}
11811(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11812(@value{GDBP})
11813@end smallexample
11814@noindent
11815We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11816the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11817and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11818If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11819read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11820
11821@smallexample
11822(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11823Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11824line 1574.
11825(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11826@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11827 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11828 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11829 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11830 dirname (null)
11831 fullname (null)
11832 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11833 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11834 debugformat DWARF 2
11835 @}
11836@}
11837(@value{GDBP})
11838@end smallexample
11839@end table
11840
11841
11842@node Altering
11843@chapter Altering Execution
11844
11845Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11846find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11847correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11848experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11849program.
11850
11851For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11852locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11853address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11854
11855@menu
11856* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11857* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11858* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11859* Returning:: Returning from a function
11860* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11861* Patching:: Patching your program
11862@end menu
11863
11864@node Assignment
11865@section Assignment to Variables
11866
11867@cindex assignment
11868@cindex setting variables
11869To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11870@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11871
11872@smallexample
11873print x=4
11874@end smallexample
11875
11876@noindent
11877stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11878value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11879@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11880information on operators in supported languages.
11881
11882@kindex set variable
11883@cindex variables, setting
11884If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11885@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11886really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11887not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11888,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11889
11890If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11891appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11892variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11893to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11894program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11895a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11896command @code{set width}:
11897
11898@smallexample
11899(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11900type = double
11901(@value{GDBP}) p width
11902$4 = 13
11903(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11904Invalid syntax in expression.
11905@end smallexample
11906
11907@noindent
11908The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11909order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11910
11911@smallexample
11912(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11913@end smallexample
11914
11915Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11916with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11917@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11918your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11919to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11920the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11921
11922@smallexample
11923@group
11924(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11925type = double
11926(@value{GDBP}) p g
11927$1 = 1
11928(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11929(@value{GDBP}) p g
11930$2 = 1
11931(@value{GDBP}) r
11932The program being debugged has been started already.
11933Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11934Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11935"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11936 Invalid bfd target.
11937(@value{GDBP}) show g
11938The current BFD target is "=4".
11939@end group
11940@end smallexample
11941
11942@noindent
11943The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11944@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11945@code{g}, use
11946
11947@smallexample
11948(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11949@end smallexample
11950
11951@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11952freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11953and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11954same length or shorter.
11955@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11956@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11957
11958To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11959construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11960(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11961to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11962and representation in memory), and
11963
11964@smallexample
11965set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11966@end smallexample
11967
11968@noindent
11969stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11970
11971@node Jumping
11972@section Continuing at a Different Address
11973
11974Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11975it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11976an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11977
11978@table @code
11979@kindex jump
11980@item jump @var{linespec}
11981@itemx jump @var{location}
11982Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
11983@var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
11984breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
11985different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
11986practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
11987@code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11988
11989The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11990the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11991register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11992a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11993be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11994of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11995confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11996executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11997well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11998@end table
11999
12000@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
12001On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
12002command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
12003difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
12004changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
12005example,
12006
12007@smallexample
12008set $pc = 0x485
12009@end smallexample
12010
12011@noindent
12012makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
12013address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
12014@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
12015
12016The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
12017up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
12018that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
12019detail.
12020
12021@c @group
12022@node Signaling
12023@section Giving your Program a Signal
12024@cindex deliver a signal to a program
12025
12026@table @code
12027@kindex signal
12028@item signal @var{signal}
12029Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
12030signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
12031signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
12032SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
12033
12034Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
12035giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
12036a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
12037@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
12038signal.
12039
12040@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
12041after executing the command.
12042@end table
12043@c @end group
12044
12045Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
12046@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
12047causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
12048the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
12049passes the signal directly to your program.
12050
12051
12052@node Returning
12053@section Returning from a Function
12054
12055@table @code
12056@cindex returning from a function
12057@kindex return
12058@item return
12059@itemx return @var{expression}
12060You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
12061command. If you give an
12062@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
12063value.
12064@end table
12065
12066When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
12067(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
12068discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
12069be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
12070
12071This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
12072Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
12073innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
12074specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
12075of functions.
12076
12077The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
12078program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
12079returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
12080and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
12081selected stack frame returns naturally.
12082
12083@node Calling
12084@section Calling Program Functions
12085
12086@table @code
12087@cindex calling functions
12088@cindex inferior functions, calling
12089@item print @var{expr}
12090Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
12091@var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
12092debugged.
12093
12094@kindex call
12095@item call @var{expr}
12096Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
12097returned values.
12098
12099You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
12100execute a function from your program that does not return anything
12101(a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
12102with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
12103print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
12104value history.
12105@end table
12106
12107It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
12108@code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
12109the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
12110in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
12111
12112@table @code
12113@item set unwindonsignal
12114@kindex set unwindonsignal
12115@cindex unwind stack in called functions
12116@cindex call dummy stack unwinding
12117Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
12118that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
12119@value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
12120the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
12121default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
12122received.
12123
12124@item show unwindonsignal
12125@kindex show unwindonsignal
12126Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
12127@value{GDBN}.
12128@end table
12129
12130@cindex weak alias functions
12131Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
12132for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
12133the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
12134which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
12135As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
12136even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
12137function instead.
12138
12139@node Patching
12140@section Patching Programs
12141
12142@cindex patching binaries
12143@cindex writing into executables
12144@cindex writing into corefiles
12145
12146By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
12147executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
12148alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
12149patching your program's binary.
12150
12151If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
12152explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
12153want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
12154repairs.
12155
12156@table @code
12157@kindex set write
12158@item set write on
12159@itemx set write off
12160If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
12161core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
12162off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
12163
12164If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
12165@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
12166write}, for your new setting to take effect.
12167
12168@item show write
12169@kindex show write
12170Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
12171as well as reading.
12172@end table
12173
12174@node GDB Files
12175@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
12176
12177@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
12178both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
12179program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
12180@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
12181
12182@menu
12183* Files:: Commands to specify files
12184* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
12185* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
12186@end menu
12187
12188@node Files
12189@section Commands to Specify Files
12190
12191@cindex symbol table
12192@cindex core dump file
12193
12194You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
12195way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
12196@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
12197Out of @value{GDBN}}).
12198
12199Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
12200@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
12201specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
12202via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
12203Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
12204new files are useful.
12205
12206@table @code
12207@cindex executable file
12208@kindex file
12209@item file @var{filename}
12210Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
12211symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
12212executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
12213directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
12214@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
12215directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
12216to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
12217and your program, using the @code{path} command.
12218
12219@cindex unlinked object files
12220@cindex patching object files
12221You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
12222the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
12223file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
12224if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
12225@kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
12226that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
12227case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
12228the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
12229
12230@item file
12231@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
12232has on both executable file and the symbol table.
12233
12234@kindex exec-file
12235@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12236Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
12237in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
12238if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
12239discard information on the executable file.
12240
12241@kindex symbol-file
12242@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12243Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
12244searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
12245table and program to run from the same file.
12246
12247@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
12248program's symbol table.
12249
12250The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
12251some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
12252contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
12253which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
12254@value{GDBN}.
12255
12256@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
12257executing it once.
12258
12259When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
12260understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
12261generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
12262other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
12263Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
12264using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
12265optimized code.
12266
12267For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
12268using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
12269symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
12270quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
12271details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
12272
12273The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
12274start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
12275occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
12276file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
12277pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
12278Warnings and Messages}.)
12279
12280We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
12281symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
12282symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
12283still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
12284in stabs format.
12285
12286@kindex readnow
12287@cindex reading symbols immediately
12288@cindex symbols, reading immediately
12289@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12290@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12291You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
12292tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
12293load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
12294entire symbol table available.
12295
12296@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
12297@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
12298@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
12299@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
12300@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
12301@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
12302@c files.
12303
12304@kindex core-file
12305@item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
12306@itemx core
12307Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
12308of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
12309address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
12310executable file itself for other parts.
12311
12312@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
12313to be used.
12314
12315Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
12316under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
12317wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
12318the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
12319(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
12320
12321@kindex add-symbol-file
12322@cindex dynamic linking
12323@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
12324@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12325@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
12326The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
12327information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
12328when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
12329into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
12330address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
12331this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
12332of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
12333section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
12334@var{address} as an expression.
12335
12336The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
12337originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
12338@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
12339thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
12340instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
12341
12342@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
12343@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
12344@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
12345@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
12346@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
12347Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
12348executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
12349relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
12350information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
12351
12352@itemize @bullet
12353@item
12354the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
12355that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
12356@item
12357every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
12358been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
12359@item
12360you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
12361provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12362@end itemize
12363
12364@noindent
12365Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
12366relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
12367typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
12368important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
12369procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
12370assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
12371general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
12372relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
12373as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
12374way.
12375
12376@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
12377
12378@kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
12379@cindex @code{syscall DSO}
12380@cindex load symbols from memory
12381@item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
12382Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
12383object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
12384For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
12385process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
12386some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
12387evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
12388For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
12389@code{exec-file} commands in advance.
12390
12391@kindex add-shared-symbol-files
12392@kindex assf
12393@item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
12394@itemx assf @var{library-file}
12395The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
12396in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
12397alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
12398@value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
12399@value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
12400@code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
12401library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
12402@code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
12403
12404@kindex section
12405@item section @var{section} @var{addr}
12406The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
12407@var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
12408exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
12409@code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
12410itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
12411@code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
12412their addresses.
12413
12414@kindex info files
12415@kindex info target
12416@item info files
12417@itemx info target
12418@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
12419current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
12420including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
12421use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
12422command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
12423current ones.
12424
12425@kindex maint info sections
12426@item maint info sections
12427Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
12428is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
12429displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
12430offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
12431@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
12432may be arbitrarily combined):
12433
12434@table @code
12435@item ALLOBJ
12436Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
12437@item @var{sections}
12438Display info only for named @var{sections}.
12439@item @var{section-flags}
12440Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
12441The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
12442@table @code
12443@item ALLOC
12444Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
12445Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
12446@item LOAD
12447Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
12448Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
12449@item RELOC
12450Section needs to be relocated before loading.
12451@item READONLY
12452Section cannot be modified by the child process.
12453@item CODE
12454Section contains executable code only.
12455@item DATA
12456Section contains data only (no executable code).
12457@item ROM
12458Section will reside in ROM.
12459@item CONSTRUCTOR
12460Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
12461@item HAS_CONTENTS
12462Section is not empty.
12463@item NEVER_LOAD
12464An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
12465@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
12466A notification to the linker that the section contains
12467COFF shared library information.
12468@item IS_COMMON
12469Section contains common symbols.
12470@end table
12471@end table
12472@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
12473@cindex read-only sections
12474@item set trust-readonly-sections on
12475Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
12476really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
12477In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
12478out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
12479For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
12480enhancement to debugging performance.
12481
12482The default is off.
12483
12484@item set trust-readonly-sections off
12485Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
12486the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
12487and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
12488
12489@item show trust-readonly-sections
12490Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
12491@end table
12492
12493All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
12494as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
12495name and remembers it that way.
12496
12497@cindex shared libraries
12498@anchor{Shared Libraries}
12499@value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
12500and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
12501
12502On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
12503shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
12504
12505@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
12506when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
12507(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
12508references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
12509debugging a core file).
12510
12511On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
12512automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
12513
12514@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
12515@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
12516@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
12517
12518There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
12519symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
12520particularly large or there are many of them.
12521
12522To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
12523commands:
12524
12525@table @code
12526@kindex set auto-solib-add
12527@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
12528If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
12529will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
12530attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
12531informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
12532is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
12533@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
12534
12535@cindex memory used for symbol tables
12536If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
12537takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
12538memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
12539symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
12540auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
12541library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
12542@var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
12543the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
12544
12545@kindex show auto-solib-add
12546@item show auto-solib-add
12547Display the current autoloading mode.
12548@end table
12549
12550@cindex load shared library
12551To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
12552command:
12553
12554@table @code
12555@kindex info sharedlibrary
12556@kindex info share
12557@item info share
12558@itemx info sharedlibrary
12559Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
12560
12561@kindex sharedlibrary
12562@kindex share
12563@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
12564@itemx share @var{regex}
12565Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
12566Unix regular expression.
12567As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
12568required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
12569@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12570loaded.
12571
12572@item nosharedlibrary
12573@kindex nosharedlibrary
12574@cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12575Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12576that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12577libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12578discarded.
12579@end table
12580
12581Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12582when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12583stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12584
12585@table @code
12586@item set stop-on-solib-events
12587@kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12588This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12589when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12590The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12591shared library.
12592
12593@item show stop-on-solib-events
12594@kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12595Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12596library events happen.
12597@end table
12598
12599Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12600configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
12601host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12602copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12603not.
12604
12605@cindex where to look for shared libraries
12606For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12607libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12608may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12609to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12610
12611@table @code
12612@cindex prefix for shared library file names
12613@cindex system root, alternate
12614@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12615@kindex set sysroot
12616@item set sysroot @var{path}
12617Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12618absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12619runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12620target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12621libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12622the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12623under @var{path}.
12624
12625The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12626sysroot}.
12627
12628@cindex default system root
12629@cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12630You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12631@samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12632@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12633@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12634automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12635location.
12636
12637@kindex show sysroot
12638@item show sysroot
12639Display the current shared library prefix.
12640
12641@kindex set solib-search-path
12642@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12643If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12644directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12645is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12646path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12647use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12648@samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12649finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12650it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12651of shared library symbols.
12652
12653@kindex show solib-search-path
12654@item show solib-search-path
12655Display the current shared library search path.
12656@end table
12657
12658
12659@node Separate Debug Files
12660@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12661@cindex separate debugging information files
12662@cindex debugging information in separate files
12663@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12664@cindex debugging information directory, global
12665@cindex global debugging information directory
12666@cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12667@cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12668
12669@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12670file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12671@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12672Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12673than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12674information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12675install only when they need to debug a problem.
12676
12677@value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12678file:
12679
12680@itemize @bullet
12681@item
12682The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12683the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12684usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12685name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12686(e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12687debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12688@value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12689came from the same build.
12690
12691@item
12692The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12693also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12694only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12695for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12696this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12697command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12698The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12699explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12700below.
12701@end itemize
12702
12703Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12704uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12705
12706@itemize @bullet
12707@item
12708For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12709the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12710directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12711directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12712directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12713
12714@item
12715For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12716@file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12717named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12718first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12719are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12720hex characters, not 10.)
12721@end itemize
12722
12723So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12724@file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12725file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12726@code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12727@file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12728debug information files, in the indicated order:
12729
12730@itemize @minus
12731@item
12732@file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12733@item
12734@file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12735@item
12736@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12737@item
12738@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12739@end itemize
12740
12741You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12742name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12743
12744@table @code
12745
12746@kindex set debug-file-directory
12747@item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12748Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12749information files to @var{directory}.
12750
12751@kindex show debug-file-directory
12752@item show debug-file-directory
12753Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12754information files.
12755
12756@end table
12757
12758@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12759@cindex debug link sections
12760A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12761@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12762
12763@itemize
12764@item
12765A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12766a zero byte,
12767@item
12768zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12769boundary within the section, and
12770@item
12771a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12772executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12773information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12774zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12775@end itemize
12776
12777Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12778contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12779described above.
12780
12781@cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12782@cindex build ID sections
12783The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12784ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12785often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12786It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12787the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12788algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12789content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12790value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12791stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12792
12793The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12794executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12795debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12796should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12797but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12798in an ordinary executable.
12799
12800The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12801@samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12802the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12803following commands:
12804
12805@smallexample
12806@kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12807@kbd{strip -g foo}
12808@end smallexample
12809
12810@noindent
12811These commands remove the debugging
12812information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12813@file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12814two files:
12815
12816@itemize @bullet
12817@item
12818The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12819behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12820
12821@smallexample
12822@kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12823@end smallexample
12824
12825Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12826a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12827foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12828the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12829
12830@item
12831Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12832the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12833compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12834utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12835@end itemize
12836
12837@noindent
12838
12839Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12840link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12841simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12842sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12843
12844@kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12845@smallexample
12846unsigned long
12847gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12848 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12849@{
12850 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12851 @{
12852 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12853 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12854 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12855 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12856 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12857 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12858 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12859 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12860 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12861 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12862 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12863 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12864 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12865 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12866 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12867 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12868 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12869 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12870 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12871 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12872 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12873 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12874 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12875 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12876 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12877 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12878 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12879 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12880 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12881 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12882 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12883 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12884 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12885 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12886 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12887 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12888 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12889 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12890 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12891 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12892 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12893 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12894 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12895 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12896 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12897 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12898 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12899 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12900 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12901 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12902 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12903 0x2d02ef8d
12904 @};
12905 unsigned char *end;
12906
12907 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12908 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12909 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12910 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12911@}
12912@end smallexample
12913
12914@noindent
12915This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12916
12917
12918@node Symbol Errors
12919@section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12920
12921While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12922such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12923output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12924they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12925debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12926about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12927only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12928times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12929to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12930complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12931Messages}).
12932
12933The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12934
12935@table @code
12936@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12937
12938The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12939(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12940error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12941in its outer scope blocks.
12942
12943@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12944the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12945may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12946function.
12947
12948@item block at @var{address} out of order
12949
12950The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12951order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12952do so.
12953
12954@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12955locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12956can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12957@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12958Messages}.)
12959
12960@item bad block start address patched
12961
12962The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12963smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12964to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12965
12966@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12967starting on the previous source line.
12968
12969@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12970
12971@cindex foo
12972Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12973larger than the size of the string table.
12974
12975@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12976name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12977with this name.
12978
12979@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12980
12981The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12982not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12983uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12984
12985@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12986This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12987are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12988debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12989on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12990and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12991
12992@item stub type has NULL name
12993
12994@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12995
12996@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12997The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12998information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12999it.
13000
13001@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
13002
13003@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
13004
13005@end table
13006
13007@node Targets
13008@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
13009
13010@cindex debugging target
13011A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
13012
13013Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
13014in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
13015you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
13016flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
13017host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
13018realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
13019command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
13020(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
13021
13022@cindex target architecture
13023It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
13024architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
13025one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
13026command.
13027
13028@table @code
13029@kindex set architecture
13030@kindex show architecture
13031@item set architecture @var{arch}
13032This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
13033value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
13034supported architectures.
13035
13036@item show architecture
13037Show the current target architecture.
13038
13039@item set processor
13040@itemx processor
13041@kindex set processor
13042@kindex show processor
13043These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
13044and @code{show architecture}.
13045@end table
13046
13047@menu
13048* Active Targets:: Active targets
13049* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
13050* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
13051@end menu
13052
13053@node Active Targets
13054@section Active Targets
13055
13056@cindex stacking targets
13057@cindex active targets
13058@cindex multiple targets
13059
13060There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
13061executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
13062active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
13063start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
13064a core file.
13065
13066For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
13067@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
13068well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
13069@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
13070first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
13071requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
13072are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
13073read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
13074executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
13075
13076When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
13077target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
13078commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
13079an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
13080process target is active.
13081
13082Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
13083core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
13084Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
13085the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
13086Process}).
13087
13088@node Target Commands
13089@section Commands for Managing Targets
13090
13091@table @code
13092@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
13093Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
13094process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
13095facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
13096protocol of the target machine.
13097
13098Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
13099typically include things like device names or host names to connect
13100with, process numbers, and baud rates.
13101
13102The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
13103after executing the command.
13104
13105@kindex help target
13106@item help target
13107Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
13108currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
13109(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13110
13111@item help target @var{name}
13112Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
13113select it.
13114
13115@kindex set gnutarget
13116@item set gnutarget @var{args}
13117@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
13118knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
13119a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
13120with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
13121with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
13122
13123@quotation
13124@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
13125you must know the actual BFD name.
13126@end quotation
13127
13128@noindent
13129@xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
13130
13131@kindex show gnutarget
13132@item show gnutarget
13133Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
13134@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
13135@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
13136and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
13137@end table
13138
13139@cindex common targets
13140Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
13141configuration):
13142
13143@table @code
13144@kindex target
13145@item target exec @var{program}
13146@cindex executable file target
13147An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
13148@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
13149
13150@item target core @var{filename}
13151@cindex core dump file target
13152A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
13153@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
13154
13155@item target remote @var{medium}
13156@cindex remote target
13157A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
13158connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
13159protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
13160
13161For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
13162machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
13163
13164@smallexample
13165target remote /dev/ttya
13166@end smallexample
13167
13168@code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
13169useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
13170system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
13171clobbered by the download.
13172
13173@item target sim
13174@cindex built-in simulator target
13175Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
13176In general,
13177@smallexample
13178 target sim
13179 load
13180 run
13181@end smallexample
13182@noindent
13183works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
13184drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
13185provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
13186see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
13187Processors}.
13188
13189@end table
13190
13191Some configurations may include these targets as well:
13192
13193@table @code
13194
13195@item target nrom @var{dev}
13196@cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
13197NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
13198
13199@end table
13200
13201Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
13202your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
13203
13204Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
13205you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
13206various aspects of this process.
13207
13208@table @code
13209
13210@item set hash
13211@kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13212@cindex hash mark while downloading
13213This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
13214downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
13215displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
13216monitor.
13217
13218@item show hash
13219@kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13220Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
13221
13222@item set debug monitor
13223@kindex set debug monitor
13224@cindex display remote monitor communications
13225Enable or disable display of communications messages between
13226@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13227
13228@item show debug monitor
13229@kindex show debug monitor
13230Show the current status of displaying communications between
13231@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13232@end table
13233
13234@table @code
13235
13236@kindex load @var{filename}
13237@item load @var{filename}
13238@anchor{load}
13239Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
13240@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
13241is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
13242on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
13243@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
13244the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13245
13246If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
13247execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
13248target is @dots{}}''
13249
13250The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
13251For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
13252link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
13253specifies a fixed address.
13254@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
13255
13256Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
13257load programs into flash memory.
13258
13259@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
13260@end table
13261
13262@node Byte Order
13263@section Choosing Target Byte Order
13264
13265@cindex choosing target byte order
13266@cindex target byte order
13267
13268Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
13269offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
13270orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
13271designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
13272which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
13273@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
13274
13275@table @code
13276@kindex set endian
13277@item set endian big
13278Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
13279
13280@item set endian little
13281Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
13282
13283@item set endian auto
13284Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
13285executable.
13286
13287@item show endian
13288Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
13289
13290@end table
13291
13292Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
13293data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
13294target system.
13295
13296
13297@node Remote Debugging
13298@chapter Debugging Remote Programs
13299@cindex remote debugging
13300
13301If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
13302@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
13303For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
13304or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
13305powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
13306
13307Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
13308to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
13309@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
13310but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
13311write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
13312communicate with @value{GDBN}.
13313
13314Other remote targets may be available in your
13315configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
13316
13317@menu
13318* Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
13319* File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
13320* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
13321* Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
13322* Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
13323@end menu
13324
13325@node Connecting
13326@section Connecting to a Remote Target
13327
13328On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
13329your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
13330Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
13331program as the first argument.
13332
13333@cindex @code{target remote}
13334@value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
13335over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
13336each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
13337program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
13338@code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
13339Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
13340
13341@table @code
13342
13343@item target remote @var{serial-device}
13344@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
13345Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
13346to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
13347
13348@smallexample
13349target remote /dev/ttyb
13350@end smallexample
13351
13352If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
13353@w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
13354(@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
13355@code{target} command.
13356
13357@item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
13358@itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13359@cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
13360Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
13361The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
13362address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
13363the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
13364it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
13365target.
13366
13367For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
13368@code{manyfarms}:
13369
13370@smallexample
13371target remote manyfarms:2828
13372@end smallexample
13373
13374If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
13375debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
13376same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
13377port 1234 on your local machine:
13378
13379@smallexample
13380target remote :1234
13381@end smallexample
13382@noindent
13383
13384Note that the colon is still required here.
13385
13386@item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13387@cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
13388Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
13389connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
13390
13391@smallexample
13392target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
13393@end smallexample
13394
13395When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
13396keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
13397can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
13398cause havoc with your debugging session.
13399
13400@item target remote | @var{command}
13401@cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
13402Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
13403pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
13404by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
13405protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
13406standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
13407that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
13408using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
13409
13410If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
13411@value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
13412program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
13413
13414@end table
13415
13416Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
13417commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
13418running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
13419need to use @kbd{run}.
13420
13421@cindex interrupting remote programs
13422@cindex remote programs, interrupting
13423Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
13424interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
13425program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
13426and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
13427interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
13428
13429@smallexample
13430Interrupted while waiting for the program.
13431Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
13432@end smallexample
13433
13434If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
13435(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
13436remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
13437goes back to waiting.
13438
13439@table @code
13440@kindex detach (remote)
13441@item detach
13442When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
13443@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
13444Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
13445will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
13446command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
13447
13448@kindex disconnect
13449@item disconnect
13450The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
13451the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
13452(this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
13453the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
13454another target.
13455
13456@cindex send command to remote monitor
13457@cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
13458@cindex add new commands for external monitor
13459@kindex monitor
13460@item monitor @var{cmd}
13461This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
13462remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
13463sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
13464can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
13465and implement.
13466@end table
13467
13468@node File Transfer
13469@section Sending files to a remote system
13470@cindex remote target, file transfer
13471@cindex file transfer
13472@cindex sending files to remote systems
13473
13474Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
13475connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
13476for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
13477running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
13478e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
13479the only way to upload or download files.
13480
13481Not all remote targets support these commands.
13482
13483@table @code
13484@kindex remote put
13485@item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
13486Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
13487@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
13488
13489@kindex remote get
13490@item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
13491Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
13492on the host system.
13493
13494@kindex remote delete
13495@item remote delete @var{targetfile}
13496Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
13497
13498@end table
13499
13500@node Server
13501@section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
13502
13503@kindex gdbserver
13504@cindex remote connection without stubs
13505@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
13506allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
13507@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
13508
13509@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
13510because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
13511that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
13512@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
13513@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
13514because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
13515also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
13516started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
13517Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
13518the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
13519do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
13520by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
13521choice for debugging.
13522
13523@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
13524or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
13525protocol.
13526
13527@quotation
13528@emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
13529Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
13530@value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
13531target system with the same privileges as the user running
13532@code{gdbserver}.
13533@end quotation
13534
13535@subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
13536@cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
13537
13538Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
13539program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
13540@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
13541strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
13542system does all the symbol handling.
13543
13544To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
13545the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
13546syntax is:
13547
13548@smallexample
13549target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
13550@end smallexample
13551
13552@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
13553hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
13554@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
13555@file{/dev/com1}:
13556
13557@smallexample
13558target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
13559@end smallexample
13560
13561@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
13562with it.
13563
13564To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
13565
13566@smallexample
13567target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
13568@end smallexample
13569
13570The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
13571specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13572TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13573expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13574(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13575you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13576TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13577reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13578conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13579and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13580@code{target remote} command.
13581
13582@subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13583
13584On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13585This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13586
13587@smallexample
13588target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13589@end smallexample
13590
13591@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13592to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13593
13594@pindex pidof
13595@cindex attach to a program by name
13596You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13597@code{pidof} utility:
13598
13599@smallexample
13600target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13601@end smallexample
13602
13603In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13604has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13605@code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13606
13607@subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13608@cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13609@cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13610
13611When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13612@code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13613program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13614and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13615
13616If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13617enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13618detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13619though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13620commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13621The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13622remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13623arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13624redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13625
13626To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13627or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13628Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
13629the program you want to debug.
13630
13631@code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13632You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13633(@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13634
13635@subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13636
13637You can include @option{--debug} on the @code{gdbserver} command line.
13638@code{gdbserver} will display extra status information about the debugging
13639process. This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and
13640for bug reports to the developers.
13641
13642The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
13643for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
13644wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
13645@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
13646
13647@code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
13648command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
13649program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
13650runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
13651
13652You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
13653its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
13654this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
13655with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
13656
13657For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
13658the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
13659environment:
13660
13661@smallexample
13662$ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
13663@end smallexample
13664
13665@subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
13666
13667Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
13668
13669First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13670your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13671@code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13672was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
13673
13674The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13675and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13676system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13677are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13678during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13679files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13680programs.
13681
13682Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13683For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13684the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13685text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13686@samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
13687command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13688already on the target.
13689
13690@subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13691@cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13692@anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
13693
13694During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13695@code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13696Here are the available commands.
13697
13698@table @code
13699@item monitor help
13700List the available monitor commands.
13701
13702@item monitor set debug 0
13703@itemx monitor set debug 1
13704Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13705
13706@item monitor set remote-debug 0
13707@itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13708Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13709protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13710
13711@item monitor exit
13712Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
13713@code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
13714detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
13715Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
13716of a multi-process mode debug session.
13717
13718@end table
13719
13720@node Remote Configuration
13721@section Remote Configuration
13722
13723@kindex set remote
13724@kindex show remote
13725This section documents the configuration options available when
13726debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13727extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13728system-call-allowed}.
13729
13730@table @code
13731@item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13732@cindex address size for remote targets
13733@cindex bits in remote address
13734Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13735number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13736that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13737default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13738
13739@item show remoteaddresssize
13740Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13741
13742@item set remotebaud @var{n}
13743@cindex baud rate for remote targets
13744Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13745value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13746remote targets.
13747
13748@item show remotebaud
13749Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13750
13751@item set remotebreak
13752@cindex interrupt remote programs
13753@cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13754@anchor{set remotebreak}
13755If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13756when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13757on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13758character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13759expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13760
13761@item show remotebreak
13762Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13763interrupt the remote program.
13764
13765@item set remoteflow on
13766@itemx set remoteflow off
13767@kindex set remoteflow
13768Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13769on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13770
13771@item show remoteflow
13772@kindex show remoteflow
13773Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13774
13775@item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13776Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13777communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13778@code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13779@code{ascii}.
13780
13781@item show remotelogbase
13782Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13783protocol.
13784
13785@item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13786@cindex record serial communications on file
13787Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13788default is not to record at all.
13789
13790@item show remotelogfile.
13791Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13792serial communications.
13793
13794@item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13795@cindex timeout for serial communications
13796@cindex remote timeout
13797Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13798@var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13799
13800@item show remotetimeout
13801Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13802responses.
13803
13804@cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13805@cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13806@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13807@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13808@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13809@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13810Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13811watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13812
13813@item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
13814@itemx show remote exec-file
13815@anchor{set remote exec-file}
13816@cindex executable file, for remote target
13817Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
13818extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
13819target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
13820filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
13821@end table
13822
13823@cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13824The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13825your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13826can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13827packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13828packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13829or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13830all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13831see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13832
13833During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13834If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13835in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13836@value{GDBN} developers.
13837
13838For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13839packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13840are:
13841
13842@multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13843@item Command Name
13844@tab Remote Packet
13845@tab Related Features
13846
13847@item @code{fetch-register}
13848@tab @code{p}
13849@tab @code{info registers}
13850
13851@item @code{set-register}
13852@tab @code{P}
13853@tab @code{set}
13854
13855@item @code{binary-download}
13856@tab @code{X}
13857@tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13858
13859@item @code{read-aux-vector}
13860@tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13861@tab @code{info auxv}
13862
13863@item @code{symbol-lookup}
13864@tab @code{qSymbol}
13865@tab Detecting multiple threads
13866
13867@item @code{attach}
13868@tab @code{vAttach}
13869@tab @code{attach}
13870
13871@item @code{verbose-resume}
13872@tab @code{vCont}
13873@tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13874
13875@item @code{run}
13876@tab @code{vRun}
13877@tab @code{run}
13878
13879@item @code{software-breakpoint}
13880@tab @code{Z0}
13881@tab @code{break}
13882
13883@item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13884@tab @code{Z1}
13885@tab @code{hbreak}
13886
13887@item @code{write-watchpoint}
13888@tab @code{Z2}
13889@tab @code{watch}
13890
13891@item @code{read-watchpoint}
13892@tab @code{Z3}
13893@tab @code{rwatch}
13894
13895@item @code{access-watchpoint}
13896@tab @code{Z4}
13897@tab @code{awatch}
13898
13899@item @code{target-features}
13900@tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13901@tab @code{set architecture}
13902
13903@item @code{library-info}
13904@tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13905@tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13906
13907@item @code{memory-map}
13908@tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13909@tab @code{info mem}
13910
13911@item @code{read-spu-object}
13912@tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13913@tab @code{info spu}
13914
13915@item @code{write-spu-object}
13916@tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13917@tab @code{info spu}
13918
13919@item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13920@tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13921@tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13922
13923@item @code{search-memory}
13924@tab @code{qSearch:memory}
13925@tab @code{find}
13926
13927@item @code{supported-packets}
13928@tab @code{qSupported}
13929@tab Remote communications parameters
13930
13931@item @code{pass-signals}
13932@tab @code{QPassSignals}
13933@tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13934
13935@item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13936@tab @code{vFile:close}
13937@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13938
13939@item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13940@tab @code{vFile:open}
13941@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13942
13943@item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13944@tab @code{vFile:pread}
13945@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13946
13947@item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13948@tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13949@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13950
13951@item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13952@tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13953@tab @code{remote delete}
13954
13955@item @code{noack-packet}
13956@tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
13957@tab Packet acknowledgment
13958@end multitable
13959
13960@node Remote Stub
13961@section Implementing a Remote Stub
13962
13963@cindex debugging stub, example
13964@cindex remote stub, example
13965@cindex stub example, remote debugging
13966The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13967communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13968@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13969these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13970implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13971with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13972organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13973
13974@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13975To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13976@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13977prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13978program, you need:
13979
13980@enumerate
13981@item
13982A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13983have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13984your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13985
13986@item
13987A C subroutine library to support your program's
13988subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13989
13990@item
13991A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13992download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13993manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13994documentation.
13995@end enumerate
13996
13997The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13998communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13999machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
14000
14001@table @emph
14002@item On the host,
14003@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
14004else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
14005(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
14006
14007@item On the target,
14008you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
14009implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
14010subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
14011
14012On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
14013@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
14014@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
14015@end table
14016
14017The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
14018machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
14019@sc{sparc} boards.
14020
14021@cindex remote serial stub list
14022These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
14023
14024@table @code
14025
14026@item i386-stub.c
14027@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
14028@cindex Intel
14029@cindex i386
14030For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
14031
14032@item m68k-stub.c
14033@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
14034@cindex Motorola 680x0
14035@cindex m680x0
14036For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
14037
14038@item sh-stub.c
14039@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
14040@cindex Renesas
14041@cindex SH
14042For Renesas SH architectures.
14043
14044@item sparc-stub.c
14045@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
14046@cindex Sparc
14047For @sc{sparc} architectures.
14048
14049@item sparcl-stub.c
14050@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
14051@cindex Fujitsu
14052@cindex SparcLite
14053For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
14054
14055@end table
14056
14057The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
14058recently added stubs.
14059
14060@menu
14061* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
14062* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
14063* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
14064@end menu
14065
14066@node Stub Contents
14067@subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
14068
14069@cindex remote serial stub
14070The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
14071subroutines:
14072
14073@table @code
14074@item set_debug_traps
14075@findex set_debug_traps
14076@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
14077This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
14078program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
14079beginning of your program.
14080
14081@item handle_exception
14082@findex handle_exception
14083@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
14084This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
14085explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
14086run when a trap is triggered.
14087
14088@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
14089execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
14090with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
14091protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
14092representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
14093information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
14094retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
14095execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
14096@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
14097machine.
14098
14099@item breakpoint
14100@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
14101Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
14102breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
14103way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
14104machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
14105pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
14106@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
14107simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
14108again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
14109your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
14110@value{GDBN} session gets control.
14111
14112Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
14113to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
14114start of your debugging session.
14115@end table
14116
14117@node Bootstrapping
14118@subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
14119
14120@cindex remote stub, support routines
14121The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
14122chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
14123debugging target machine.
14124
14125First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
14126serial port.
14127
14128@table @code
14129@item int getDebugChar()
14130@findex getDebugChar
14131Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
14132It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
14133different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14134
14135@item void putDebugChar(int)
14136@findex putDebugChar
14137Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
14138It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
14139different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14140@end table
14141
14142@cindex control C, and remote debugging
14143@cindex interrupting remote targets
14144If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
14145running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
14146for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
14147character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
14148remote system to stop.
14149
14150Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
14151probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
14152is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
14153@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
14154
14155Other routines you need to supply are:
14156
14157@table @code
14158@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
14159@findex exceptionHandler
14160Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
14161handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
14162way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
14163are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
14164containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
14165@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
14166its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
14167might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
14168exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
14169@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
14170and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
14171you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
14172should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
14173
14174For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
14175gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
14176should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
14177@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
14178help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
14179
14180@item void flush_i_cache()
14181@findex flush_i_cache
14182On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
14183instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
14184instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
14185
14186On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
14187function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
14188@end table
14189
14190@noindent
14191You must also make sure this library routine is available:
14192
14193@table @code
14194@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
14195@findex memset
14196This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
14197memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
14198@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
14199either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
14200@end table
14201
14202If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
14203library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
14204but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
14205subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
14206
14207
14208@node Debug Session
14209@subsection Putting it All Together
14210
14211@cindex remote serial debugging summary
14212In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
14213steps.
14214
14215@enumerate
14216@item
14217Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
14218(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
14219@display
14220@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
14221@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
14222@end display
14223
14224@item
14225Insert these lines near the top of your program:
14226
14227@smallexample
14228set_debug_traps();
14229breakpoint();
14230@end smallexample
14231
14232@item
14233For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
14234@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
14235
14236@smallexample
14237void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
14238@end smallexample
14239
14240@noindent
14241but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
14242function in your program, that function is called when
14243@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
14244error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
14245one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
14246
14247@item
14248Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
14249your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
14250
14251@item
14252Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
14253the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
14254
14255@item
14256@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
14257@c document that. FIXME.
14258Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
14259whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
14260
14261@item
14262Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
14263(@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14264
14265@end enumerate
14266
14267@node Configurations
14268@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
14269
14270While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
14271cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
14272describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
14273
14274There are three major categories of configurations: native
14275configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
14276operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
14277different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
14278are quite different from each other.
14279
14280@menu
14281* Native::
14282* Embedded OS::
14283* Embedded Processors::
14284* Architectures::
14285@end menu
14286
14287@node Native
14288@section Native
14289
14290This section describes details specific to particular native
14291configurations.
14292
14293@menu
14294* HP-UX:: HP-UX
14295* BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
14296* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
14297* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
14298* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
14299* Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
14300* Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
14301@end menu
14302
14303@node HP-UX
14304@subsection HP-UX
14305
14306On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
14307begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
14308name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
14309
14310
14311@node BSD libkvm Interface
14312@subsection BSD libkvm Interface
14313
14314@cindex libkvm
14315@cindex kernel memory image
14316@cindex kernel crash dump
14317
14318BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
14319interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
14320memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
14321uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
14322dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
14323special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
14324the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
14325@code{kvm} target:
14326
14327@smallexample
14328(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
14329@end smallexample
14330
14331For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
14332argument:
14333
14334@smallexample
14335(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
14336@end smallexample
14337
14338Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
14339available:
14340
14341@table @code
14342@kindex kvm
14343@item kvm pcb
14344Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
14345
14346@item kvm proc
14347Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
14348modern FreeBSD systems.
14349@end table
14350
14351@node SVR4 Process Information
14352@subsection SVR4 Process Information
14353@cindex /proc
14354@cindex examine process image
14355@cindex process info via @file{/proc}
14356
14357Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
14358@samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
14359process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
14360for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
14361proc} is available to report information about the process running
14362your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
14363proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
14364This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
14365Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
14366
14367@table @code
14368@kindex info proc
14369@cindex process ID
14370@item info proc
14371@itemx info proc @var{process-id}
14372Summarize available information about any running process. If a
14373process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
14374that process; otherwise display information about the program being
14375debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
14376line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
14377executable file's absolute file name.
14378
14379On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
14380@samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
14381within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
14382a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
14383needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
14384a process ID rather than a thread ID).
14385
14386@item info proc mappings
14387@cindex memory address space mappings
14388Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
14389information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
14390rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
14391includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
14392memory access rights to that range.
14393
14394@item info proc stat
14395@itemx info proc status
14396@cindex process detailed status information
14397These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
14398the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
14399how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
14400the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
14401consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
14402value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
14403(type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
14404
14405@item info proc all
14406Show all the information about the process described under all of the
14407above @code{info proc} subcommands.
14408
14409@ignore
14410@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
14411@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
14412@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
14413@kindex info proc times
14414@item info proc times
14415Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
14416its children.
14417
14418@kindex info proc id
14419@item info proc id
14420Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
14421the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
14422@end ignore
14423
14424@item set procfs-trace
14425@kindex set procfs-trace
14426@cindex @code{procfs} API calls
14427This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
14428
14429@item show procfs-trace
14430@kindex show procfs-trace
14431Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
14432
14433@item set procfs-file @var{file}
14434@kindex set procfs-file
14435Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
14436@var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
14437contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
14438standard output.
14439
14440@item show procfs-file
14441@kindex show procfs-file
14442Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
14443
14444@item proc-trace-entry
14445@itemx proc-trace-exit
14446@itemx proc-untrace-entry
14447@itemx proc-untrace-exit
14448@kindex proc-trace-entry
14449@kindex proc-trace-exit
14450@kindex proc-untrace-entry
14451@kindex proc-untrace-exit
14452These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
14453from the @code{syscall} interface.
14454
14455@item info pidlist
14456@kindex info pidlist
14457@cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
14458For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
14459processes and all the threads within each process.
14460
14461@item info meminfo
14462@kindex info meminfo
14463@cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
14464For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
14465@end table
14466
14467@node DJGPP Native
14468@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
14469@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
14470@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
14471@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
14472
14473@cindex DPMI
14474@sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
14475MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
14476that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
14477top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
14478
14479@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
14480defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
14481subsection describes those commands.
14482
14483@table @code
14484@kindex info dos
14485@item info dos
14486This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
14487information about the target system and important OS structures.
14488
14489@kindex sysinfo
14490@cindex MS-DOS system info
14491@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
14492@item info dos sysinfo
14493This command displays assorted information about the underlying
14494platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
14495DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
14496
14497@cindex GDT
14498@cindex LDT
14499@cindex IDT
14500@cindex segment descriptor tables
14501@cindex descriptor tables display
14502@item info dos gdt
14503@itemx info dos ldt
14504@itemx info dos idt
14505These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
14506and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
14507tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
14508that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
14509descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
14510descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
14511rights.
14512
14513A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
14514segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
14515allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
14516conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
14517additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
14518
14519@cindex garbled pointers
14520These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
14521Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
14522displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
14523display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
14524example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
14525debugged program's data segment:
14526
14527@smallexample
14528@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
14529@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
14530@end smallexample
14531
14532@noindent
14533This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
14534the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
14535
14536@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
14537@item info dos pde
14538@itemx info dos pte
14539These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
14540Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
14541data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
14542into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
14543page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
14544may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
14545Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
14546that is currently in use.
14547
14548Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
14549Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
14550the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
14551@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
14552Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
14553means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
14554the specified entry in the Page Directory.
14555
14556@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
14557These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
14558Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
14559controller.
14560
14561These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
14562
14563@cindex physical address from linear address
14564@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
14565This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
14566address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
14567already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
14568because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
14569segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
14570the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
14571
14572@smallexample
14573@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
14574@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
14575@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
14576@end smallexample
14577
14578@noindent
14579This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
14580whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
14581attributes of that page.
14582
14583Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
14584since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
14585address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
14586be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
14587declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
14588@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
14589
14590Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
14591transfer buffer:
14592
14593@smallexample
14594@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
14595@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
14596@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
14597@end smallexample
14598
14599@noindent
14600(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
146013rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
14602clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14603memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
14604linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
14605
14606This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
14607@end table
14608
14609@cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
14610In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
14611debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
14612to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
14613
14614@table @code
14615@kindex set com1base
14616@kindex set com1irq
14617@kindex set com2base
14618@kindex set com2irq
14619@kindex set com3base
14620@kindex set com3irq
14621@kindex set com4base
14622@kindex set com4irq
14623@item set com1base @var{addr}
14624This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
14625port.
14626
14627@item set com1irq @var{irq}
14628This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
14629for the @file{COM1} serial port.
14630
14631There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
14632etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
14633other 3 COM ports.
14634
14635@kindex show com1base
14636@kindex show com1irq
14637@kindex show com2base
14638@kindex show com2irq
14639@kindex show com3base
14640@kindex show com3irq
14641@kindex show com4base
14642@kindex show com4irq
14643The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
14644display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
14645lines used by the COM ports.
14646
14647@item info serial
14648@kindex info serial
14649@cindex DOS serial port status
14650This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
14651port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
14652IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
14653counts of various errors encountered so far.
14654@end table
14655
14656
14657@node Cygwin Native
14658@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
14659@cindex MS Windows debugging
14660@cindex native Cygwin debugging
14661@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
14662
14663@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
14664DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
14665additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
14666Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
14667@ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
14668
14669@table @code
14670@kindex info w32
14671@item info w32
14672This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
14673information about the target system and important OS structures.
14674
14675@item info w32 selector
14676This command displays information returned by
14677the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
14678It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
14679a long value to give the information about this given selector.
14680Without argument, this command displays information
14681about the six segment registers.
14682
14683@kindex info dll
14684@item info dll
14685This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14686
14687@kindex dll-symbols
14688@item dll-symbols
14689This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14690add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14691
14692@kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14693@cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14694@cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14695@item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14696If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14697happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14698@value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14699exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14700``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14701Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14702@value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14703
14704@kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14705@item show cygwin-exceptions
14706Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14707inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14708
14709@kindex set new-console
14710@item set new-console @var{mode}
14711If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14712be started in a new console on next start.
14713If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14714be started in the same console as the debugger.
14715
14716@kindex show new-console
14717@item show new-console
14718Displays whether a new console is used
14719when the debuggee is started.
14720
14721@kindex set new-group
14722@item set new-group @var{mode}
14723This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14724start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14725This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14726@samp{Ctrl-C}.
14727
14728@kindex show new-group
14729@item show new-group
14730Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14731
14732@kindex set debugevents
14733@item set debugevents
14734This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14735to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14736signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14737unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14738Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14739
14740@kindex set debugexec
14741@item set debugexec
14742This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14743(such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14744
14745@kindex set debugexceptions
14746@item set debugexceptions
14747This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14748debuggee seen by the debugger.
14749
14750@kindex set debugmemory
14751@item set debugmemory
14752This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14753and writes by the debugger.
14754
14755@kindex set shell
14756@item set shell
14757This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14758via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14759
14760@kindex show shell
14761@item show shell
14762Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14763
14764@end table
14765
14766@menu
14767* Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14768@end menu
14769
14770@node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14771@subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14772@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14773@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14774
14775Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14776not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14777@file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14778symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14779information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14780describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14781``minimal symbols''.
14782
14783Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14784will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14785start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14786program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14787@value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14788see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14789@code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14790explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14791cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14792which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14793
14794@subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14795
14796In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14797tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14798DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14799also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14800sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14801(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14802necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14803contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14804exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14805
14806Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14807though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14808symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14809some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14810@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14811(@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14812
14813@smallexample
14814(@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14815All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14816
14817Non-debugging symbols:
148180x77e885f4 CreateFileA
148190x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14820@end smallexample
14821
14822@smallexample
14823(@value{GDBP}) info function !
14824All functions matching regular expression "!":
14825
14826Non-debugging symbols:
148270x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
148280x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
148290x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14830[etc...]
14831@end smallexample
14832
14833@subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14834
14835Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14836type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14837refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14838contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14839contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14840means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14841a function within a DLL without a running program.
14842
14843Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14844automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14845variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14846type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14847problem:
14848
14849@smallexample
14850(@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14851$1 = 268572168
14852@end smallexample
14853
14854@smallexample
14855(@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
148560x10021610: "\230y\""
14857@end smallexample
14858
14859And two possible solutions:
14860
14861@smallexample
14862(@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14863$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14864@end smallexample
14865
14866@smallexample
14867(@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
148680x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14869(@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
148700x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14871(@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
148720x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14873@end smallexample
14874
14875Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14876starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14877examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14878function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14879to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14880
14881@smallexample
14882(@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14883Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14884@end smallexample
14885
14886The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14887break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14888safe.
14889
14890@node Hurd Native
14891@subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14892@cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14893
14894This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14895@sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14896
14897@table @code
14898@item set signals
14899@itemx set sigs
14900@kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14901@kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14902This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14903@value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14904affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14905@code{signals}.
14906
14907@item show signals
14908@itemx show sigs
14909@kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14910@kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14911Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14912
14913@item set signal-thread
14914@itemx set sigthread
14915@kindex set signal-thread
14916@kindex set sigthread
14917This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14918thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14919process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14920signal-thread}.
14921
14922@item show signal-thread
14923@itemx show sigthread
14924@kindex show signal-thread
14925@kindex show sigthread
14926These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14927delivered a signal.
14928
14929@item set stopped
14930@kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14931This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14932as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14933continued by delivering a signal to it.
14934
14935@item show stopped
14936@kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14937This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14938stopped.
14939
14940@item set exceptions
14941@kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14942Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14943When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14944single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14945trapping on.
14946
14947@item show exceptions
14948@kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14949Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14950
14951@item set task pause
14952@kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14953@cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14954@cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14955This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14956Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14957whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14958effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14959to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14960thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14961
14962@item show task pause
14963@kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14964Show the current state of task suspension.
14965
14966@item set task detach-suspend-count
14967@cindex task suspend count
14968@cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14969This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14970@value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14971
14972@item show task detach-suspend-count
14973Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14974
14975@item set task exception-port
14976@itemx set task excp
14977@cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14978This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14979forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14980rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14981
14982@item set noninvasive
14983@cindex noninvasive task options
14984This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14985invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14986is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14987@code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14988
14989@item info send-rights
14990@itemx info receive-rights
14991@itemx info port-rights
14992@itemx info port-sets
14993@itemx info dead-names
14994@itemx info ports
14995@itemx info psets
14996@cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14997@cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14998@cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14999@cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15000@cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15001These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
15002receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
15003There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
15004port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
15005
15006@item set thread pause
15007@kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
15008@cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15009@cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15010This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
15011control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
15012thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
15013off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
15014Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
15015control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
15016task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
15017only the current thread.
15018
15019@item show thread pause
15020@kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
15021This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
15022
15023@item set thread run
15024This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15025
15026@item show thread run
15027Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15028
15029@item set thread detach-suspend-count
15030@cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15031@cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15032This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
15033thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
15034found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
15035takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
15036
15037@item show thread detach-suspend-count
15038Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
15039detaching.
15040
15041@item set thread exception-port
15042@itemx set thread excp
15043Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
15044overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
15045@code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
15046
15047@item set thread takeover-suspend-count
15048Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
15049value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
15050changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
15051
15052@item set thread default
15053@itemx show thread default
15054@cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15055Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
15056default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
15057thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
15058variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
15059threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
15060the non-default commands.
15061@end table
15062
15063
15064@node Neutrino
15065@subsection QNX Neutrino
15066@cindex QNX Neutrino
15067
15068@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
15069Neutrino target:
15070
15071@table @code
15072@item set debug nto-debug
15073@kindex set debug nto-debug
15074When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
15075Neutrino support.
15076
15077@item show debug nto-debug
15078@kindex show debug nto-debug
15079Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
15080@end table
15081
15082
15083@node Embedded OS
15084@section Embedded Operating Systems
15085
15086This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
15087embedded operating systems that are available for several different
15088architectures.
15089
15090@menu
15091* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15092@end menu
15093
15094@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
15095various real-time operating systems.
15096
15097@node VxWorks
15098@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15099
15100@cindex VxWorks
15101
15102@table @code
15103
15104@kindex target vxworks
15105@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
15106A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
15107is the target system's machine name or IP address.
15108
15109@end table
15110
15111On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
15112current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
15113
15114@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
15115VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
15116the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15117both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
15118@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
15119installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
15120@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
15121
15122@table @code
15123@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
15124@kindex vxworks-timeout
15125All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
15126This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15127seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
15128your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
15129of a thin network line.
15130@end table
15131
15132The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
15133this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
15134procedures.
15135
15136@findex INCLUDE_RDB
15137To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
15138to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
15139library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
15140VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
15141kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
15142source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
15143information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
15144manual.
15145@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
15146
15147Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
15148your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15149run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
15150@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
15151
15152@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15153
15154@smallexample
15155(vxgdb)
15156@end smallexample
15157
15158@menu
15159* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
15160* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
15161* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
15162@end menu
15163
15164@node VxWorks Connection
15165@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
15166
15167The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
15168network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
15169
15170@smallexample
15171(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
15172@end smallexample
15173
15174@need 750
15175@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15176
15177@smallexample
15178Attaching remote machine across net...
15179Connected to tt.
15180@end smallexample
15181
15182@need 1000
15183@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
15184loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
15185these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
15186path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
15187to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
15188
15189@smallexample
15190prog.o: No such file or directory.
15191@end smallexample
15192
15193When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
15194the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
15195command again.
15196
15197@node VxWorks Download
15198@subsubsection VxWorks Download
15199
15200@cindex download to VxWorks
15201If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
15202object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
15203@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
15204incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
15205command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
15206to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
15207table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
15208the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
15209filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
15210Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
15211to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
15212the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
15213@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
15214and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
15215program, type this on VxWorks:
15216
15217@smallexample
15218-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
15219@end smallexample
15220
15221@noindent
15222Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15223
15224@smallexample
15225(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
15226(vxgdb) load prog.o
15227@end smallexample
15228
15229@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
15230
15231@smallexample
15232Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
15233@end smallexample
15234
15235You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
15236after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
15237this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
15238auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
15239history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
15240debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
15241table.)
15242
15243@node VxWorks Attach
15244@subsubsection Running Tasks
15245
15246@cindex running VxWorks tasks
15247You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
15248follows:
15249
15250@smallexample
15251(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
15252@end smallexample
15253
15254@noindent
15255where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
15256or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
15257the time of attachment.
15258
15259@node Embedded Processors
15260@section Embedded Processors
15261
15262This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
15263configurations.
15264
15265@cindex send command to simulator
15266Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
15267allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
15268
15269@table @code
15270@item sim @var{command}
15271@kindex sim@r{, a command}
15272Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
15273documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
15274acceptable commands.
15275@end table
15276
15277
15278@menu
15279* ARM:: ARM RDI
15280* M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
15281* M68K:: Motorola M68K
15282* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
15283* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
15284* PA:: HP PA Embedded
15285* PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
15286* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
15287* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
15288* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
15289* AVR:: Atmel AVR
15290* CRIS:: CRIS
15291* Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
15292@end menu
15293
15294@node ARM
15295@subsection ARM
15296@cindex ARM RDI
15297
15298@table @code
15299@kindex target rdi
15300@item target rdi @var{dev}
15301ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
15302use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
15303monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
15304
15305@kindex target rdp
15306@item target rdp @var{dev}
15307ARM Demon monitor.
15308
15309@end table
15310
15311@value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
15312
15313@table @code
15314@item set arm disassembler
15315@kindex set arm
15316This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
15317@code{"std"} style is the standard style.
15318
15319@item show arm disassembler
15320@kindex show arm
15321Show the current disassembly style.
15322
15323@item set arm apcs32
15324@cindex ARM 32-bit mode
15325This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
15326
15327@item show arm apcs32
15328Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
15329
15330@item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
15331This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
15332argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
15333
15334@table @code
15335@item auto
15336Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
15337@item softfpa
15338Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
15339processors.
15340@item fpa
15341GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
15342@item softvfp
15343Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
15344@item vfp
15345VFP co-processor.
15346@end table
15347
15348@item show arm fpu
15349Show the current type of the FPU.
15350
15351@item set arm abi
15352This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
15353
15354@item show arm abi
15355Show the currently used ABI.
15356
15357@item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15358@value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
15359whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
15360@value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
15361available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
15362use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
15363register).
15364
15365@item show arm fallback-mode
15366Show the current fallback instruction mode.
15367
15368@item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15369This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
15370instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
15371causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
15372of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
15373
15374@item show arm force-mode
15375Show the current forced instruction mode.
15376
15377@item set debug arm
15378Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
15379target support subsystem.
15380
15381@item show debug arm
15382Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
15383@end table
15384
15385The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
15386using the RDI interface:
15387
15388@table @code
15389@item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15390@kindex rdilogfile
15391@cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
15392Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
15393With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
15394no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
15395@file{rdi.log}.
15396
15397@item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
15398@kindex rdilogenable
15399Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
15400enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
15401no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
15402ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
15403are logged to a file.
15404
15405@item set rdiromatzero
15406@kindex set rdiromatzero
15407@cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
15408Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
15409vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
15410(the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
15411effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
15412
15413@item show rdiromatzero
15414@kindex show rdiromatzero
15415Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
15416
15417@item set rdiheartbeat
15418@kindex set rdiheartbeat
15419@cindex RDI heartbeat
15420Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
15421turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
15422well as the Angel monitor.
15423
15424@item show rdiheartbeat
15425@kindex show rdiheartbeat
15426Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
15427@end table
15428
15429
15430@node M32R/D
15431@subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
15432
15433@table @code
15434@kindex target m32r
15435@item target m32r @var{dev}
15436Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
15437
15438@kindex target m32rsdi
15439@item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
15440Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
15441@end table
15442
15443The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
15444
15445@table @code
15446@item set download-path @var{path}
15447@kindex set download-path
15448@cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
15449Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15450
15451@item show download-path
15452@kindex show download-path
15453Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15454
15455@item set board-address @var{addr}
15456@kindex set board-address
15457@cindex M32-EVA target board address
15458Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
15459
15460@item show board-address
15461@kindex show board-address
15462Show the current IP address of the target board.
15463
15464@item set server-address @var{addr}
15465@kindex set server-address
15466@cindex download server address (M32R)
15467Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
15468host machine.
15469
15470@item show server-address
15471@kindex show server-address
15472Display the IP address of the download server.
15473
15474@item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15475@kindex upload@r{, M32R}
15476Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
15477upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
15478executable file is uploaded.
15479
15480@item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15481@kindex tload@r{, M32R}
15482Test the @code{upload} command.
15483@end table
15484
15485The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
15486
15487@table @code
15488@item sdireset
15489@kindex sdireset
15490@cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
15491This command resets the SDI connection.
15492
15493@item sdistatus
15494@kindex sdistatus
15495This command shows the SDI connection status.
15496
15497@item debug_chaos
15498@kindex debug_chaos
15499@cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
15500Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
15501
15502@item use_debug_dma
15503@kindex use_debug_dma
15504Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
15505
15506@item use_mon_code
15507@kindex use_mon_code
15508Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
15509
15510@item use_ib_break
15511@kindex use_ib_break
15512Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
15513
15514@item use_dbt_break
15515@kindex use_dbt_break
15516Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
15517@end table
15518
15519@node M68K
15520@subsection M68k
15521
15522The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
15523target command for the following ROM monitor.
15524
15525@table @code
15526
15527@kindex target dbug
15528@item target dbug @var{dev}
15529dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
15530
15531@end table
15532
15533@node MIPS Embedded
15534@subsection MIPS Embedded
15535
15536@cindex MIPS boards
15537@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
15538MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
15539you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
15540
15541@need 1000
15542Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
15543
15544@table @code
15545@item target mips @var{port}
15546@kindex target mips @var{port}
15547To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
15548name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
15549command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
15550the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
15551been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
15552download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
15553
15554For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
15555port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
15556debugger:
15557
15558@smallexample
15559host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
15560@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
15561(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
15562(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
15563(@value{GDBP}) run
15564@end smallexample
15565
15566@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
15567On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
15568connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
15569concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
15570@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15571
15572@item target pmon @var{port}
15573@kindex target pmon @var{port}
15574PMON ROM monitor.
15575
15576@item target ddb @var{port}
15577@kindex target ddb @var{port}
15578NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
15579
15580@item target lsi @var{port}
15581@kindex target lsi @var{port}
15582LSI variant of PMON.
15583
15584@kindex target r3900
15585@item target r3900 @var{dev}
15586Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
15587
15588@kindex target array
15589@item target array @var{dev}
15590Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
15591
15592@end table
15593
15594
15595@noindent
15596@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
15597
15598@table @code
15599@item set mipsfpu double
15600@itemx set mipsfpu single
15601@itemx set mipsfpu none
15602@itemx set mipsfpu auto
15603@itemx show mipsfpu
15604@kindex set mipsfpu
15605@kindex show mipsfpu
15606@cindex MIPS remote floating point
15607@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
15608If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
15609coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
15610need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
15611file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
15612functions which return floating point values. It also allows
15613@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
15614functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
15615with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
15616processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
15617double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
15618@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
15619
15620In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
15621floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
15622and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
15623
15624As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
15625@samp{show mipsfpu}.
15626
15627@item set timeout @var{seconds}
15628@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
15629@itemx show timeout
15630@itemx show retransmit-timeout
15631@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
15632@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
15633@kindex set timeout
15634@kindex show timeout
15635@kindex set retransmit-timeout
15636@kindex show retransmit-timeout
15637You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
15638remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
15639default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
15640waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
15641retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
15642You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
15643retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
15644@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
15645
15646The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
15647is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
15648forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
15649to run before stopping.
15650
15651@item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
15652@kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15653@cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
15654Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
15655it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
15656characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
15657
15658@item show syn-garbage-limit
15659@kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15660Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
15661trying to synchronize with the remote system.
15662
15663@item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
15664@kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15665@cindex remote monitor prompt
15666Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
15667remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
15668@table @asis
15669@item pmon target
15670@samp{PMON}
15671@item ddb target
15672@samp{NEC010}
15673@item lsi target
15674@samp{PMON>}
15675@end table
15676
15677@item show monitor-prompt
15678@kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15679Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
15680remote monitor.
15681
15682@item set monitor-warnings
15683@kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15684Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
15685has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
15686display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
15687PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
15688
15689@item show monitor-warnings
15690@kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15691Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
15692
15693@item pmon @var{command}
15694@kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
15695@cindex send PMON command
15696This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
15697monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
15698@end table
15699
15700@node OpenRISC 1000
15701@subsection OpenRISC 1000
15702@cindex OpenRISC 1000
15703
15704@cindex or1k boards
15705See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15706about platform and commands.
15707
15708@table @code
15709
15710@kindex target jtag
15711@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15712
15713Connects to remote JTAG server.
15714JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15715connected via parallel port to the board.
15716
15717Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15718
15719@kindex or1ksim
15720@item or1ksim @var{command}
15721If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15722Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15723
15724@kindex info or1k spr
15725@item info or1k spr
15726Displays spr groups.
15727
15728@item info or1k spr @var{group}
15729@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15730Displays register names in selected group.
15731
15732@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15733@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15734@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15735@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15736Shows information about specified spr register.
15737
15738@kindex spr
15739@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15740@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15741@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15742@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15743Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15744@end table
15745
15746Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15747It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15748program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15749triggers can be set using:
15750@table @code
15751@item $LEA/$LDATA
15752Load effective address/data
15753@item $SEA/$SDATA
15754Store effective address/data
15755@item $AEA/$ADATA
15756Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15757@item $FETCH
15758Fetch data
15759@end table
15760
15761When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15762@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15763
15764@code{htrace} commands:
15765@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15766@table @code
15767@kindex hwatch
15768@item hwatch @var{conditional}
15769Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15770or Data. For example:
15771
15772@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15773
15774@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15775
15776@kindex htrace
15777@item htrace info
15778Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15779
15780@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15781Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15782
15783@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15784Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15785
15786@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15787Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15788
15789@item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15790Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15791triggered.
15792
15793@item htrace enable
15794@itemx htrace disable
15795Enables/disables the HW trace.
15796
15797@item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15798Clears currently recorded trace data.
15799
15800If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15801will be written there.
15802
15803@item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15804Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15805
15806@item htrace mode continuous
15807Set continuous trace mode.
15808
15809@item htrace mode suspend
15810Set suspend trace mode.
15811
15812@end table
15813
15814@node PowerPC Embedded
15815@subsection PowerPC Embedded
15816
15817@value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15818
15819@table @code
15820@kindex set powerpc
15821@item set powerpc soft-float
15822@itemx show powerpc soft-float
15823Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15824convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15825on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15826
15827@item set powerpc vector-abi
15828@itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15829Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15830arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15831@samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15832@samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15833registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15834based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15835
15836@kindex target dink32
15837@item target dink32 @var{dev}
15838DINK32 ROM monitor.
15839
15840@kindex target ppcbug
15841@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15842@kindex target ppcbug1
15843@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15844PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15845
15846@kindex target sds
15847@item target sds @var{dev}
15848SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15849@end table
15850
15851@cindex SDS protocol
15852The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15853by @value{GDBN}:
15854
15855@table @code
15856@item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15857@kindex set sdstimeout
15858Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15859default is 2 seconds.
15860
15861@item show sdstimeout
15862@kindex show sdstimeout
15863Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15864
15865@item sds @var{command}
15866@kindex sds@r{, a command}
15867Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15868@end table
15869
15870
15871@node PA
15872@subsection HP PA Embedded
15873
15874@table @code
15875
15876@kindex target op50n
15877@item target op50n @var{dev}
15878OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15879
15880@kindex target w89k
15881@item target w89k @var{dev}
15882W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15883
15884@end table
15885
15886@node Sparclet
15887@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15888
15889@cindex Sparclet
15890
15891@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15892Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15893@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15894both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15895@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15896
15897@table @code
15898@item remotetimeout @var{args}
15899@kindex remotetimeout
15900@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15901This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15902seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15903@end table
15904
15905@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15906When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15907information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15908load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15909@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15910
15911@smallexample
15912sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15913@end smallexample
15914
15915You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15916
15917@smallexample
15918sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15919@end smallexample
15920
15921@cindex running, on Sparclet
15922Once you have set
15923your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15924run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15925(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15926
15927@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15928
15929@smallexample
15930(gdbslet)
15931@end smallexample
15932
15933@menu
15934* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15935* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15936* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15937* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15938@end menu
15939
15940@node Sparclet File
15941@subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15942
15943The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15944
15945@smallexample
15946(gdbslet) file prog
15947@end smallexample
15948
15949@need 1000
15950@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15951@value{GDBN} locates
15952the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15953path.
15954If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15955files will be searched as well.
15956@value{GDBN} locates
15957the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15958path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15959If it fails
15960to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15961
15962@smallexample
15963prog: No such file or directory.
15964@end smallexample
15965
15966When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15967the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15968@code{target} command again.
15969
15970@node Sparclet Connection
15971@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15972
15973The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15974To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15975
15976@smallexample
15977(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15978Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15979main () at ../prog.c:3
15980@end smallexample
15981
15982@need 750
15983@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15984
15985@smallexample
15986Connected to ttya.
15987@end smallexample
15988
15989@node Sparclet Download
15990@subsubsection Sparclet Download
15991
15992@cindex download to Sparclet
15993Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15994you can use the @value{GDBN}
15995@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15996The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15997command.
15998Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15999address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
16000offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
16001of each of the file's sections.
16002For instance, if the program
16003@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
16004and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16005
16006@smallexample
16007(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
16008Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
16009@end smallexample
16010
16011If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
16012to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
16013to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
16014
16015@node Sparclet Execution
16016@subsubsection Running and Debugging
16017
16018@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
16019You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
16020commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
16021manual for the list of commands.
16022
16023@smallexample
16024(gdbslet) b main
16025Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
16026(gdbslet) run
16027Starting program: prog
16028Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
160293 char *symarg = 0;
16030(gdbslet) step
160314 char *execarg = "hello!";
16032(gdbslet)
16033@end smallexample
16034
16035@node Sparclite
16036@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
16037
16038@table @code
16039
16040@kindex target sparclite
16041@item target sparclite @var{dev}
16042Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
16043You must use an additional command to debug the program.
16044For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
16045remote protocol.
16046
16047@end table
16048
16049@node Z8000
16050@subsection Zilog Z8000
16051
16052@cindex Z8000
16053@cindex simulator, Z8000
16054@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
16055
16056When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
16057a Z8000 simulator.
16058
16059For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
16060unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
16061segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
16062appropriate by inspecting the object code.
16063
16064@table @code
16065@item target sim @var{args}
16066@kindex sim
16067@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
16068Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
16069options, specify them via @var{args}.
16070@end table
16071
16072@noindent
16073After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
16074CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
16075@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
16076to run your program, and so on.
16077
16078As well as making available all the usual machine registers
16079(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
16080additional items of information as specially named registers:
16081
16082@table @code
16083
16084@item cycles
16085Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
16086
16087@item insts
16088Counts instructions run in the simulator.
16089
16090@item time
16091Execution time in 60ths of a second.
16092
16093@end table
16094
16095You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
16096conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
16097conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
16098simulated clock ticks.
16099
16100@node AVR
16101@subsection Atmel AVR
16102@cindex AVR
16103
16104When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
16105following AVR-specific commands:
16106
16107@table @code
16108@item info io_registers
16109@kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
16110@cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
16111This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
16112each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
16113@end table
16114
16115@node CRIS
16116@subsection CRIS
16117@cindex CRIS
16118
16119When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
16120following CRIS-specific commands:
16121
16122@table @code
16123@item set cris-version @var{ver}
16124@cindex CRIS version
16125Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
16126The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
16127case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
16128
16129@item show cris-version
16130Show the current CRIS version.
16131
16132@item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
16133@cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
16134Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
16135Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
16136@code{R59}.
16137
16138@item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
16139Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
16140
16141@item set cris-mode @var{mode}
16142@cindex CRIS mode
16143Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
16144debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
16145@samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
16146
16147@item show cris-mode
16148Show the current CRIS mode.
16149@end table
16150
16151@node Super-H
16152@subsection Renesas Super-H
16153@cindex Super-H
16154
16155For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
16156commands:
16157
16158@table @code
16159@item regs
16160@kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
16161Show the values of all Super-H registers.
16162
16163@item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
16164@kindex set sh calling-convention
16165Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
16166Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
16167With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
16168convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
16169that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
16170is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
16171is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
16172regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
16173default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
16174does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
16175
16176@item show sh calling-convention
16177@kindex show sh calling-convention
16178Show the current calling convention setting.
16179
16180@end table
16181
16182
16183@node Architectures
16184@section Architectures
16185
16186This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
16187all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
16188
16189@menu
16190* i386::
16191* A29K::
16192* Alpha::
16193* MIPS::
16194* HPPA:: HP PA architecture
16195* SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16196* PowerPC::
16197@end menu
16198
16199@node i386
16200@subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
16201
16202@table @code
16203@item set struct-convention @var{mode}
16204@kindex set struct-convention
16205@cindex struct return convention
16206@cindex struct/union returned in registers
16207Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
16208@code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
16209@var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
16210default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
16211are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
16212@code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
16213be returned in a register.
16214
16215@item show struct-convention
16216@kindex show struct-convention
16217Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
16218from functions.
16219@end table
16220
16221@node A29K
16222@subsection A29K
16223
16224@table @code
16225
16226@kindex set rstack_high_address
16227@cindex AMD 29K register stack
16228@cindex register stack, AMD29K
16229@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
16230On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
16231@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
16232extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
16233stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
16234memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
16235this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
16236the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
16237address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
16238hexadecimal.
16239
16240@kindex show rstack_high_address
16241@item show rstack_high_address
16242Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
16243processors.
16244
16245@end table
16246
16247@node Alpha
16248@subsection Alpha
16249
16250See the following section.
16251
16252@node MIPS
16253@subsection MIPS
16254
16255@cindex stack on Alpha
16256@cindex stack on MIPS
16257@cindex Alpha stack
16258@cindex MIPS stack
16259Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
16260sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
16261find the beginning of a function.
16262
16263@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
16264To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
16265@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
16266you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
16267commands:
16268
16269@table @code
16270@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
16271@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
16272Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
16273search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
16274default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
16275larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
16276and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
16277this command when debugging a stripped executable.
16278
16279@item show heuristic-fence-post
16280Display the current limit.
16281@end table
16282
16283@noindent
16284These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
16285for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
16286
16287Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
16288programs:
16289
16290@table @code
16291@item set mips abi @var{arg}
16292@kindex set mips abi
16293@cindex set ABI for MIPS
16294Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
16295values of @var{arg} are:
16296
16297@table @samp
16298@item auto
16299The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
16300default).
16301@item o32
16302@item o64
16303@item n32
16304@item n64
16305@item eabi32
16306@item eabi64
16307@item auto
16308@end table
16309
16310@item show mips abi
16311@kindex show mips abi
16312Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
16313
16314@item set mipsfpu
16315@itemx show mipsfpu
16316@xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
16317
16318@item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
16319@kindex set mips mask-address
16320@cindex MIPS addresses, masking
16321This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
16322MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
16323@samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
16324setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
16325
16326@item show mips mask-address
16327@kindex show mips mask-address
16328Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
16329not.
16330
16331@item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16332@kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16333This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
16334transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
16335that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
16336and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
16337
16338@item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16339@kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16340Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
16341
16342@item set debug mips
16343@kindex set debug mips
16344This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
16345target code in @value{GDBN}.
16346
16347@item show debug mips
16348@kindex show debug mips
16349Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
16350@end table
16351
16352
16353@node HPPA
16354@subsection HPPA
16355@cindex HPPA support
16356
16357When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
16358following special commands:
16359
16360@table @code
16361@item set debug hppa
16362@kindex set debug hppa
16363This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
16364messages are to be displayed.
16365
16366@item show debug hppa
16367Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
16368
16369@item maint print unwind @var{address}
16370@kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
16371This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
16372given @var{address}.
16373
16374@end table
16375
16376
16377@node SPU
16378@subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16379@cindex Cell Broadband Engine
16380@cindex SPU
16381
16382When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
16383it provides the following special commands:
16384
16385@table @code
16386@item info spu event
16387@kindex info spu
16388Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
16389and pending event status.
16390
16391@item info spu signal
16392Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
16393signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
16394notification channels.
16395
16396@item info spu mailbox
16397Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
16398in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
16399SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
16400
16401@item info spu dma
16402Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16403DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16404and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16405
16406@item info spu proxydma
16407Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16408Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16409and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16410
16411@end table
16412
16413@node PowerPC
16414@subsection PowerPC
16415@cindex PowerPC architecture
16416
16417When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
16418pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
16419numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
16420in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
16421@code{f0} or @code{f2}.
16422
16423The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
16424by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
16425@code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
16426
16427For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
16428wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
16429
16430
16431@node Controlling GDB
16432@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
16433
16434You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
16435@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
16436data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
16437described here.
16438
16439@menu
16440* Prompt:: Prompt
16441* Editing:: Command editing
16442* Command History:: Command history
16443* Screen Size:: Screen size
16444* Numbers:: Numbers
16445* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
16446* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
16447* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
16448@end menu
16449
16450@node Prompt
16451@section Prompt
16452
16453@cindex prompt
16454
16455@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
16456called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
16457can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
16458instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
16459the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
16460which one you are talking to.
16461
16462@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
16463prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
16464or a prompt that does not.
16465
16466@table @code
16467@kindex set prompt
16468@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
16469Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
16470
16471@kindex show prompt
16472@item show prompt
16473Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
16474@end table
16475
16476@node Editing
16477@section Command Editing
16478@cindex readline
16479@cindex command line editing
16480
16481@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
16482@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
16483command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
16484or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
16485substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
16486debugging sessions.
16487
16488You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
16489command @code{set}.
16490
16491@table @code
16492@kindex set editing
16493@cindex editing
16494@item set editing
16495@itemx set editing on
16496Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
16497
16498@item set editing off
16499Disable command line editing.
16500
16501@kindex show editing
16502@item show editing
16503Show whether command line editing is enabled.
16504@end table
16505
16506@xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
16507interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
16508encouraged to read that chapter.
16509
16510@node Command History
16511@section Command History
16512@cindex command history
16513
16514@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
16515debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
16516happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
16517history facility.
16518
16519@value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
16520package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
16521Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
16522
16523To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
16524the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
16525(@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
16526means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
16527affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
16528pressed on a line by itself.
16529
16530@cindex @code{server}, command prefix
16531The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
16532history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
16533use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
16534
16535Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
16536history.
16537
16538@table @code
16539@cindex history substitution
16540@cindex history file
16541@kindex set history filename
16542@cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
16543@item set history filename @var{fname}
16544Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
16545This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
16546list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
16547exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
16548the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
16549to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
16550@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
16551is not set.
16552
16553@cindex save command history
16554@kindex set history save
16555@item set history save
16556@itemx set history save on
16557Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
16558@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
16559
16560@item set history save off
16561Stop recording command history in a file.
16562
16563@cindex history size
16564@kindex set history size
16565@cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
16566@item set history size @var{size}
16567Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
16568This defaults to the value of the environment variable
16569@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
16570@end table
16571
16572History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
16573@xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
16574
16575@cindex history expansion, turn on/off
16576Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
16577is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
16578@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
16579follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
16580a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
16581history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
16582@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
16583
16584The commands to control history expansion are:
16585
16586@table @code
16587@item set history expansion on
16588@itemx set history expansion
16589@kindex set history expansion
16590Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
16591
16592@item set history expansion off
16593Disable history expansion.
16594
16595@c @group
16596@kindex show history
16597@item show history
16598@itemx show history filename
16599@itemx show history save
16600@itemx show history size
16601@itemx show history expansion
16602These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
16603@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
16604@c @end group
16605@end table
16606
16607@table @code
16608@kindex show commands
16609@cindex show last commands
16610@cindex display command history
16611@item show commands
16612Display the last ten commands in the command history.
16613
16614@item show commands @var{n}
16615Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
16616
16617@item show commands +
16618Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
16619@end table
16620
16621@node Screen Size
16622@section Screen Size
16623@cindex size of screen
16624@cindex pauses in output
16625
16626Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
16627information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
16628@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
16629output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
16630to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
16631determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
16632printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
16633rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
16634
16635Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
16636driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
16637together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
16638@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
16639you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
16640width} commands:
16641
16642@table @code
16643@kindex set height
16644@kindex set width
16645@kindex show width
16646@kindex show height
16647@item set height @var{lpp}
16648@itemx show height
16649@itemx set width @var{cpl}
16650@itemx show width
16651These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
16652a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
16653commands display the current settings.
16654
16655If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
16656output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
16657file or to an editor buffer.
16658
16659Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
16660from wrapping its output.
16661
16662@item set pagination on
16663@itemx set pagination off
16664@kindex set pagination
16665Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
16666pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
16667
16668@item show pagination
16669@kindex show pagination
16670Show the current pagination mode.
16671@end table
16672
16673@node Numbers
16674@section Numbers
16675@cindex number representation
16676@cindex entering numbers
16677
16678You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
16679@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
16680@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
16681begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
16682@samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
1668310; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
16684format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
16685both input and output with the commands described below.
16686
16687@table @code
16688@kindex set input-radix
16689@item set input-radix @var{base}
16690Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
16691for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16692specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
16693example, any of
16694
16695@smallexample
16696set input-radix 012
16697set input-radix 10.
16698set input-radix 0xa
16699@end smallexample
16700
16701@noindent
16702sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
16703leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
16704@samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
16705interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
16706@samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
16707change the radix.
16708
16709@kindex set output-radix
16710@item set output-radix @var{base}
16711Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
16712for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16713specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16714
16715@kindex show input-radix
16716@item show input-radix
16717Display the current default base for numeric input.
16718
16719@kindex show output-radix
16720@item show output-radix
16721Display the current default base for numeric display.
16722
16723@item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16724@itemx show radix
16725@kindex set radix
16726@kindex show radix
16727These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16728of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16729the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16730default value of 10.
16731
16732@end table
16733
16734@node ABI
16735@section Configuring the Current ABI
16736
16737@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16738application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16739conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16740current ABI.
16741
16742@cindex OS ABI
16743@kindex set osabi
16744@kindex show osabi
16745
16746One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16747system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16748@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16749but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16750One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16751an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16752not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16753platform provides.
16754
16755@table @code
16756@item show osabi
16757Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16758
16759@item set osabi
16760With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16761
16762@item set osabi @var{abi}
16763Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16764@end table
16765
16766@cindex float promotion
16767
16768Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16769function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16770(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16771according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16772(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16773@code{double} and then passed.
16774
16775Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16776a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16777as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16778
16779@table @code
16780@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16781@item set coerce-float-to-double
16782@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16783Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16784to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16785
16786@item set coerce-float-to-double off
16787Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16788functions.
16789
16790@kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16791@item show coerce-float-to-double
16792Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16793@end table
16794
16795@kindex set cp-abi
16796@kindex show cp-abi
16797@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16798objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16799used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16800programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16801multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16802program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16803Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16804before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16805``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16806use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16807``auto''.
16808
16809@table @code
16810@item show cp-abi
16811Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16812
16813@item set cp-abi
16814With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16815
16816@item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16817@itemx set cp-abi auto
16818Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16819@end table
16820
16821@node Messages/Warnings
16822@section Optional Warnings and Messages
16823
16824@cindex verbose operation
16825@cindex optional warnings
16826By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16827running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16828command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16829internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16830
16831Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16832which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16833see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16834
16835@table @code
16836@kindex set verbose
16837@item set verbose on
16838Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16839
16840@item set verbose off
16841Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16842
16843@kindex show verbose
16844@item show verbose
16845Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16846@end table
16847
16848By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16849object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16850find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16851Symbol Files}).
16852
16853@table @code
16854
16855@kindex set complaints
16856@item set complaints @var{limit}
16857Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16858unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16859@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16860to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16861
16862@kindex show complaints
16863@item show complaints
16864Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16865
16866@end table
16867
16868By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16869lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16870you try to run a program which is already running:
16871
16872@smallexample
16873(@value{GDBP}) run
16874The program being debugged has been started already.
16875Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16876@end smallexample
16877
16878If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16879commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16880
16881@table @code
16882
16883@kindex set confirm
16884@cindex flinching
16885@cindex confirmation
16886@cindex stupid questions
16887@item set confirm off
16888Disables confirmation requests.
16889
16890@item set confirm on
16891Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16892
16893@kindex show confirm
16894@item show confirm
16895Displays state of confirmation requests.
16896
16897@end table
16898
16899@cindex command tracing
16900If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16901useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16902printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16903quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16904
16905@table @code
16906@kindex set trace-commands
16907@cindex command scripts, debugging
16908@item set trace-commands on
16909Enable command tracing.
16910@item set trace-commands off
16911Disable command tracing.
16912@item show trace-commands
16913Display the current state of command tracing.
16914@end table
16915
16916@node Debugging Output
16917@section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16918@cindex optional debugging messages
16919
16920@value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16921various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16922interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16923section documents those commands.
16924
16925@table @code
16926@kindex set exec-done-display
16927@item set exec-done-display
16928Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16929completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16930asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16931@kindex show exec-done-display
16932@item show exec-done-display
16933Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16934notification.
16935@kindex set debug
16936@cindex gdbarch debugging info
16937@cindex architecture debugging info
16938@item set debug arch
16939Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16940@kindex show debug
16941@item show debug arch
16942Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16943@item set debug aix-thread
16944@cindex AIX threads
16945Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16946module.
16947@item show debug aix-thread
16948Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16949@item set debug displaced
16950@cindex displaced stepping debugging info
16951Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
16952displaced stepping support. The default is off.
16953@item show debug displaced
16954Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
16955related to displaced stepping.
16956@item set debug event
16957@cindex event debugging info
16958Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16959default is off.
16960@item show debug event
16961Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16962info.
16963@item set debug expression
16964@cindex expression debugging info
16965Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16966expression parsing. The default is off.
16967@item show debug expression
16968Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16969@value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16970@item set debug frame
16971@cindex frame debugging info
16972Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16973default is off.
16974@item show debug frame
16975Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16976info.
16977@item set debug infrun
16978@cindex inferior debugging info
16979Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16980The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16981for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16982@item show debug infrun
16983Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16984@item set debug lin-lwp
16985@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16986@cindex Linux lightweight processes
16987Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16988@item show debug lin-lwp
16989Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16990@item set debug lin-lwp-async
16991@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
16992@cindex Linux lightweight processes
16993Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
16994@item show debug lin-lwp-async
16995Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
16996@item set debug observer
16997@cindex observer debugging info
16998Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16999includes info such as the notification of observable events.
17000@item show debug observer
17001Displays the current state of observer debugging.
17002@item set debug overload
17003@cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
17004Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
17005info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
17006is off.
17007@item show debug overload
17008Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
17009debugging info.
17010@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
17011@cindex serial connections, debugging
17012@cindex debug remote protocol
17013@cindex remote protocol debugging
17014@cindex display remote packets
17015@item set debug remote
17016Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
17017the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
17018@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
17019@item show debug remote
17020Displays the state of display of remote packets.
17021@item set debug serial
17022Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
17023default is off.
17024@item show debug serial
17025Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
17026info.
17027@item set debug solib-frv
17028@cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
17029Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
17030@item show debug solib-frv
17031Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
17032messages.
17033@item set debug target
17034@cindex target debugging info
17035Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
17036includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
17037default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
17038value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
17039until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
17040@item show debug target
17041Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
17042info.
17043@item set debug timestamp
17044@cindex timestampping debugging info
17045Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
17046When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
17047message.
17048@item show debug timestamp
17049Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
17050debugging info.
17051@item set debugvarobj
17052@cindex variable object debugging info
17053Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
17054info. The default is off.
17055@item show debugvarobj
17056Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
17057debugging info.
17058@item set debug xml
17059@cindex XML parser debugging
17060Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
17061@item show debug xml
17062Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
17063@end table
17064
17065@node Extending GDB
17066@chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
17067@cindex extending GDB
17068
17069@value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
17070on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
17071Python scripting language.
17072
17073@menu
17074* Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
17075* Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17076@end menu
17077
17078@node Sequences
17079@section Canned Sequences of Commands
17080
17081Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
17082Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
17083commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
17084files.
17085
17086@menu
17087* Define:: How to define your own commands
17088* Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
17089* Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
17090* Output:: Commands for controlled output
17091@end menu
17092
17093@node Define
17094@subsection User-defined Commands
17095
17096@cindex user-defined command
17097@cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
17098A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
17099which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
17100@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
17101separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
17102via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
17103
17104@smallexample
17105define adder
17106 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17107end
17108@end smallexample
17109
17110@noindent
17111To execute the command use:
17112
17113@smallexample
17114adder 1 2 3
17115@end smallexample
17116
17117@noindent
17118This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
17119its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
17120reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
17121functions calls.
17122
17123@cindex argument count in user-defined commands
17124@cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
17125In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
17126been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
17127
17128@smallexample
17129define adder
17130 if $argc == 2
17131 print $arg0 + $arg1
17132 end
17133 if $argc == 3
17134 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17135 end
17136end
17137@end smallexample
17138
17139@table @code
17140
17141@kindex define
17142@item define @var{commandname}
17143Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
17144by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
17145
17146The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
17147which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
17148commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17149
17150@kindex document
17151@kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
17152@item document @var{commandname}
17153Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
17154accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
17155defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
17156reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
17157After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
17158@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
17159
17160You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
17161documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
17162does not change the documentation.
17163
17164@kindex dont-repeat
17165@cindex don't repeat command
17166@item dont-repeat
17167Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
17168command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
17169(@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
17170
17171@kindex help user-defined
17172@item help user-defined
17173List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
17174(if any) for each.
17175
17176@kindex show user
17177@item show user
17178@itemx show user @var{commandname}
17179Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
17180not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
17181definitions for all user-defined commands.
17182
17183@cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
17184@kindex show max-user-call-depth
17185@kindex set max-user-call-depth
17186@item show max-user-call-depth
17187@itemx set max-user-call-depth
17188The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
17189levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
17190infinite recursion and aborts the command.
17191@end table
17192
17193In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
17194use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
17195
17196When user-defined commands are executed, the
17197commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
17198stops execution of the user-defined command.
17199
17200If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
17201without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
17202commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
17203messages when used in a user-defined command.
17204
17205@node Hooks
17206@subsection User-defined Command Hooks
17207@cindex command hooks
17208@cindex hooks, for commands
17209@cindex hooks, pre-command
17210
17211@kindex hook
17212You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
17213command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
17214command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
17215before that command.
17216
17217@cindex hooks, post-command
17218@kindex hookpost
17219A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
17220Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
17221@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
17222that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
17223pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
17224
17225It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
17226occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
17227
17228@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
17229@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
17230
17231@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
17232In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
17233(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
17234execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
17235displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
17236
17237For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
17238single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
17239you could define:
17240
17241@smallexample
17242define hook-stop
17243handle SIGALRM nopass
17244end
17245
17246define hook-run
17247handle SIGALRM pass
17248end
17249
17250define hook-continue
17251handle SIGALRM pass
17252end
17253@end smallexample
17254
17255As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
17256command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
17257you could define:
17258
17259@smallexample
17260define hook-echo
17261echo <<<---
17262end
17263
17264define hookpost-echo
17265echo --->>>\n
17266end
17267
17268(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
17269<<<---Hello World--->>>
17270(@value{GDBP})
17271
17272@end smallexample
17273
17274You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
17275not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
17276name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
17277@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
17278@c or not?
17279If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
17280@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
17281(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
17282
17283If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
17284get a warning from the @code{define} command.
17285
17286@node Command Files
17287@subsection Command Files
17288
17289@cindex command files
17290@cindex scripting commands
17291A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
17292@value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
17293also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
17294does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
17295terminal.
17296
17297You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
17298command:
17299
17300@table @code
17301@kindex source
17302@cindex execute commands from a file
17303@item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
17304Execute the command file @var{filename}.
17305@end table
17306
17307The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
17308unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
17309@emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
17310printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
17311execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
17312
17313@value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
17314on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
17315
17316If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
17317each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
17318@var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
17319
17320Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
17321without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
17322normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
17323when called from command files.
17324
17325@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
17326mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
17327standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
17328not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
17329the next command.
17330
17331@smallexample
17332gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
17333@end smallexample
17334
17335(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
17336will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
17337would be directed to @file{log}.
17338
17339Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
17340commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
17341complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
17342variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
17343built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
17344deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
17345complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
17346conditionally, etc.
17347
17348@table @code
17349@kindex if
17350@kindex else
17351@item if
17352@itemx else
17353This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
17354commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
17355expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
17356are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
17357There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
17358of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
17359end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17360
17361@kindex while
17362@item while
17363This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
17364@code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
17365to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
17366line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
17367@dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
17368executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
17369
17370@kindex loop_break
17371@item loop_break
17372This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
17373Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
17374line.
17375
17376@kindex loop_continue
17377@item loop_continue
17378This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
17379in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
17380branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
17381the controlling expression.
17382
17383@kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
17384@item end
17385Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
17386@code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
17387@end table
17388
17389
17390@node Output
17391@subsection Commands for Controlled Output
17392
17393During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
17394@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
17395explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
17396describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
17397want.
17398
17399@table @code
17400@kindex echo
17401@item echo @var{text}
17402@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
17403@c because it is not in ANSI.
17404Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
17405@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
17406newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
17407In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
17408by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
17409string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
17410trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
17411To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
17412@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
17413
17414A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
17415the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
17416
17417@smallexample
17418echo This is some text\n\
17419which is continued\n\
17420onto several lines.\n
17421@end smallexample
17422
17423produces the same output as
17424
17425@smallexample
17426echo This is some text\n
17427echo which is continued\n
17428echo onto several lines.\n
17429@end smallexample
17430
17431@kindex output
17432@item output @var{expression}
17433Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
17434newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
17435value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
17436on expressions.
17437
17438@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
17439Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
17440the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
17441Formats}, for more information.
17442
17443@kindex printf
17444@item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
17445Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
17446the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
17447@var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
17448which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
17449specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
17450executing the code below:
17451
17452@smallexample
17453printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
17454@end smallexample
17455
17456As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
17457are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
17458by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
17459evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
17460style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
17461printed.
17462
17463For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
17464
17465@smallexample
17466printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
17467@end smallexample
17468
17469@code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
17470specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
17471character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
17472
17473@itemize @bullet
17474@item
17475The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
17476
17477@item
17478The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
17479width.
17480
17481@item
17482The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
17483@code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
17484
17485@item
17486The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
17487supported.
17488
17489@item
17490The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
17491
17492@item
17493The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
17494@end itemize
17495
17496@noindent
17497Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
17498underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
17499the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
17500supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
17501
17502As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
17503sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
17504@samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
17505single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
17506supported.
17507
17508Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
17509(@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
17510together with a floating point specifier.
17511letters:
17512
17513@itemize @bullet
17514@item
17515@samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
17516
17517@item
17518@samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
17519
17520@item
17521@samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
17522@end itemize
17523
17524If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
17525support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
17526such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
17527
17528In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
17529available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
17530
17531Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
17532@smallexample
17533printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
17534@end smallexample
17535
17536@end table
17537
17538@node Python
17539@section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17540@cindex python scripting
17541@cindex scripting with python
17542
17543You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
17544Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
17545@value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
17546
17547@menu
17548* Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
17549* Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
17550@end menu
17551
17552@node Python Commands
17553@subsection Python Commands
17554@cindex python commands
17555@cindex commands to access python
17556
17557@value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
17558and one related setting:
17559
17560@table @code
17561@kindex python
17562@item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
17563The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
17564
17565If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
17566argument as a Python command. For example:
17567
17568@smallexample
17569(@value{GDBP}) python print 23
1757023
17571@end smallexample
17572
17573If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
17574multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
17575script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
17576@code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
17577containing @code{end}. For example:
17578
17579@smallexample
17580(@value{GDBP}) python
17581Type python script
17582End with a line saying just "end".
17583>print 23
17584>end
1758523
17586@end smallexample
17587
17588@kindex maint set python print-stack
17589@item maint set python print-stack
17590By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
17591in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
17592python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
17593printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
17594disabled.
17595@end table
17596
17597@node Python API
17598@subsection Python API
17599@cindex python api
17600@cindex programming in python
17601
17602@cindex python stdout
17603@cindex python pagination
17604At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
17605@code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
17606A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
17607output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
17608situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
17609
17610@menu
17611* Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
17612* Exception Handling::
17613@end menu
17614
17615@node Basic Python
17616@subsubsection Basic Python
17617
17618@cindex python functions
17619@cindex python module
17620@cindex gdb module
17621@value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
17622methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
17623@value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
17624use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
17625
17626@findex gdb.execute
17627@defun execute command
17628Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17629If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
17630translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
17631If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
17632@end defun
17633
17634@findex gdb.get_parameter
17635@defun get_parameter parameter
17636Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
17637string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
17638spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
17639@samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
17640
17641If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
17642@code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
17643a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
17644@end defun
17645
17646@findex gdb.write
17647@defun write string
17648Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
17649Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
17650call this function.
17651@end defun
17652
17653@findex gdb.flush
17654@defun flush
17655Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
17656@code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
17657function.
17658@end defun
17659
17660@node Exception Handling
17661@subsubsection Exception Handling
17662@cindex python exceptions
17663@cindex exceptions, python
17664
17665When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
17666uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
17667@value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
17668@code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
17669terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
17670exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
17671backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
17672
17673@smallexample
17674(@value{GDBP}) python print foo
17675Traceback (most recent call last):
17676 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
17677NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
17678@end smallexample
17679
17680@value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
17681code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
17682interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
17683prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
17684exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
17685exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
17686@code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
17687message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
17688Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
17689traceback.
17690
17691@node Interpreters
17692@chapter Command Interpreters
17693@cindex command interpreters
17694
17695@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
17696infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
17697between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
17698
17699@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
17700interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
17701and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
17702describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
17703
17704By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
17705However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
17706interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
17707startup options. Defined interpreters include:
17708
17709@table @code
17710@item console
17711@cindex console interpreter
17712The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
17713used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
17714@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
17715
17716@item mi
17717@cindex mi interpreter
17718The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
17719by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
17720or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
17721Interface}.
17722
17723@item mi2
17724@cindex mi2 interpreter
17725The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
17726
17727@item mi1
17728@cindex mi1 interpreter
17729The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
17730
17731@end table
17732
17733@cindex invoke another interpreter
17734The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
17735switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
17736precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
17737enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
17738@value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
17739the IDE inoperable!
17740
17741@kindex interpreter-exec
17742Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
17743commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
17744command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
17745@code{interpreter-exec} command:
17746
17747@smallexample
17748interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
17749@end smallexample
17750
17751@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
17752@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
17753
17754@node TUI
17755@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
17756@cindex TUI
17757@cindex Text User Interface
17758
17759@menu
17760* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
17761* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
17762* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
17763* TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
17764* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
17765@end menu
17766
17767The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
17768interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
17769file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
17770commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
17771on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
17772is available.
17773
17774@pindex @value{GDBTUI}
17775The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
17776either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
17777You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
17778using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
17779@xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
17780
17781@node TUI Overview
17782@section TUI Overview
17783
17784In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
17785
17786@table @emph
17787@item command
17788This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
17789prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
17790managed using readline.
17791
17792@item source
17793The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
17794line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
17795
17796@item assembly
17797The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
17798
17799@item register
17800This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
17801when their values change.
17802@end table
17803
17804The source and assembly windows show the current program position
17805by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
17806Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
17807indicates the breakpoint type:
17808
17809@table @code
17810@item B
17811Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17812
17813@item b
17814Breakpoint which was never hit.
17815
17816@item H
17817Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17818
17819@item h
17820Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
17821@end table
17822
17823The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
17824
17825@table @code
17826@item +
17827Breakpoint is enabled.
17828
17829@item -
17830Breakpoint is disabled.
17831@end table
17832
17833The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
17834thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
17835changes.
17836
17837These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
17838window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
17839layouts:
17840
17841@itemize @bullet
17842@item
17843source only,
17844
17845@item
17846assembly only,
17847
17848@item
17849source and assembly,
17850
17851@item
17852source and registers, or
17853
17854@item
17855assembly and registers.
17856@end itemize
17857
17858A status line above the command window shows the following information:
17859
17860@table @emph
17861@item target
17862Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
17863(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
17864
17865@item process
17866Gives the current process or thread number.
17867When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
17868
17869@item function
17870Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
17871The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
17872When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
17873the string @code{??} is displayed.
17874
17875@item line
17876Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
17877When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
17878
17879@item pc
17880Indicates the current program counter address.
17881@end table
17882
17883@node TUI Keys
17884@section TUI Key Bindings
17885@cindex TUI key bindings
17886
17887The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
17888(@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
17889are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
17890
17891@table @kbd
17892@kindex C-x C-a
17893@item C-x C-a
17894@kindex C-x a
17895@itemx C-x a
17896@kindex C-x A
17897@itemx C-x A
17898Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
17899the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
17900its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
17901the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
17902The screen is then refreshed.
17903
17904@kindex C-x 1
17905@item C-x 1
17906Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
17907either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
17908is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
17909
17910Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
17911
17912@kindex C-x 2
17913@item C-x 2
17914Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
17915layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
17916When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
17917previous layout and the new one.
17918
17919Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
17920
17921@kindex C-x o
17922@item C-x o
17923Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17924(like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
17925gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17926
17927Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17928
17929@kindex C-x s
17930@item C-x s
17931Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
17932keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17933@end table
17934
17935The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
17936
17937@table @asis
17938@kindex PgUp
17939@item @key{PgUp}
17940Scroll the active window one page up.
17941
17942@kindex PgDn
17943@item @key{PgDn}
17944Scroll the active window one page down.
17945
17946@kindex Up
17947@item @key{Up}
17948Scroll the active window one line up.
17949
17950@kindex Down
17951@item @key{Down}
17952Scroll the active window one line down.
17953
17954@kindex Left
17955@item @key{Left}
17956Scroll the active window one column left.
17957
17958@kindex Right
17959@item @key{Right}
17960Scroll the active window one column right.
17961
17962@kindex C-L
17963@item @kbd{C-L}
17964Refresh the screen.
17965@end table
17966
17967Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17968are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17969window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17970other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17971and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17972
17973@node TUI Single Key Mode
17974@section TUI Single Key Mode
17975@cindex TUI single key mode
17976
17977The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17978frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17979switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17980
17981@table @kbd
17982@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17983@item c
17984continue
17985
17986@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17987@item d
17988down
17989
17990@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17991@item f
17992finish
17993
17994@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17995@item n
17996next
17997
17998@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17999@item q
18000exit the SingleKey mode.
18001
18002@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18003@item r
18004run
18005
18006@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18007@item s
18008step
18009
18010@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18011@item u
18012up
18013
18014@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18015@item v
18016info locals
18017
18018@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18019@item w
18020where
18021@end table
18022
18023Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
18024The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
18025it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
18026with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
18027SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
18028this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
18029
18030
18031@node TUI Commands
18032@section TUI-specific Commands
18033@cindex TUI commands
18034
18035The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
18036These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
18037the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
18038of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
18039
18040@table @code
18041@item info win
18042@kindex info win
18043List and give the size of all displayed windows.
18044
18045@item layout next
18046@kindex layout
18047Display the next layout.
18048
18049@item layout prev
18050Display the previous layout.
18051
18052@item layout src
18053Display the source window only.
18054
18055@item layout asm
18056Display the assembly window only.
18057
18058@item layout split
18059Display the source and assembly window.
18060
18061@item layout regs
18062Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
18063
18064@item focus next
18065@kindex focus
18066Make the next window active for scrolling.
18067
18068@item focus prev
18069Make the previous window active for scrolling.
18070
18071@item focus src
18072Make the source window active for scrolling.
18073
18074@item focus asm
18075Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
18076
18077@item focus regs
18078Make the register window active for scrolling.
18079
18080@item focus cmd
18081Make the command window active for scrolling.
18082
18083@item refresh
18084@kindex refresh
18085Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
18086
18087@item tui reg float
18088@kindex tui reg
18089Show the floating point registers in the register window.
18090
18091@item tui reg general
18092Show the general registers in the register window.
18093
18094@item tui reg next
18095Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
18096their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
18097following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
18098@code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
18099
18100@item tui reg system
18101Show the system registers in the register window.
18102
18103@item update
18104@kindex update
18105Update the source window and the current execution point.
18106
18107@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
18108@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
18109@kindex winheight
18110Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
18111lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
18112decrease it.
18113
18114@item tabset @var{nchars}
18115@kindex tabset
18116Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
18117@end table
18118
18119@node TUI Configuration
18120@section TUI Configuration Variables
18121@cindex TUI configuration variables
18122
18123Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
18124
18125@table @code
18126@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
18127@kindex set tui border-kind
18128Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
18129The possible values are the following:
18130@table @code
18131@item space
18132Use a space character to draw the border.
18133
18134@item ascii
18135Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
18136
18137@item acs
18138Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
18139drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
18140@end table
18141
18142@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
18143@kindex set tui border-mode
18144@itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
18145@kindex set tui active-border-mode
18146Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
18147or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
18148@table @code
18149@item normal
18150Use normal attributes to display the border.
18151
18152@item standout
18153Use standout mode.
18154
18155@item reverse
18156Use reverse video mode.
18157
18158@item half
18159Use half bright mode.
18160
18161@item half-standout
18162Use half bright and standout mode.
18163
18164@item bold
18165Use extra bright or bold mode.
18166
18167@item bold-standout
18168Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
18169@end table
18170@end table
18171
18172@node Emacs
18173@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
18174
18175@cindex Emacs
18176@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
18177A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
18178edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
18179@value{GDBN}.
18180
18181To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
18182executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
18183@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
18184created Emacs buffer.
18185@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
18186
18187Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
18188things:
18189
18190@itemize @bullet
18191@item
18192All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
18193the GUD buffer.
18194
18195This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
18196and output done by the program you are debugging.
18197
18198This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
18199commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
18200in this way.
18201
18202All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
18203with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
18204way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
18205stop.
18206
18207@item
18208@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
18209
18210Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
18211source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
18212left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
18213source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
18214and the source.
18215
18216Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
18217usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
18218@end itemize
18219
18220We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
18221a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
18222that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
18223@xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
18224
18225If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
18226gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
18227your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
18228sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
18229with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
18230program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
18231some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
18232@value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
18233buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
18234
18235The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
18236line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
18237that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
18238,Commands to Specify Files}.
18239
18240By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
18241need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
18242keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
18243customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
18244one you want.
18245
18246In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
18247addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
18248
18249@table @kbd
18250@item C-h m
18251Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
18252
18253@item C-c C-s
18254Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
18255update the display window to show the current file and location.
18256
18257@item C-c C-n
18258Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
18259calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
18260to show the current file and location.
18261
18262@item C-c C-i
18263Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
18264display window accordingly.
18265
18266@item C-c C-f
18267Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
18268@code{finish} command.
18269
18270@item C-c C-r
18271Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
18272command.
18273
18274@item C-c <
18275Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
18276(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
18277like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
18278
18279@item C-c >
18280Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
18281@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
18282@end table
18283
18284In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
18285tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
18286
18287In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
18288separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
18289Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
18290become the current frame and display the associated source in the
18291source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
18292selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
18293speedbar displays watch expressions.
18294
18295If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
18296it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
18297request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
18298the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
18299frame.
18300
18301The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
18302which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
18303the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
18304communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
18305delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
18306to correspond properly with the code.
18307
18308A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
18309given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
18310Emacs Manual}).
18311
18312@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
18313@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
18314@ignore
18315@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
18316@kindex Epoch
18317@kindex inspect
18318
18319Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
18320called the @code{epoch}
18321environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
18322@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
18323each value is printed in its own window.
18324@end ignore
18325
18326
18327@node GDB/MI
18328@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
18329
18330@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
18331
18332@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
18333@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
18334@value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
18335@option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
18336is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
18337use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
18338
18339This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
18340in the form of a reference manual.
18341
18342Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
18343features described below are incomplete and subject to change
18344(@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
18345
18346@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
18347
18348@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
18349This chapter uses the following notation:
18350
18351@itemize @bullet
18352@item
18353@code{|} separates two alternatives.
18354
18355@item
18356@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
18357it may or may not be given.
18358
18359@item
18360@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
18361may repeat zero or more times.
18362
18363@item
18364@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
18365may repeat one or more times.
18366
18367@item
18368@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
18369@end itemize
18370
18371@ignore
18372@heading Dependencies
18373@end ignore
18374
18375@menu
18376* GDB/MI Command Syntax::
18377* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
18378* GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
18379* GDB/MI Output Records::
18380* GDB/MI Simple Examples::
18381* GDB/MI Command Description Format::
18382* GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
18383* GDB/MI Program Context::
18384* GDB/MI Thread Commands::
18385* GDB/MI Program Execution::
18386* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
18387* GDB/MI Variable Objects::
18388* GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
18389* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
18390* GDB/MI Symbol Query::
18391* GDB/MI File Commands::
18392@ignore
18393* GDB/MI Kod Commands::
18394* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
18395* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
18396@end ignore
18397* GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
18398* GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
18399* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
18400@end menu
18401
18402@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18403@node GDB/MI Command Syntax
18404@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
18405
18406@menu
18407* GDB/MI Input Syntax::
18408* GDB/MI Output Syntax::
18409@end menu
18410
18411@node GDB/MI Input Syntax
18412@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
18413
18414@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
18415@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
18416@table @code
18417@item @var{command} @expansion{}
18418@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
18419
18420@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
18421@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
18422@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
18423
18424@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
18425@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
18426@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
18427
18428@item @var{token} @expansion{}
18429"any sequence of digits"
18430
18431@item @var{option} @expansion{}
18432@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
18433
18434@item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
18435@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
18436
18437@item @var{operation} @expansion{}
18438@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
18439
18440@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
18441@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
18442"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
18443
18444@item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
18445@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
18446
18447@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
18448@code{CR | CR-LF}
18449@end table
18450
18451@noindent
18452Notes:
18453
18454@itemize @bullet
18455@item
18456The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
18457output is described below.
18458
18459@item
18460The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
18461finishes.
18462
18463@item
18464Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
18465list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
18466followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
18467parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
18468@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
18469@end itemize
18470
18471Pragmatics:
18472
18473@itemize @bullet
18474@item
18475We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
18476
18477@item
18478We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
18479@end itemize
18480
18481@node GDB/MI Output Syntax
18482@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
18483
18484@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
18485@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
18486The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
18487followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
18488is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
18489terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
18490
18491If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
18492corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
18493@var{token}.
18494
18495@table @code
18496@item @var{output} @expansion{}
18497@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
18498
18499@item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
18500@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
18501
18502@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
18503@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
18504
18505@item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
18506@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
18507
18508@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
18509@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
18510
18511@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
18512@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
18513
18514@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
18515@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
18516
18517@item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
18518@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
18519
18520@item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
18521@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
18522
18523@item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
18524@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
18525depending on the needs---this is still in development).
18526
18527@item @var{result} @expansion{}
18528@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
18529
18530@item @var{variable} @expansion{}
18531@code{ @var{string} }
18532
18533@item @var{value} @expansion{}
18534@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
18535
18536@item @var{const} @expansion{}
18537@code{@var{c-string}}
18538
18539@item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
18540@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
18541
18542@item @var{list} @expansion{}
18543@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
18544@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
18545
18546@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
18547@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
18548
18549@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
18550@code{"~" @var{c-string}}
18551
18552@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
18553@code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
18554
18555@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
18556@code{"&" @var{c-string}}
18557
18558@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
18559@code{CR | CR-LF}
18560
18561@item @var{token} @expansion{}
18562@emph{any sequence of digits}.
18563@end table
18564
18565@noindent
18566Notes:
18567
18568@itemize @bullet
18569@item
18570All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
18571
18572@item
18573The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
18574for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
18575may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
18576output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
18577all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
18578target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
18579prior command.
18580
18581@item
18582@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18583@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
18584progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
18585prefixed by @samp{+}.
18586
18587@item
18588@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18589@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
18590(stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
18591@samp{*}.
18592
18593@item
18594@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18595@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
18596client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
18597output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
18598
18599@item
18600@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18601@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
18602console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
18603output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
18604
18605@item
18606@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18607@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
18608All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
18609
18610@item
18611@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18612@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
18613instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
18614the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
18615
18616@item
18617@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18618New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
18619@var{values}.
18620
18621
18622@end itemize
18623
18624@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
18625details about the various output records.
18626
18627@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18628@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
18629@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
18630
18631@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
18632@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
18633
18634For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
18635but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
18636that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
18637command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
18638@code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
18639@samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
18640
18641This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
18642recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
18643(@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
18644
18645@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18646@node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
18647@section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
18648@cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
18649
18650The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
18651program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
18652
18653Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
18654by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
18655to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
18656section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
18657might change.
18658
18659Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
18660for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
18661list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
18662parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
18663
18664@itemize @bullet
18665@item
18666New MI commands may be added.
18667
18668@item
18669New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
18670
18671@item
18672The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
18673@code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
18674
18675@c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
18676@c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
18677
18678@c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
18679@c resolve inconsistencies.
18680@end itemize
18681
18682If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
18683will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
18684output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
18685@value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
18686responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
18687
18688@c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
18689@c version?
18690
18691The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
18692end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
18693follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
18694@email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
18695@cindex mailing lists
18696
18697@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18698@node GDB/MI Output Records
18699@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
18700
18701@menu
18702* GDB/MI Result Records::
18703* GDB/MI Stream Records::
18704* GDB/MI Async Records::
18705@end menu
18706
18707@node GDB/MI Result Records
18708@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
18709
18710@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18711@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
18712In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
18713@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
18714
18715@table @code
18716@findex ^done
18717@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
18718The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
18719values.
18720
18721@item "^running"
18722@findex ^running
18723@c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
18724The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
18725running.
18726
18727@item "^connected"
18728@findex ^connected
18729@value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
18730
18731@item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
18732@findex ^error
18733The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
18734error message.
18735
18736@item "^exit"
18737@findex ^exit
18738@value{GDBN} has terminated.
18739
18740@end table
18741
18742@node GDB/MI Stream Records
18743@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
18744
18745@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
18746@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18747@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
18748target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
18749funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
18750
18751Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
18752identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
18753Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
18754@code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
18755line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
18756
18757@table @code
18758@item "~" @var{string-output}
18759The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
18760CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
18761
18762@item "@@" @var{string-output}
18763The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
18764target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
18765asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
18766
18767@item "&" @var{string-output}
18768The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
18769internals.
18770@end table
18771
18772@node GDB/MI Async Records
18773@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
18774
18775@cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18776@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
18777@dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
18778additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
18779consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
18780target activity (e.g., target stopped).
18781
18782The following is the list of possible async records:
18783
18784@table @code
18785
18786@item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
18787The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
18788specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
18789are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
18790running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
18791The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
18792only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
18793several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
18794all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
18795be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
18796
18797@item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
18798The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
18799following values:
18800
18801@table @code
18802@item breakpoint-hit
18803A breakpoint was reached.
18804@item watchpoint-trigger
18805A watchpoint was triggered.
18806@item read-watchpoint-trigger
18807A read watchpoint was triggered.
18808@item access-watchpoint-trigger
18809An access watchpoint was triggered.
18810@item function-finished
18811An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18812@item location-reached
18813An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18814@item watchpoint-scope
18815A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
18816@item end-stepping-range
18817An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
18818similar CLI command was accomplished.
18819@item exited-signalled
18820The inferior exited because of a signal.
18821@item exited
18822The inferior exited.
18823@item exited-normally
18824The inferior exited normally.
18825@item signal-received
18826A signal was received by the inferior.
18827@end table
18828
18829@item =thread-created,id="@var{id}"
18830@itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}"
18831A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
18832contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread.
18833@end table
18834
18835
18836
18837@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18838@node GDB/MI Simple Examples
18839@section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
18840@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
18841
18842This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
18843the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
18844following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
18845the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
18846
18847Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
18848readability, they don't appear in the real output.
18849
18850@subheading Setting a Breakpoint
18851
18852Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
18853information of the breakpoint.
18854
18855@smallexample
18856-> -break-insert main
18857<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18858 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
18859 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
18860<- (gdb)
18861@end smallexample
18862
18863@subheading Program Execution
18864
18865Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
18866reason that execution stopped.
18867
18868@smallexample
18869-> -exec-run
18870<- ^running
18871<- (gdb)
18872<- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
18873 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
18874 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
18875 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
18876<- (gdb)
18877-> -exec-continue
18878<- ^running
18879<- (gdb)
18880<- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18881<- (gdb)
18882@end smallexample
18883
18884@subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
18885
18886Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
18887
18888@smallexample
18889-> (gdb)
18890<- -gdb-exit
18891<- ^exit
18892@end smallexample
18893
18894@subheading A Bad Command
18895
18896Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
18897
18898@smallexample
18899-> -rubbish
18900<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
18901<- (gdb)
18902@end smallexample
18903
18904
18905@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18906@node GDB/MI Command Description Format
18907@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
18908
18909The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
18910commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
18911
18912@subheading Motivation
18913
18914The motivation for this collection of commands.
18915
18916@subheading Introduction
18917
18918A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
18919
18920@subheading Commands
18921
18922For each command in the block, the following is described:
18923
18924@subsubheading Synopsis
18925
18926@smallexample
18927 -command @var{args}@dots{}
18928@end smallexample
18929
18930@subsubheading Result
18931
18932@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18933
18934The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
18935
18936@subsubheading Example
18937
18938Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
18939not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18940
18941
18942@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18943@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18944@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18945
18946@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18947@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18948This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18949breakpoints.
18950
18951@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18952@findex -break-after
18953
18954@subsubheading Synopsis
18955
18956@smallexample
18957 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18958@end smallexample
18959
18960The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18961hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18962the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18963@samp{-break-list} command below.
18964
18965@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18966
18967The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18968
18969@subsubheading Example
18970
18971@smallexample
18972(gdb)
18973-break-insert main
18974^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18975enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
18976fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18977(gdb)
18978-break-after 1 3
18979~
18980^done
18981(gdb)
18982-break-list
18983^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18984hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18985@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18986@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18987@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18988@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18989@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18990body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18991addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18992line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18993(gdb)
18994@end smallexample
18995
18996@ignore
18997@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18998@findex -break-catch
18999
19000@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
19001@findex -break-commands
19002@end ignore
19003
19004
19005@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
19006@findex -break-condition
19007
19008@subsubheading Synopsis
19009
19010@smallexample
19011 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
19012@end smallexample
19013
19014Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
19015@var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
19016@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
19017command below).
19018
19019@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19020
19021The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
19022
19023@subsubheading Example
19024
19025@smallexample
19026(gdb)
19027-break-condition 1 1
19028^done
19029(gdb)
19030-break-list
19031^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19032hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19033@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19034@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19035@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19036@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19037@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19038body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19039addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19040line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
19041(gdb)
19042@end smallexample
19043
19044@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
19045@findex -break-delete
19046
19047@subsubheading Synopsis
19048
19049@smallexample
19050 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19051@end smallexample
19052
19053Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
19054list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
19055
19056@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19057
19058The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
19059
19060@subsubheading Example
19061
19062@smallexample
19063(gdb)
19064-break-delete 1
19065^done
19066(gdb)
19067-break-list
19068^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
19069hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19070@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19071@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19072@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19073@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19074@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19075body=[]@}
19076(gdb)
19077@end smallexample
19078
19079@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
19080@findex -break-disable
19081
19082@subsubheading Synopsis
19083
19084@smallexample
19085 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19086@end smallexample
19087
19088Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
19089break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
19090
19091@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19092
19093The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
19094
19095@subsubheading Example
19096
19097@smallexample
19098(gdb)
19099-break-disable 2
19100^done
19101(gdb)
19102-break-list
19103^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19104hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19105@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19106@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19107@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19108@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19109@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19110body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
19111addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19112line="5",times="0"@}]@}
19113(gdb)
19114@end smallexample
19115
19116@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
19117@findex -break-enable
19118
19119@subsubheading Synopsis
19120
19121@smallexample
19122 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19123@end smallexample
19124
19125Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
19126
19127@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19128
19129The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
19130
19131@subsubheading Example
19132
19133@smallexample
19134(gdb)
19135-break-enable 2
19136^done
19137(gdb)
19138-break-list
19139^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19140hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19141@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19142@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19143@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19144@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19145@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19146body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19147addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19148line="5",times="0"@}]@}
19149(gdb)
19150@end smallexample
19151
19152@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
19153@findex -break-info
19154
19155@subsubheading Synopsis
19156
19157@smallexample
19158 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
19159@end smallexample
19160
19161@c REDUNDANT???
19162Get information about a single breakpoint.
19163
19164@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19165
19166The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
19167
19168@subsubheading Example
19169N.A.
19170
19171@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
19172@findex -break-insert
19173
19174@subsubheading Synopsis
19175
19176@smallexample
19177 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
19178 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
19179 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
19180@end smallexample
19181
19182@noindent
19183If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
19184
19185@itemize @bullet
19186@item function
19187@c @item +offset
19188@c @item -offset
19189@c @item linenum
19190@item filename:linenum
19191@item filename:function
19192@item *address
19193@end itemize
19194
19195The possible optional parameters of this command are:
19196
19197@table @samp
19198@item -t
19199Insert a temporary breakpoint.
19200@item -h
19201Insert a hardware breakpoint.
19202@item -c @var{condition}
19203Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
19204@item -i @var{ignore-count}
19205Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
19206@item -f
19207If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
19208refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
19209breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
19210an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
19211cannot be parsed.
19212@end table
19213
19214@subsubheading Result
19215
19216The result is in the form:
19217
19218@smallexample
19219^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
19220enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
19221fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
19222times="@var{times}"@}
19223@end smallexample
19224
19225@noindent
19226where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
19227@var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
19228inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
19229this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
19230and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
19231(always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
19232which use the same output).
19233
19234Note: this format is open to change.
19235@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
19236
19237@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19238
19239The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
19240@samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
19241
19242@subsubheading Example
19243
19244@smallexample
19245(gdb)
19246-break-insert main
19247^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
19248fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
19249(gdb)
19250-break-insert -t foo
19251^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
19252fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
19253(gdb)
19254-break-list
19255^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19256hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19257@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19258@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19259@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19260@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19261@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19262body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19263addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
19264fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
19265bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
19266addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
19267fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
19268(gdb)
19269-break-insert -r foo.*
19270~int foo(int, int);
19271^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
19272"fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
19273(gdb)
19274@end smallexample
19275
19276@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
19277@findex -break-list
19278
19279@subsubheading Synopsis
19280
19281@smallexample
19282 -break-list
19283@end smallexample
19284
19285Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
19286
19287@table @samp
19288@item Number
19289number of the breakpoint
19290@item Type
19291type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
19292@item Disposition
19293should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
19294or @samp{nokeep}
19295@item Enabled
19296is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
19297@item Address
19298memory location at which the breakpoint is set
19299@item What
19300logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
19301name, line number
19302@item Times
19303number of times the breakpoint has been hit
19304@end table
19305
19306If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
19307@code{body} field is an empty list.
19308
19309@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19310
19311The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
19312
19313@subsubheading Example
19314
19315@smallexample
19316(gdb)
19317-break-list
19318^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19319hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19320@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19321@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19322@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19323@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19324@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19325body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19326addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
19327bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19328addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19329line="13",times="0"@}]@}
19330(gdb)
19331@end smallexample
19332
19333Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
19334
19335@smallexample
19336(gdb)
19337-break-list
19338^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
19339hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19340@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19341@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19342@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19343@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19344@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19345body=[]@}
19346(gdb)
19347@end smallexample
19348
19349@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
19350@findex -break-watch
19351
19352@subsubheading Synopsis
19353
19354@smallexample
19355 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
19356@end smallexample
19357
19358Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
19359@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
19360read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
19361option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
19362trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
19363either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
19364i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
19365@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
19366
19367Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
19368breakpoints inserted.
19369
19370@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19371
19372The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
19373@samp{rwatch}.
19374
19375@subsubheading Example
19376
19377Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
19378
19379@smallexample
19380(gdb)
19381-break-watch x
19382^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
19383(gdb)
19384-exec-continue
19385^running
19386(gdb)
19387*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
19388value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
19389frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19390fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
19391(gdb)
19392@end smallexample
19393
19394Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
19395the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
19396for the watchpoint going out of scope.
19397
19398@smallexample
19399(gdb)
19400-break-watch C
19401^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
19402(gdb)
19403-exec-continue
19404^running
19405(gdb)
19406*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
19407wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
19408frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19409file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19410fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
19411(gdb)
19412-exec-continue
19413^running
19414(gdb)
19415*stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
19416frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
19417value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19418file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19419fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19420(gdb)
19421@end smallexample
19422
19423Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
19424execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
19425deleted.
19426
19427@smallexample
19428(gdb)
19429-break-watch C
19430^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
19431(gdb)
19432-break-list
19433^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19434hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19435@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19436@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19437@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19438@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19439@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19440body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19441addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19442file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19443fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
19444bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
19445enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
19446(gdb)
19447-exec-continue
19448^running
19449(gdb)
19450*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
19451value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
19452frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19453file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19454fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
19455(gdb)
19456-break-list
19457^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19458hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19459@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19460@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19461@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19462@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19463@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19464body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19465addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19466file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19467fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
19468bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
19469enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
19470(gdb)
19471-exec-continue
19472^running
19473^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
19474frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
19475value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19476file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19477fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19478(gdb)
19479-break-list
19480^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19481hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19482@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19483@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19484@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19485@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19486@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19487body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19488addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19489file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19490fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
19491times="1"@}]@}
19492(gdb)
19493@end smallexample
19494
19495@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19496@node GDB/MI Program Context
19497@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
19498
19499@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
19500@findex -exec-arguments
19501
19502
19503@subsubheading Synopsis
19504
19505@smallexample
19506 -exec-arguments @var{args}
19507@end smallexample
19508
19509Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
19510@samp{-exec-run}.
19511
19512@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19513
19514The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
19515
19516@subsubheading Example
19517
19518@smallexample
19519(gdb)
19520-exec-arguments -v word
19521^done
19522(gdb)
19523@end smallexample
19524
19525
19526@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
19527@findex -exec-show-arguments
19528
19529@subsubheading Synopsis
19530
19531@smallexample
19532 -exec-show-arguments
19533@end smallexample
19534
19535Print the arguments of the program.
19536
19537@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19538
19539The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
19540
19541@subsubheading Example
19542N.A.
19543
19544
19545@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
19546@findex -environment-cd
19547
19548@subsubheading Synopsis
19549
19550@smallexample
19551 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
19552@end smallexample
19553
19554Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
19555
19556@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19557
19558The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
19559
19560@subsubheading Example
19561
19562@smallexample
19563(gdb)
19564-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
19565^done
19566(gdb)
19567@end smallexample
19568
19569
19570@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
19571@findex -environment-directory
19572
19573@subsubheading Synopsis
19574
19575@smallexample
19576 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
19577@end smallexample
19578
19579Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
19580If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
19581search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
19582@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
19583occurs as normal.
19584Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
19585multiple directories in a single command
19586results in the directories added to the beginning of the
19587search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
19588If blanks are needed as
19589part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
19590the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
19591by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
19592character must not be used
19593in any directory name.
19594If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
19595
19596@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19597
19598The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
19599
19600@subsubheading Example
19601
19602@smallexample
19603(gdb)
19604-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
19605^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
19606(gdb)
19607-environment-directory ""
19608^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
19609(gdb)
19610-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
19611^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
19612(gdb)
19613-environment-directory -r
19614^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
19615(gdb)
19616@end smallexample
19617
19618
19619@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
19620@findex -environment-path
19621
19622@subsubheading Synopsis
19623
19624@smallexample
19625 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
19626@end smallexample
19627
19628Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
19629If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
19630search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
19631supplied in addition to the
19632@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
19633occurs as normal.
19634Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
19635multiple directories in a single command
19636results in the directories added to the beginning of the
19637search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
19638If blanks are needed as
19639part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
19640the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
19641by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
19642character must not be used
19643in any directory name.
19644If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
19645
19646
19647@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19648
19649The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
19650
19651@subsubheading Example
19652
19653@smallexample
19654(gdb)
19655-environment-path
19656^done,path="/usr/bin"
19657(gdb)
19658-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
19659^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
19660(gdb)
19661-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
19662^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
19663(gdb)
19664@end smallexample
19665
19666
19667@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
19668@findex -environment-pwd
19669
19670@subsubheading Synopsis
19671
19672@smallexample
19673 -environment-pwd
19674@end smallexample
19675
19676Show the current working directory.
19677
19678@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19679
19680The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
19681
19682@subsubheading Example
19683
19684@smallexample
19685(gdb)
19686-environment-pwd
19687^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
19688(gdb)
19689@end smallexample
19690
19691@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19692@node GDB/MI Thread Commands
19693@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
19694
19695
19696@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
19697@findex -thread-info
19698
19699@subsubheading Synopsis
19700
19701@smallexample
19702 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
19703@end smallexample
19704
19705Reports information about either a specific thread, if
19706the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
19707threads. When printing information about all threads,
19708also reports the current thread.
19709
19710@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19711
19712The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
19713about all threads.
19714
19715@subsubheading Example
19716
19717@smallexample
19718-thread-info
19719^done,threads=[
19720@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
19721 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},
19722@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
19723 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
19724 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@}@}],
19725current-thread-id="1"
19726(gdb)
19727@end smallexample
19728
19729@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
19730@findex -thread-list-ids
19731
19732@subsubheading Synopsis
19733
19734@smallexample
19735 -thread-list-ids
19736@end smallexample
19737
19738Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
19739end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
19740
19741@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19742
19743Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
19744
19745@subsubheading Example
19746
19747No threads present, besides the main process:
19748
19749@smallexample
19750(gdb)
19751-thread-list-ids
19752^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
19753(gdb)
19754@end smallexample
19755
19756
19757Several threads:
19758
19759@smallexample
19760(gdb)
19761-thread-list-ids
19762^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19763number-of-threads="3"
19764(gdb)
19765@end smallexample
19766
19767
19768@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
19769@findex -thread-select
19770
19771@subsubheading Synopsis
19772
19773@smallexample
19774 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
19775@end smallexample
19776
19777Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
19778current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
19779
19780@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19781
19782The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
19783
19784@subsubheading Example
19785
19786@smallexample
19787(gdb)
19788-exec-next
19789^running
19790(gdb)
19791*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
19792file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
19793(gdb)
19794-thread-list-ids
19795^done,
19796thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19797number-of-threads="3"
19798(gdb)
19799-thread-select 3
19800^done,new-thread-id="3",
19801frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
19802args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
19803@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
19804(gdb)
19805@end smallexample
19806
19807@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19808@node GDB/MI Program Execution
19809@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
19810
19811These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
19812record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
19813asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
19814other cases.
19815
19816@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
19817@findex -exec-continue
19818
19819@subsubheading Synopsis
19820
19821@smallexample
19822 -exec-continue
19823@end smallexample
19824
19825Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
19826encountered, or until the inferior exits.
19827
19828@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19829
19830The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
19831
19832@subsubheading Example
19833
19834@smallexample
19835-exec-continue
19836^running
19837(gdb)
19838@@Hello world
19839*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
19840func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
19841line="13"@}
19842(gdb)
19843@end smallexample
19844
19845
19846@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
19847@findex -exec-finish
19848
19849@subsubheading Synopsis
19850
19851@smallexample
19852 -exec-finish
19853@end smallexample
19854
19855Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
19856function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
19857
19858@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19859
19860The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
19861
19862@subsubheading Example
19863
19864Function returning @code{void}.
19865
19866@smallexample
19867-exec-finish
19868^running
19869(gdb)
19870@@hello from foo
19871*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19872file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
19873(gdb)
19874@end smallexample
19875
19876Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
19877@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
19878value itself.
19879
19880@smallexample
19881-exec-finish
19882^running
19883(gdb)
19884*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
19885args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
19886file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19887gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
19888(gdb)
19889@end smallexample
19890
19891
19892@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
19893@findex -exec-interrupt
19894
19895@subsubheading Synopsis
19896
19897@smallexample
19898 -exec-interrupt
19899@end smallexample
19900
19901Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
19902associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
19903that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
19904appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
19905interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
19906
19907@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19908
19909The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
19910
19911@subsubheading Example
19912
19913@smallexample
19914(gdb)
19915111-exec-continue
19916111^running
19917
19918(gdb)
19919222-exec-interrupt
19920222^done
19921(gdb)
19922111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
19923frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19924fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
19925(gdb)
19926
19927(gdb)
19928-exec-interrupt
19929^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
19930(gdb)
19931@end smallexample
19932
19933
19934@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
19935@findex -exec-next
19936
19937@subsubheading Synopsis
19938
19939@smallexample
19940 -exec-next
19941@end smallexample
19942
19943Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19944of the next source line is reached.
19945
19946@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19947
19948The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19949
19950@subsubheading Example
19951
19952@smallexample
19953-exec-next
19954^running
19955(gdb)
19956*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19957(gdb)
19958@end smallexample
19959
19960
19961@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19962@findex -exec-next-instruction
19963
19964@subsubheading Synopsis
19965
19966@smallexample
19967 -exec-next-instruction
19968@end smallexample
19969
19970Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19971call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19972instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19973printed as well.
19974
19975@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19976
19977The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19978
19979@subsubheading Example
19980
19981@smallexample
19982(gdb)
19983-exec-next-instruction
19984^running
19985
19986(gdb)
19987*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19988addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19989(gdb)
19990@end smallexample
19991
19992
19993@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19994@findex -exec-return
19995
19996@subsubheading Synopsis
19997
19998@smallexample
19999 -exec-return
20000@end smallexample
20001
20002Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
20003Displays the new current frame.
20004
20005@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20006
20007The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
20008
20009@subsubheading Example
20010
20011@smallexample
20012(gdb)
20013200-break-insert callee4
20014200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
20015file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
20016(gdb)
20017000-exec-run
20018000^running
20019(gdb)
20020000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
20021frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20022file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20023fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
20024(gdb)
20025205-break-delete
20026205^done
20027(gdb)
20028111-exec-return
20029111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
20030args=[@{name="strarg",
20031value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20032file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20033fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20034(gdb)
20035@end smallexample
20036
20037
20038@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
20039@findex -exec-run
20040
20041@subsubheading Synopsis
20042
20043@smallexample
20044 -exec-run
20045@end smallexample
20046
20047Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
20048executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
20049exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
20050the program has exited exceptionally.
20051
20052@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20053
20054The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
20055
20056@subsubheading Examples
20057
20058@smallexample
20059(gdb)
20060-break-insert main
20061^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
20062(gdb)
20063-exec-run
20064^running
20065(gdb)
20066*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
20067frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
20068fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
20069(gdb)
20070@end smallexample
20071
20072@noindent
20073Program exited normally:
20074
20075@smallexample
20076(gdb)
20077-exec-run
20078^running
20079(gdb)
20080x = 55
20081*stopped,reason="exited-normally"
20082(gdb)
20083@end smallexample
20084
20085@noindent
20086Program exited exceptionally:
20087
20088@smallexample
20089(gdb)
20090-exec-run
20091^running
20092(gdb)
20093x = 55
20094*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
20095(gdb)
20096@end smallexample
20097
20098Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
20099@code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
20100
20101@smallexample
20102(gdb)
20103*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
20104signal-meaning="Interrupt"
20105@end smallexample
20106
20107
20108@c @subheading -exec-signal
20109
20110
20111@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
20112@findex -exec-step
20113
20114@subsubheading Synopsis
20115
20116@smallexample
20117 -exec-step
20118@end smallexample
20119
20120Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
20121of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
20122function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
20123function.
20124
20125@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20126
20127The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
20128
20129@subsubheading Example
20130
20131Stepping into a function:
20132
20133@smallexample
20134-exec-step
20135^running
20136(gdb)
20137*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20138frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
20139@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
20140fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
20141(gdb)
20142@end smallexample
20143
20144Regular stepping:
20145
20146@smallexample
20147-exec-step
20148^running
20149(gdb)
20150*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
20151(gdb)
20152@end smallexample
20153
20154
20155@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
20156@findex -exec-step-instruction
20157
20158@subsubheading Synopsis
20159
20160@smallexample
20161 -exec-step-instruction
20162@end smallexample
20163
20164Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
20165output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
20166we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
20167case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
20168well.
20169
20170@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20171
20172The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
20173
20174@subsubheading Example
20175
20176@smallexample
20177(gdb)
20178-exec-step-instruction
20179^running
20180
20181(gdb)
20182*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20183frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20184fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
20185(gdb)
20186-exec-step-instruction
20187^running
20188
20189(gdb)
20190*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20191frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20192fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
20193(gdb)
20194@end smallexample
20195
20196
20197@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
20198@findex -exec-until
20199
20200@subsubheading Synopsis
20201
20202@smallexample
20203 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
20204@end smallexample
20205
20206Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
20207argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
20208until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
20209reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
20210
20211@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20212
20213The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
20214
20215@subsubheading Example
20216
20217@smallexample
20218(gdb)
20219-exec-until recursive2.c:6
20220^running
20221(gdb)
20222x = 55
20223*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
20224file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
20225(gdb)
20226@end smallexample
20227
20228@ignore
20229@subheading -file-clear
20230Is this going away????
20231@end ignore
20232
20233@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20234@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
20235@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
20236
20237
20238@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
20239@findex -stack-info-frame
20240
20241@subsubheading Synopsis
20242
20243@smallexample
20244 -stack-info-frame
20245@end smallexample
20246
20247Get info on the selected frame.
20248
20249@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20250
20251The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
20252(without arguments).
20253
20254@subsubheading Example
20255
20256@smallexample
20257(gdb)
20258-stack-info-frame
20259^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
20260file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20261fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
20262(gdb)
20263@end smallexample
20264
20265@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
20266@findex -stack-info-depth
20267
20268@subsubheading Synopsis
20269
20270@smallexample
20271 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
20272@end smallexample
20273
20274Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
20275is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
20276
20277@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20278
20279There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
20280
20281@subsubheading Example
20282
20283For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
20284
20285@smallexample
20286(gdb)
20287-stack-info-depth
20288^done,depth="12"
20289(gdb)
20290-stack-info-depth 4
20291^done,depth="4"
20292(gdb)
20293-stack-info-depth 12
20294^done,depth="12"
20295(gdb)
20296-stack-info-depth 11
20297^done,depth="11"
20298(gdb)
20299-stack-info-depth 13
20300^done,depth="12"
20301(gdb)
20302@end smallexample
20303
20304@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
20305@findex -stack-list-arguments
20306
20307@subsubheading Synopsis
20308
20309@smallexample
20310 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
20311 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
20312@end smallexample
20313
20314Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
20315and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
20316@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
20317call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
20318at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
20319larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
20320@var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
20321which case only existing frames will be returned.
20322
20323The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
203240 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
20325means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
20326
20327@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20328
20329@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
20330@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
20331functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
20332
20333@subsubheading Example
20334
20335@smallexample
20336(gdb)
20337-stack-list-frames
20338^done,
20339stack=[
20340frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20341file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20342fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
20343frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
20344file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20345fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
20346frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
20347file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20348fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
20349frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
20350file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20351fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
20352frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
20353file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20354fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
20355(gdb)
20356-stack-list-arguments 0
20357^done,
20358stack-args=[
20359frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
20360frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
20361frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
20362frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
20363frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
20364(gdb)
20365-stack-list-arguments 1
20366^done,
20367stack-args=[
20368frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
20369frame=@{level="1",
20370 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
20371frame=@{level="2",args=[
20372@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
20373@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
20374@{frame=@{level="3",args=[
20375@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
20376@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
20377@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
20378frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
20379(gdb)
20380-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
20381^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
20382(gdb)
20383-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
20384^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
20385args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
20386@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
20387(gdb)
20388@end smallexample
20389
20390@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
20391
20392
20393@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
20394@findex -stack-list-frames
20395
20396@subsubheading Synopsis
20397
20398@smallexample
20399 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
20400@end smallexample
20401
20402List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
20403following info:
20404
20405@table @samp
20406@item @var{level}
20407The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
20408@item @var{addr}
20409The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
20410@item @var{func}
20411Function name.
20412@item @var{file}
20413File name of the source file where the function lives.
20414@item @var{line}
20415Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
20416@end table
20417
20418If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
20419whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
20420levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
20421are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
20422an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
20423frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
20424actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
20425
20426@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20427
20428The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
20429
20430@subsubheading Example
20431
20432Full stack backtrace:
20433
20434@smallexample
20435(gdb)
20436-stack-list-frames
20437^done,stack=
20438[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
20439 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
20440frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20441 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20442frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20443 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20444frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20445 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20446frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20447 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20448frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20449 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20450frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20451 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20452frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20453 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20454frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20455 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20456frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20457 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20458frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20459 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20460frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
20461 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
20462(gdb)
20463@end smallexample
20464
20465Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
20466
20467@smallexample
20468(gdb)
20469-stack-list-frames 3 5
20470^done,stack=
20471[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20472 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20473frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20474 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20475frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20476 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
20477(gdb)
20478@end smallexample
20479
20480Show a single frame:
20481
20482@smallexample
20483(gdb)
20484-stack-list-frames 3 3
20485^done,stack=
20486[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20487 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
20488(gdb)
20489@end smallexample
20490
20491
20492@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
20493@findex -stack-list-locals
20494
20495@subsubheading Synopsis
20496
20497@smallexample
20498 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
20499@end smallexample
20500
20501Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
20502@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
20503the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
20504values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
20505type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
20506structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
20507display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
20508other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
20509more detail.
20510
20511@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20512
20513@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
20514
20515@subsubheading Example
20516
20517@smallexample
20518(gdb)
20519-stack-list-locals 0
20520^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
20521(gdb)
20522-stack-list-locals --all-values
20523^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
20524 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
20525-stack-list-locals --simple-values
20526^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
20527 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
20528(gdb)
20529@end smallexample
20530
20531
20532@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
20533@findex -stack-select-frame
20534
20535@subsubheading Synopsis
20536
20537@smallexample
20538 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
20539@end smallexample
20540
20541Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
20542the stack.
20543
20544@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20545
20546The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
20547@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
20548
20549@subsubheading Example
20550
20551@smallexample
20552(gdb)
20553-stack-select-frame 2
20554^done
20555(gdb)
20556@end smallexample
20557
20558@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20559@node GDB/MI Variable Objects
20560@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
20561
20562@ignore
20563
20564@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20565
20566For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
20567expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
20568used by @code{Insight}.
20569
20570The two main reasons for that are:
20571
20572@enumerate 1
20573@item
20574It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
20575
20576@item
20577It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
20578now).
20579@end enumerate
20580
20581The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
20582slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
20583describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
20584hints about their use.
20585
20586@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
20587expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
20588least, the following operations:
20589
20590@itemize @bullet
20591@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
20592@item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
20593@item @code{-stack-list-locals}
20594@item @code{-stack-select-frame}
20595@end itemize
20596
20597@end ignore
20598
20599@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
20600
20601@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20602
20603Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
20604changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
20605work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
20606simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
20607is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
20608frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
20609expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
20610expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
20611variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
20612operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
20613object, or to change display format.
20614
20615Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
20616that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
20617a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
20618element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
20619children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
20620leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
20621objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
20622is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
20623child will be created.
20624
20625For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
20626string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
20627obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
20628that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
20629contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
20630
20631A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
20632the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
20633variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
20634operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
20635be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
20636objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
20637real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
20638variables that frontend has created.
20639
20640The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
20641might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
20642and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
20643relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
20644to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
20645visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
20646called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
20647implicitly updated.
20648
20649The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
20650access this functionality:
20651
20652@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
20653@item @strong{Operation}
20654@tab @strong{Description}
20655
20656@item @code{-var-create}
20657@tab create a variable object
20658@item @code{-var-delete}
20659@tab delete the variable object and/or its children
20660@item @code{-var-set-format}
20661@tab set the display format of this variable
20662@item @code{-var-show-format}
20663@tab show the display format of this variable
20664@item @code{-var-info-num-children}
20665@tab tells how many children this object has
20666@item @code{-var-list-children}
20667@tab return a list of the object's children
20668@item @code{-var-info-type}
20669@tab show the type of this variable object
20670@item @code{-var-info-expression}
20671@tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
20672@item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
20673@tab print full expression that this variable object represents
20674@item @code{-var-show-attributes}
20675@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
20676@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
20677@tab get the value of this variable
20678@item @code{-var-assign}
20679@tab set the value of this variable
20680@item @code{-var-update}
20681@tab update the variable and its children
20682@item @code{-var-set-frozen}
20683@tab set frozeness attribute
20684@end multitable
20685
20686In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
20687how it can be used.
20688
20689@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
20690
20691@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
20692@findex -var-create
20693
20694@subsubheading Synopsis
20695
20696@smallexample
20697 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
20698 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
20699@end smallexample
20700
20701This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
20702a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
20703register.
20704
20705The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
20706referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
20707system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
20708unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
20709The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
20710
20711The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
20712specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
20713frame should be used.
20714
20715@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
20716begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
20717
20718@itemize @bullet
20719@item
20720@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
20721
20722@item
20723@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
20724
20725@item
20726@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
20727@end itemize
20728
20729@subsubheading Result
20730
20731This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
20732object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
20733the @value{GDBN} CLI:
20734
20735@smallexample
20736 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
20737@end smallexample
20738
20739
20740@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
20741@findex -var-delete
20742
20743@subsubheading Synopsis
20744
20745@smallexample
20746 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
20747@end smallexample
20748
20749Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
20750With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
20751
20752Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
20753
20754
20755@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
20756@findex -var-set-format
20757
20758@subsubheading Synopsis
20759
20760@smallexample
20761 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
20762@end smallexample
20763
20764Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
20765@var{format-spec}.
20766
20767@anchor{-var-set-format}
20768The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
20769
20770@smallexample
20771 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
20772 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
20773@end smallexample
20774
20775The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
20776based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
20777for pointers, etc.).
20778
20779For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
20780variable itself, and the children are not affected.
20781
20782@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
20783@findex -var-show-format
20784
20785@subsubheading Synopsis
20786
20787@smallexample
20788 -var-show-format @var{name}
20789@end smallexample
20790
20791Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
20792
20793@smallexample
20794 @var{format} @expansion{}
20795 @var{format-spec}
20796@end smallexample
20797
20798
20799@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
20800@findex -var-info-num-children
20801
20802@subsubheading Synopsis
20803
20804@smallexample
20805 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
20806@end smallexample
20807
20808Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
20809
20810@smallexample
20811 numchild=@var{n}
20812@end smallexample
20813
20814
20815@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
20816@findex -var-list-children
20817
20818@subsubheading Synopsis
20819
20820@smallexample
20821 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
20822@end smallexample
20823@anchor{-var-list-children}
20824
20825Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
20826create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
20827a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
20828@code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20829@var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20830values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20831value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20832and unions.
20833
20834@subsubheading Example
20835
20836@smallexample
20837(gdb)
20838 -var-list-children n
20839 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20840 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20841(gdb)
20842 -var-list-children --all-values n
20843 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20844 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20845@end smallexample
20846
20847
20848@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20849@findex -var-info-type
20850
20851@subsubheading Synopsis
20852
20853@smallexample
20854 -var-info-type @var{name}
20855@end smallexample
20856
20857Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20858returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20859@value{GDBN} CLI:
20860
20861@smallexample
20862 type=@var{typename}
20863@end smallexample
20864
20865
20866@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
20867@findex -var-info-expression
20868
20869@subsubheading Synopsis
20870
20871@smallexample
20872 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20873@end smallexample
20874
20875Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
20876variable object in user interface. The string is generally
20877not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
20878
20879For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
20880@code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
20881
20882@smallexample
20883(gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
20884^done,lang="C",exp="1"
20885@end smallexample
20886
20887@noindent
20888Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
20889
20890Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
20891includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
20892is of limited use.
20893
20894@subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
20895@findex -var-info-path-expression
20896
20897@subsubheading Synopsis
20898
20899@smallexample
20900 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
20901@end smallexample
20902
20903Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
20904context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
20905Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
20906result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
20907the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
20908watchpoint from a variable object.
20909
20910For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
20911@code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
20912@code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
20913@code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
20914@code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
20915@smallexample
20916(gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
20917^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
20918@end smallexample
20919
20920@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
20921@findex -var-show-attributes
20922
20923@subsubheading Synopsis
20924
20925@smallexample
20926 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
20927@end smallexample
20928
20929List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
20930
20931@smallexample
20932 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
20933@end smallexample
20934
20935@noindent
20936where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
20937
20938@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
20939@findex -var-evaluate-expression
20940
20941@subsubheading Synopsis
20942
20943@smallexample
20944 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
20945@end smallexample
20946
20947Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20948object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
20949can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
20950this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
20951(@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
20952the current display format will be used. The current display format
20953can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
20954
20955@smallexample
20956 value=@var{value}
20957@end smallexample
20958
20959Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20960before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20961
20962@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20963@findex -var-assign
20964
20965@subsubheading Synopsis
20966
20967@smallexample
20968 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20969@end smallexample
20970
20971Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20972by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20973value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20974subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20975
20976@subsubheading Example
20977
20978@smallexample
20979(gdb)
20980-var-assign var1 3
20981^done,value="3"
20982(gdb)
20983-var-update *
20984^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20985(gdb)
20986@end smallexample
20987
20988@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20989@findex -var-update
20990
20991@subsubheading Synopsis
20992
20993@smallexample
20994 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20995@end smallexample
20996
20997Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20998@var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20999list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
21000be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
21001@code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
21002@code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
21003object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
21004for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
21005@var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
21006names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
21007as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
21008recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
21009number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
21010
21011
21012@subsubheading Example
21013
21014@smallexample
21015(gdb)
21016-var-assign var1 3
21017^done,value="3"
21018(gdb)
21019-var-update --all-values var1
21020^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
21021type_changed="false"@}]
21022(gdb)
21023@end smallexample
21024
21025@anchor{-var-update}
21026The field in_scope may take three values:
21027
21028@table @code
21029@item "true"
21030The variable object's current value is valid.
21031
21032@item "false"
21033The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
21034hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
21035scope.
21036
21037@item "invalid"
21038The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
21039This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
21040either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
21041command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
21042objects.
21043@end table
21044
21045In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
21046be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
21047
21048@subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
21049@findex -var-set-frozen
21050@anchor{-var-set-frozen}
21051
21052@subsubheading Synopsis
21053
21054@smallexample
21055 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
21056@end smallexample
21057
21058Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
21059@var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
21060frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
21061frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
21062implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
21063a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
21064@code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
21065values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
21066implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
21067Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
21068@code{-var-update} does.
21069
21070@subsubheading Example
21071
21072@smallexample
21073(gdb)
21074-var-set-frozen V 1
21075^done
21076(gdb)
21077@end smallexample
21078
21079
21080@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21081@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
21082@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
21083
21084@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
21085@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
21086This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
21087examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
21088
21089@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
21090@c @subheading -data-assign
21091@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
21092@c @subsubheading GDB Command
21093@c set variable
21094@c @subsubheading Example
21095@c N.A.
21096
21097@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
21098@findex -data-disassemble
21099
21100@subsubheading Synopsis
21101
21102@smallexample
21103 -data-disassemble
21104 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
21105 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
21106 -- @var{mode}
21107@end smallexample
21108
21109@noindent
21110Where:
21111
21112@table @samp
21113@item @var{start-addr}
21114is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
21115@item @var{end-addr}
21116is the end address
21117@item @var{filename}
21118is the name of the file to disassemble
21119@item @var{linenum}
21120is the line number to disassemble around
21121@item @var{lines}
21122is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
21123the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
21124specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
21125@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
21126@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
21127displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
21128@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
21129are displayed.
21130@item @var{mode}
21131is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
21132disassembly).
21133@end table
21134
21135@subsubheading Result
21136
21137The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
21138
21139@itemize @bullet
21140@item Address
21141@item Func-name
21142@item Offset
21143@item Instruction
21144@end itemize
21145
21146Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
21147directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
21148
21149@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21150
21151There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
21152
21153@subsubheading Example
21154
21155Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
21156
21157@smallexample
21158(gdb)
21159-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
21160^done,
21161asm_insns=[
21162@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21163inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21164@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21165inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21166@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
21167inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
21168@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
21169inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21170@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
21171inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
21172(gdb)
21173@end smallexample
21174
21175Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
21176@code{main}.
21177
21178@smallexample
21179-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
21180^done,asm_insns=[
21181@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
21182inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
21183@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21184inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21185@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21186inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21187[@dots{}]
21188@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
21189@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
21190(gdb)
21191@end smallexample
21192
21193Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
21194
21195@smallexample
21196(gdb)
21197-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
21198^done,asm_insns=[
21199@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
21200inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
21201@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21202inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21203@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21204inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
21205(gdb)
21206@end smallexample
21207
21208Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
21209
21210@smallexample
21211(gdb)
21212-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
21213^done,asm_insns=[
21214src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
21215file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
21216 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
21217@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
21218inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
21219src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
21220file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
21221 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
21222@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21223inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21224@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21225inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
21226(gdb)
21227@end smallexample
21228
21229
21230@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
21231@findex -data-evaluate-expression
21232
21233@subsubheading Synopsis
21234
21235@smallexample
21236 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
21237@end smallexample
21238
21239Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
21240inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
21241If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
21242
21243@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21244
21245The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
21246@samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
21247@samp{gdb_eval} command.
21248
21249@subsubheading Example
21250
21251In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
21252@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
21253Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
21254output.
21255
21256@smallexample
21257211-data-evaluate-expression A
21258211^done,value="1"
21259(gdb)
21260311-data-evaluate-expression &A
21261311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
21262(gdb)
21263411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
21264411^done,value="4"
21265(gdb)
21266511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
21267511^done,value="4"
21268(gdb)
21269@end smallexample
21270
21271
21272@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
21273@findex -data-list-changed-registers
21274
21275@subsubheading Synopsis
21276
21277@smallexample
21278 -data-list-changed-registers
21279@end smallexample
21280
21281Display a list of the registers that have changed.
21282
21283@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21284
21285@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
21286has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
21287
21288@subsubheading Example
21289
21290On a PPC MBX board:
21291
21292@smallexample
21293(gdb)
21294-exec-continue
21295^running
21296
21297(gdb)
21298*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
21299func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
21300line="5"@}
21301(gdb)
21302-data-list-changed-registers
21303^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
21304"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
21305"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
21306(gdb)
21307@end smallexample
21308
21309
21310@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
21311@findex -data-list-register-names
21312
21313@subsubheading Synopsis
21314
21315@smallexample
21316 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
21317@end smallexample
21318
21319Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
21320are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
21321integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
21322names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
21323consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
21324include empty register names.
21325
21326@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21327
21328@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
21329@samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
21330corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
21331
21332@subsubheading Example
21333
21334For the PPC MBX board:
21335@smallexample
21336(gdb)
21337-data-list-register-names
21338^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
21339"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
21340"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
21341"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
21342"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
21343"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
21344"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
21345(gdb)
21346-data-list-register-names 1 2 3
21347^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
21348(gdb)
21349@end smallexample
21350
21351@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
21352@findex -data-list-register-values
21353
21354@subsubheading Synopsis
21355
21356@smallexample
21357 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
21358@end smallexample
21359
21360Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
21361which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
21362list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
21363numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
21364
21365Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
21366
21367@table @code
21368@item x
21369Hexadecimal
21370@item o
21371Octal
21372@item t
21373Binary
21374@item d
21375Decimal
21376@item r
21377Raw
21378@item N
21379Natural
21380@end table
21381
21382@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21383
21384The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
21385all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
21386
21387@subsubheading Example
21388
21389For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
21390don't appear in the actual output):
21391
21392@smallexample
21393(gdb)
21394-data-list-register-values r 64 65
21395^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
21396@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
21397(gdb)
21398-data-list-register-values x
21399^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
21400@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
21401@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
21402@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
21403@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
21404@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
21405@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
21406@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
21407@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
21408@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
21409@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
21410@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
21411@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
21412@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
21413@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
21414@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
21415@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
21416@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
21417@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
21418@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
21419@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
21420@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
21421@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
21422@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
21423@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
21424@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
21425@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
21426@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
21427@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
21428@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
21429@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
21430@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
21431@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
21432@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
21433@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
21434@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
21435(gdb)
21436@end smallexample
21437
21438
21439@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
21440@findex -data-read-memory
21441
21442@subsubheading Synopsis
21443
21444@smallexample
21445 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
21446 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
21447 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
21448@end smallexample
21449
21450@noindent
21451where:
21452
21453@table @samp
21454@item @var{address}
21455An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
21456read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
21457quoted using the C convention.
21458
21459@item @var{word-format}
21460The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
21461same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
21462,Output Formats}).
21463
21464@item @var{word-size}
21465The size of each memory word in bytes.
21466
21467@item @var{nr-rows}
21468The number of rows in the output table.
21469
21470@item @var{nr-cols}
21471The number of columns in the output table.
21472
21473@item @var{aschar}
21474If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
21475value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
21476member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
21477characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
21478
21479@item @var{byte-offset}
21480An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
21481@end table
21482
21483This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
21484@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
21485@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
21486(returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
21487of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
21488using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
21489in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
21490@samp{addr}.
21491
21492The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
21493@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
21494@samp{prev-page}.
21495
21496@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21497
21498The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
21499@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
21500
21501@subsubheading Example
21502
21503Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
21504@code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
21505word. Display each word in hex.
21506
21507@smallexample
21508(gdb)
215099-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
215109^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
21511next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
21512prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
21513@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
21514@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
21515@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
21516(gdb)
21517@end smallexample
21518
21519Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
21520display as a single word formatted in decimal.
21521
21522@smallexample
21523(gdb)
215245-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
215255^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
21526next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
21527next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
21528@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
21529(gdb)
21530@end smallexample
21531
21532Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
21533as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
21534used as the non-printable character.
21535
21536@smallexample
21537(gdb)
215384-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
215394^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
21540next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
21541next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
21542@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21543@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21544@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21545@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21546@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
21547@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
21548@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
21549@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
21550(gdb)
21551@end smallexample
21552
21553@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21554@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
21555@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
21556
21557The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
21558
21559@c @subheading -trace-actions
21560
21561@c @subheading -trace-delete
21562
21563@c @subheading -trace-disable
21564
21565@c @subheading -trace-dump
21566
21567@c @subheading -trace-enable
21568
21569@c @subheading -trace-exists
21570
21571@c @subheading -trace-find
21572
21573@c @subheading -trace-frame-number
21574
21575@c @subheading -trace-info
21576
21577@c @subheading -trace-insert
21578
21579@c @subheading -trace-list
21580
21581@c @subheading -trace-pass-count
21582
21583@c @subheading -trace-save
21584
21585@c @subheading -trace-start
21586
21587@c @subheading -trace-stop
21588
21589
21590@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21591@node GDB/MI Symbol Query
21592@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
21593
21594
21595@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
21596@findex -symbol-info-address
21597
21598@subsubheading Synopsis
21599
21600@smallexample
21601 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
21602@end smallexample
21603
21604Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
21605
21606@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21607
21608The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
21609
21610@subsubheading Example
21611N.A.
21612
21613
21614@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
21615@findex -symbol-info-file
21616
21617@subsubheading Synopsis
21618
21619@smallexample
21620 -symbol-info-file
21621@end smallexample
21622
21623Show the file for the symbol.
21624
21625@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21626
21627There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
21628@samp{gdb_find_file}.
21629
21630@subsubheading Example
21631N.A.
21632
21633
21634@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
21635@findex -symbol-info-function
21636
21637@subsubheading Synopsis
21638
21639@smallexample
21640 -symbol-info-function
21641@end smallexample
21642
21643Show which function the symbol lives in.
21644
21645@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21646
21647@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
21648
21649@subsubheading Example
21650N.A.
21651
21652
21653@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
21654@findex -symbol-info-line
21655
21656@subsubheading Synopsis
21657
21658@smallexample
21659 -symbol-info-line
21660@end smallexample
21661
21662Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
21663
21664@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21665
21666The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
21667@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
21668
21669@subsubheading Example
21670N.A.
21671
21672
21673@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
21674@findex -symbol-info-symbol
21675
21676@subsubheading Synopsis
21677
21678@smallexample
21679 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
21680@end smallexample
21681
21682Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
21683
21684@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21685
21686The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
21687
21688@subsubheading Example
21689N.A.
21690
21691
21692@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
21693@findex -symbol-list-functions
21694
21695@subsubheading Synopsis
21696
21697@smallexample
21698 -symbol-list-functions
21699@end smallexample
21700
21701List the functions in the executable.
21702
21703@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21704
21705@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
21706@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21707
21708@subsubheading Example
21709N.A.
21710
21711
21712@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
21713@findex -symbol-list-lines
21714
21715@subsubheading Synopsis
21716
21717@smallexample
21718 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
21719@end smallexample
21720
21721Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
21722addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
21723ascending PC order.
21724
21725@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21726
21727There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
21728
21729@subsubheading Example
21730@smallexample
21731(gdb)
21732-symbol-list-lines basics.c
21733^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
21734(gdb)
21735@end smallexample
21736
21737
21738@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
21739@findex -symbol-list-types
21740
21741@subsubheading Synopsis
21742
21743@smallexample
21744 -symbol-list-types
21745@end smallexample
21746
21747List all the type names.
21748
21749@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21750
21751The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
21752@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21753
21754@subsubheading Example
21755N.A.
21756
21757
21758@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
21759@findex -symbol-list-variables
21760
21761@subsubheading Synopsis
21762
21763@smallexample
21764 -symbol-list-variables
21765@end smallexample
21766
21767List all the global and static variable names.
21768
21769@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21770
21771@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21772
21773@subsubheading Example
21774N.A.
21775
21776
21777@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
21778@findex -symbol-locate
21779
21780@subsubheading Synopsis
21781
21782@smallexample
21783 -symbol-locate
21784@end smallexample
21785
21786@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21787
21788@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
21789
21790@subsubheading Example
21791N.A.
21792
21793
21794@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
21795@findex -symbol-type
21796
21797@subsubheading Synopsis
21798
21799@smallexample
21800 -symbol-type @var{variable}
21801@end smallexample
21802
21803Show type of @var{variable}.
21804
21805@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21806
21807The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
21808@samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
21809
21810@subsubheading Example
21811N.A.
21812
21813
21814@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21815@node GDB/MI File Commands
21816@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
21817
21818This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
21819and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
21820
21821@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
21822@findex -file-exec-and-symbols
21823
21824@subsubheading Synopsis
21825
21826@smallexample
21827 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
21828@end smallexample
21829
21830Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
21831which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
21832command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
21833are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
21834error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
21835notification.
21836
21837@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21838
21839The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
21840
21841@subsubheading Example
21842
21843@smallexample
21844(gdb)
21845-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21846^done
21847(gdb)
21848@end smallexample
21849
21850
21851@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
21852@findex -file-exec-file
21853
21854@subsubheading Synopsis
21855
21856@smallexample
21857 -file-exec-file @var{file}
21858@end smallexample
21859
21860Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
21861@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
21862from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
21863about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
21864notification.
21865
21866@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21867
21868The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
21869
21870@subsubheading Example
21871
21872@smallexample
21873(gdb)
21874-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21875^done
21876(gdb)
21877@end smallexample
21878
21879
21880@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
21881@findex -file-list-exec-sections
21882
21883@subsubheading Synopsis
21884
21885@smallexample
21886 -file-list-exec-sections
21887@end smallexample
21888
21889List the sections of the current executable file.
21890
21891@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21892
21893The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
21894information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
21895@samp{gdb_load_info}.
21896
21897@subsubheading Example
21898N.A.
21899
21900
21901@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
21902@findex -file-list-exec-source-file
21903
21904@subsubheading Synopsis
21905
21906@smallexample
21907 -file-list-exec-source-file
21908@end smallexample
21909
21910List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
21911to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
21912information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
21913whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
21914
21915@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21916
21917The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
21918
21919@subsubheading Example
21920
21921@smallexample
21922(gdb)
21923123-file-list-exec-source-file
21924123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
21925(gdb)
21926@end smallexample
21927
21928
21929@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
21930@findex -file-list-exec-source-files
21931
21932@subsubheading Synopsis
21933
21934@smallexample
21935 -file-list-exec-source-files
21936@end smallexample
21937
21938List the source files for the current executable.
21939
21940It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
21941the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
21942
21943@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21944
21945The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
21946@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
21947
21948@subsubheading Example
21949@smallexample
21950(gdb)
21951-file-list-exec-source-files
21952^done,files=[
21953@{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
21954@{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
21955@{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
21956(gdb)
21957@end smallexample
21958
21959@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
21960@findex -file-list-shared-libraries
21961
21962@subsubheading Synopsis
21963
21964@smallexample
21965 -file-list-shared-libraries
21966@end smallexample
21967
21968List the shared libraries in the program.
21969
21970@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21971
21972The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
21973
21974@subsubheading Example
21975N.A.
21976
21977
21978@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
21979@findex -file-list-symbol-files
21980
21981@subsubheading Synopsis
21982
21983@smallexample
21984 -file-list-symbol-files
21985@end smallexample
21986
21987List symbol files.
21988
21989@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21990
21991The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
21992
21993@subsubheading Example
21994N.A.
21995
21996
21997@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21998@findex -file-symbol-file
21999
22000@subsubheading Synopsis
22001
22002@smallexample
22003 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
22004@end smallexample
22005
22006Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
22007used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
22008produced, except for a completion notification.
22009
22010@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22011
22012The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
22013
22014@subsubheading Example
22015
22016@smallexample
22017(gdb)
22018-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
22019^done
22020(gdb)
22021@end smallexample
22022
22023@ignore
22024@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22025@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
22026@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
22027
22028The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
22029
22030@c @subheading -overlay-auto
22031
22032@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
22033
22034@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
22035
22036@c @subheading -overlay-map
22037
22038@c @subheading -overlay-off
22039
22040@c @subheading -overlay-on
22041
22042@c @subheading -overlay-unmap
22043
22044@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22045@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
22046@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
22047
22048Signal handling commands are not implemented.
22049
22050@c @subheading -signal-handle
22051
22052@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
22053
22054@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
22055@end ignore
22056
22057
22058@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22059@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
22060@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
22061
22062
22063@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
22064@findex -target-attach
22065
22066@subsubheading Synopsis
22067
22068@smallexample
22069 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
22070@end smallexample
22071
22072Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
22073
22074@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22075
22076The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
22077
22078@subsubheading Example
22079@smallexample
22080(gdb)
22081-target-attach 34
22082=thread-created,id="1"
22083*stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
22084^done
22085(gdb)
22086@end smallexample
22087
22088@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
22089@findex -target-compare-sections
22090
22091@subsubheading Synopsis
22092
22093@smallexample
22094 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
22095@end smallexample
22096
22097Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
22098Without the argument, all sections are compared.
22099
22100@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22101
22102The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
22103
22104@subsubheading Example
22105N.A.
22106
22107
22108@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
22109@findex -target-detach
22110
22111@subsubheading Synopsis
22112
22113@smallexample
22114 -target-detach
22115@end smallexample
22116
22117Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
22118There's no output.
22119
22120@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22121
22122The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
22123
22124@subsubheading Example
22125
22126@smallexample
22127(gdb)
22128-target-detach
22129^done
22130(gdb)
22131@end smallexample
22132
22133
22134@subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
22135@findex -target-disconnect
22136
22137@subsubheading Synopsis
22138
22139@smallexample
22140 -target-disconnect
22141@end smallexample
22142
22143Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
22144generally not resumed.
22145
22146@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22147
22148The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
22149
22150@subsubheading Example
22151
22152@smallexample
22153(gdb)
22154-target-disconnect
22155^done
22156(gdb)
22157@end smallexample
22158
22159
22160@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
22161@findex -target-download
22162
22163@subsubheading Synopsis
22164
22165@smallexample
22166 -target-download
22167@end smallexample
22168
22169Loads the executable onto the remote target.
22170It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
22171
22172@table @samp
22173@item section
22174The name of the section.
22175@item section-sent
22176The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
22177@item section-size
22178The size of the section.
22179@item total-sent
22180The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
22181@item total-size
22182The size of the overall executable to download.
22183@end table
22184
22185@noindent
22186Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
22187@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
22188
22189In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
22190downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
22191
22192@table @samp
22193@item section
22194The name of the section.
22195@item section-size
22196The size of the section.
22197@item total-size
22198The size of the overall executable to download.
22199@end table
22200
22201@noindent
22202At the end, a summary is printed.
22203
22204@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22205
22206The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
22207
22208@subsubheading Example
22209
22210Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
22211have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
22212
22213@smallexample
22214(gdb)
22215-target-download
22216+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
22217+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
22218total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
22219+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
22220total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
22221+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
22222total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
22223+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
22224total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
22225+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
22226total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
22227+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
22228total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
22229+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
22230total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
22231+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
22232total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
22233+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
22234total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
22235+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
22236total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
22237+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
22238total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
22239+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
22240total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
22241+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
22242total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
22243+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
22244+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
22245+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
22246+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
22247total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
22248+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
22249total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
22250+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
22251total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
22252+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
22253total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
22254+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
22255total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
22256+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
22257total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
22258^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
22259write-rate="429"
22260(gdb)
22261@end smallexample
22262
22263
22264@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
22265@findex -target-exec-status
22266
22267@subsubheading Synopsis
22268
22269@smallexample
22270 -target-exec-status
22271@end smallexample
22272
22273Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
22274not, for instance).
22275
22276@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22277
22278There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
22279
22280@subsubheading Example
22281N.A.
22282
22283
22284@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
22285@findex -target-list-available-targets
22286
22287@subsubheading Synopsis
22288
22289@smallexample
22290 -target-list-available-targets
22291@end smallexample
22292
22293List the possible targets to connect to.
22294
22295@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22296
22297The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
22298
22299@subsubheading Example
22300N.A.
22301
22302
22303@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
22304@findex -target-list-current-targets
22305
22306@subsubheading Synopsis
22307
22308@smallexample
22309 -target-list-current-targets
22310@end smallexample
22311
22312Describe the current target.
22313
22314@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22315
22316The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
22317other things).
22318
22319@subsubheading Example
22320N.A.
22321
22322
22323@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
22324@findex -target-list-parameters
22325
22326@subsubheading Synopsis
22327
22328@smallexample
22329 -target-list-parameters
22330@end smallexample
22331
22332@c ????
22333
22334@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22335
22336No equivalent.
22337
22338@subsubheading Example
22339N.A.
22340
22341
22342@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
22343@findex -target-select
22344
22345@subsubheading Synopsis
22346
22347@smallexample
22348 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
22349@end smallexample
22350
22351Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
22352
22353@table @samp
22354@item @var{type}
22355The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
22356@item @var{parameters}
22357Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
22358Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
22359@end table
22360
22361The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
22362which the target program is, in the following form:
22363
22364@smallexample
22365^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
22366 args=[@var{arg list}]
22367@end smallexample
22368
22369@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22370
22371The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
22372
22373@subsubheading Example
22374
22375@smallexample
22376(gdb)
22377-target-select remote /dev/ttya
22378^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
22379(gdb)
22380@end smallexample
22381
22382@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22383@node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
22384@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
22385
22386
22387@subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
22388@findex -target-file-put
22389
22390@subsubheading Synopsis
22391
22392@smallexample
22393 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
22394@end smallexample
22395
22396Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
22397@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
22398
22399@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22400
22401The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
22402
22403@subsubheading Example
22404
22405@smallexample
22406(gdb)
22407-target-file-put localfile remotefile
22408^done
22409(gdb)
22410@end smallexample
22411
22412
22413@subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
22414@findex -target-file-get
22415
22416@subsubheading Synopsis
22417
22418@smallexample
22419 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
22420@end smallexample
22421
22422Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
22423on the host system.
22424
22425@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22426
22427The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
22428
22429@subsubheading Example
22430
22431@smallexample
22432(gdb)
22433-target-file-get remotefile localfile
22434^done
22435(gdb)
22436@end smallexample
22437
22438
22439@subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
22440@findex -target-file-delete
22441
22442@subsubheading Synopsis
22443
22444@smallexample
22445 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
22446@end smallexample
22447
22448Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
22449
22450@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22451
22452The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
22453
22454@subsubheading Example
22455
22456@smallexample
22457(gdb)
22458-target-file-delete remotefile
22459^done
22460(gdb)
22461@end smallexample
22462
22463
22464@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22465@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
22466@section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
22467
22468@c @subheading -gdb-complete
22469
22470@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
22471@findex -gdb-exit
22472
22473@subsubheading Synopsis
22474
22475@smallexample
22476 -gdb-exit
22477@end smallexample
22478
22479Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
22480
22481@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22482
22483Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
22484
22485@subsubheading Example
22486
22487@smallexample
22488(gdb)
22489-gdb-exit
22490^exit
22491@end smallexample
22492
22493
22494@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
22495@findex -exec-abort
22496
22497@subsubheading Synopsis
22498
22499@smallexample
22500 -exec-abort
22501@end smallexample
22502
22503Kill the inferior running program.
22504
22505@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22506
22507The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
22508
22509@subsubheading Example
22510N.A.
22511
22512
22513@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
22514@findex -gdb-set
22515
22516@subsubheading Synopsis
22517
22518@smallexample
22519 -gdb-set
22520@end smallexample
22521
22522Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
22523@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
22524
22525@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22526
22527The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
22528
22529@subsubheading Example
22530
22531@smallexample
22532(gdb)
22533-gdb-set $foo=3
22534^done
22535(gdb)
22536@end smallexample
22537
22538
22539@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
22540@findex -gdb-show
22541
22542@subsubheading Synopsis
22543
22544@smallexample
22545 -gdb-show
22546@end smallexample
22547
22548Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
22549
22550@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22551
22552The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
22553
22554@subsubheading Example
22555
22556@smallexample
22557(gdb)
22558-gdb-show annotate
22559^done,value="0"
22560(gdb)
22561@end smallexample
22562
22563@c @subheading -gdb-source
22564
22565
22566@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
22567@findex -gdb-version
22568
22569@subsubheading Synopsis
22570
22571@smallexample
22572 -gdb-version
22573@end smallexample
22574
22575Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
22576
22577@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22578
22579The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
22580default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
22581
22582@subsubheading Example
22583
22584@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
22585@c box in TeX.
22586@smallexample
22587(gdb)
22588-gdb-version
22589~GNU gdb 5.2.1
22590~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22591~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
22592~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
22593~ certain conditions.
22594~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22595~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
22596~ details.
22597~This GDB was configured as
22598 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
22599^done
22600(gdb)
22601@end smallexample
22602
22603@subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
22604@findex -list-features
22605
22606Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
22607this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
22608or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
22609important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
22610of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
22611startup.
22612
22613The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
22614available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
22615have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
22616is given below.
22617
22618Example output:
22619
22620@smallexample
22621(gdb) -list-features
22622^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
22623@end smallexample
22624
22625The current list of features is:
22626
22627@table @samp
22628@item frozen-varobjs
22629Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
22630as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
22631of @code{-varobj-create}.
22632@item pending-breakpoints
22633Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
22634@item thread-info
22635Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
22636
22637@end table
22638
22639@subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
22640@findex -list-target-features
22641
22642Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
22643target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
22644unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
22645features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
22646a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
22647@code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
22648may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
22649Example output:
22650
22651@smallexample
22652(gdb) -list-features
22653^done,result=["async"]
22654@end smallexample
22655
22656The current list of features is:
22657
22658@table @samp
22659@item async
22660Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
22661execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
22662while the target is running.
22663
22664@end table
22665
22666
22667@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
22668@findex -interpreter-exec
22669
22670@subheading Synopsis
22671
22672@smallexample
22673-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
22674@end smallexample
22675@anchor{-interpreter-exec}
22676
22677Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
22678
22679@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22680
22681The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
22682
22683@subheading Example
22684
22685@smallexample
22686(gdb)
22687-interpreter-exec console "break main"
22688&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
22689&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
22690~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
22691^done
22692(gdb)
22693@end smallexample
22694
22695@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
22696@findex -inferior-tty-set
22697
22698@subheading Synopsis
22699
22700@smallexample
22701-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22702@end smallexample
22703
22704Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
22705
22706@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22707
22708The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
22709
22710@subheading Example
22711
22712@smallexample
22713(gdb)
22714-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22715^done
22716(gdb)
22717@end smallexample
22718
22719@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
22720@findex -inferior-tty-show
22721
22722@subheading Synopsis
22723
22724@smallexample
22725-inferior-tty-show
22726@end smallexample
22727
22728Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
22729
22730@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22731
22732The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
22733
22734@subheading Example
22735
22736@smallexample
22737(gdb)
22738-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22739^done
22740(gdb)
22741-inferior-tty-show
22742^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
22743(gdb)
22744@end smallexample
22745
22746@subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
22747@findex -enable-timings
22748
22749@subheading Synopsis
22750
22751@smallexample
22752-enable-timings [yes | no]
22753@end smallexample
22754
22755Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
22756command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
22757developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
22758equivalent to @samp{yes}.
22759
22760@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22761
22762No equivalent.
22763
22764@subheading Example
22765
22766@smallexample
22767(gdb)
22768-enable-timings
22769^done
22770(gdb)
22771-break-insert main
22772^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22773addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
22774fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
22775time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
22776(gdb)
22777-enable-timings no
22778^done
22779(gdb)
22780-exec-run
22781^running
22782(gdb)
22783*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
22784frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
22785@{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
22786fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
22787(gdb)
22788@end smallexample
22789
22790@node Annotations
22791@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
22792
22793This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
22794designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
22795similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
22796relatively high level.
22797
22798The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
22799(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
22800
22801@ignore
22802This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
22803@end ignore
22804
22805@menu
22806* Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
22807* Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
22808* Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
22809* Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
22810* Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
22811* Annotations for Running::
22812 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
22813* Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
22814@end menu
22815
22816@node Annotations Overview
22817@section What is an Annotation?
22818@cindex annotations
22819
22820Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
22821characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
22822information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
22823is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
22824information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
22825additional information, and a newline. The additional information
22826cannot contain newline characters.
22827
22828Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
22829characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
22830no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
22831@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
22832annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
22833means those three characters as output.
22834
22835The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
22836@option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
22837how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
22838values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
22839is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
22840subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
22841for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
22842been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
22843Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
22844
22845@table @code
22846@kindex set annotate
22847@item set annotate @var{level}
22848The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
22849annotations to the specified @var{level}.
22850
22851@item show annotate
22852@kindex show annotate
22853Show the current annotation level.
22854@end table
22855
22856This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
22857
22858A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
22859
22860@smallexample
22861$ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
22862GNU gdb 6.0
22863Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22864GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
22865and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
22866under certain conditions.
22867Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22868There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
22869for details.
22870This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
22871
22872^Z^Zpre-prompt
22873(@value{GDBP})
22874^Z^Zprompt
22875@kbd{quit}
22876
22877^Z^Zpost-prompt
22878$
22879@end smallexample
22880
22881Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
22882@value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
22883denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
22884output from @value{GDBN}.
22885
22886@node Server Prefix
22887@section The Server Prefix
22888@cindex server prefix
22889
22890If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
22891the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
22892command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
22893means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
22894a transparent manner.
22895
22896The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22897history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22898use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22899
22900@node Prompting
22901@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
22902
22903@cindex annotations for prompts
22904When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
22905to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
22906over, etc.
22907
22908Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
22909input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
22910denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
22911annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
22912annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
22913associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
22914features the following annotations:
22915
22916@smallexample
22917^Z^Zpre-prompt
22918^Z^Zprompt
22919^Z^Zpost-prompt
22920@end smallexample
22921
22922The input types are
22923
22924@table @code
22925@findex pre-prompt annotation
22926@findex prompt annotation
22927@findex post-prompt annotation
22928@item prompt
22929When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
22930
22931@findex pre-commands annotation
22932@findex commands annotation
22933@findex post-commands annotation
22934@item commands
22935When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
22936command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
22937
22938@findex pre-overload-choice annotation
22939@findex overload-choice annotation
22940@findex post-overload-choice annotation
22941@item overload-choice
22942When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
22943
22944@findex pre-query annotation
22945@findex query annotation
22946@findex post-query annotation
22947@item query
22948When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
22949
22950@findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
22951@findex prompt-for-continue annotation
22952@findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
22953@item prompt-for-continue
22954When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
22955expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
22956prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
22957presence of annotations.
22958@end table
22959
22960@node Errors
22961@section Errors
22962@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
22963
22964@findex quit annotation
22965@smallexample
22966^Z^Zquit
22967@end smallexample
22968
22969This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
22970
22971@findex error annotation
22972@smallexample
22973^Z^Zerror
22974@end smallexample
22975
22976This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
22977
22978Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
22979in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
22980@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
22981cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
22982cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
22983does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
22984to the top level.
22985
22986@findex error-begin annotation
22987A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
22988
22989@smallexample
22990^Z^Zerror-begin
22991@end smallexample
22992
22993Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
22994message.
22995
22996Warning messages are not yet annotated.
22997@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
22998@c range_error(), and possibly other places.
22999
23000@node Invalidation
23001@section Invalidation Notices
23002
23003@cindex annotations for invalidation messages
23004The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
23005changed.
23006
23007@table @code
23008@findex frames-invalid annotation
23009@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
23010
23011The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
23012have changed.
23013
23014@findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
23015@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
23016
23017The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
23018deleted a breakpoint.
23019@end table
23020
23021@node Annotations for Running
23022@section Running the Program
23023@cindex annotations for running programs
23024
23025@findex starting annotation
23026@findex stopping annotation
23027When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
23028@code{step} or @code{continue},
23029
23030@smallexample
23031^Z^Zstarting
23032@end smallexample
23033
23034is output. When the program stops,
23035
23036@smallexample
23037^Z^Zstopped
23038@end smallexample
23039
23040is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
23041annotations describe how the program stopped.
23042
23043@table @code
23044@findex exited annotation
23045@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
23046The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
23047successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
23048
23049@findex signalled annotation
23050@findex signal-name annotation
23051@findex signal-name-end annotation
23052@findex signal-string annotation
23053@findex signal-string-end annotation
23054@item ^Z^Zsignalled
23055The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
23056annotation continues:
23057
23058@smallexample
23059@var{intro-text}
23060^Z^Zsignal-name
23061@var{name}
23062^Z^Zsignal-name-end
23063@var{middle-text}
23064^Z^Zsignal-string
23065@var{string}
23066^Z^Zsignal-string-end
23067@var{end-text}
23068@end smallexample
23069
23070@noindent
23071where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
23072@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
23073as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
23074@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
23075user's benefit and have no particular format.
23076
23077@findex signal annotation
23078@item ^Z^Zsignal
23079The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
23080just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
23081terminated with it.
23082
23083@findex breakpoint annotation
23084@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
23085The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
23086
23087@findex watchpoint annotation
23088@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
23089The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
23090@end table
23091
23092@node Source Annotations
23093@section Displaying Source
23094@cindex annotations for source display
23095
23096@findex source annotation
23097The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
23098
23099@smallexample
23100^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
23101@end smallexample
23102
23103where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
23104file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
23105first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
23106within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
23107debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
23108@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
23109line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
23110@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
23111source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
23112followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
23113depend on the language).
23114
23115@node GDB Bugs
23116@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
23117@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
23118@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
23119
23120Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
23121
23122Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
23123may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
23124the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
23125reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
23126
23127In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
23128information that enables us to fix the bug.
23129
23130@menu
23131* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
23132* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
23133@end menu
23134
23135@node Bug Criteria
23136@section Have You Found a Bug?
23137@cindex bug criteria
23138
23139If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
23140
23141@itemize @bullet
23142@cindex fatal signal
23143@cindex debugger crash
23144@cindex crash of debugger
23145@item
23146If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
23147@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
23148
23149@cindex error on valid input
23150@item
23151If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
23152bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
23153somewhere in the connection to the target.)
23154
23155@cindex invalid input
23156@item
23157If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
23158that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
23159``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
23160for traditional practice''.
23161
23162@item
23163If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
23164for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
23165@end itemize
23166
23167@node Bug Reporting
23168@section How to Report Bugs
23169@cindex bug reports
23170@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
23171
23172A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
23173If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
23174contact that organization first.
23175
23176You can find contact information for many support companies and
23177individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
23178distribution.
23179@c should add a web page ref...
23180
23181@ifset BUGURL
23182@ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
23183In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
23184@value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
23185@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
23186page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
23187be used.
23188
23189@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
23190@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
23191not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
23192@samp{bug-gdb}.
23193
23194The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
23195serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
23196the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
23197newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
23198problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
23199path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
23200we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
23201bug reports to the mailing list.
23202@end ifset
23203@ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
23204In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
23205@value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
23206@end ifclear
23207@end ifset
23208
23209The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
23210@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
23211fact or leave it out, state it!
23212
23213Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
23214problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
23215assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
23216Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
23217stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
23218name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
23219of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
23220the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
23221easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
23222
23223Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
23224bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
23225you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
23226self-contained.
23227
23228Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
23229bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
23230@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
23231bugs properly.
23232
23233To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
23234
23235@itemize @bullet
23236@item
23237The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
23238with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
23239version}.
23240
23241Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
23242the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
23243
23244@item
23245The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
23246version number.
23247
23248@item
23249What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
23250``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
23251
23252@item
23253What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
23254debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
23255C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
23256to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
23257those compilers.
23258
23259@item
23260The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
23261observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
23262you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
23263Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
23264
23265If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
23266and then we might not encounter the bug.
23267
23268@item
23269A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
23270reproduce the bug.
23271
23272@item
23273A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
23274incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
23275
23276Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
23277will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
23278not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
23279a chance to make a mistake.
23280
23281Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
23282say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
23283copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
23284the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
23285crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
23286ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
23287us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
23288to draw any conclusion from our observations.
23289
23290@pindex script
23291@cindex recording a session script
23292To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
23293such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
23294Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
23295include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
23296
23297Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
23298inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
23299
23300@item
23301If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
23302diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
23303it by context, not by line number.
23304
23305The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
23306sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
23307
23308@end itemize
23309
23310Here are some things that are not necessary:
23311
23312@itemize @bullet
23313@item
23314A description of the envelope of the bug.
23315
23316Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
23317which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
23318changes will not affect it.
23319
23320This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
23321will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
23322with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
23323We recommend that you save your time for something else.
23324
23325Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
23326of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
23327output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
23328less time, and so on.
23329
23330However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
23331report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
23332
23333@item
23334A patch for the bug.
23335
23336A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
23337the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
23338a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
23339to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
23340
23341Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
23342construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
23343through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
23344to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
23345
23346And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
23347patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
23348help us to understand.
23349
23350@item
23351A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
23352
23353Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
23354things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
23355@end itemize
23356
23357@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
23358@c and consists of the two following files:
23359@c rluser.texinfo
23360@c inc-hist.texinfo
23361@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
23362@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
23363@include rluser.texi
23364@include inc-hist.texinfo
23365
23366
23367@node Formatting Documentation
23368@appendix Formatting Documentation
23369
23370@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
23371@cindex reference card
23372The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
23373for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
23374subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
23375@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
23376release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
23377you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
23378
23379The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
23380can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
23381
23382@smallexample
23383make refcard.dvi
23384@end smallexample
23385
23386The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
23387mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
23388that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
23389high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
23390your @sc{dvi} output program.
23391
23392@cindex documentation
23393
23394All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
23395distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
23396a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
23397on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
23398formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
23399and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
23400
23401@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
23402version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
23403file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
23404subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
23405necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
23406but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
23407Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
23408@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
23409
23410If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
23411Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
23412@code{makeinfo}.
23413
23414If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
23415@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
23416version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
23417
23418@smallexample
23419cd gdb
23420make gdb.info
23421@end smallexample
23422
23423If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
23424a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
23425Texinfo definitions file.
23426
23427@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
23428produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
23429document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
23430has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
23431command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
23432(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
23433require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
23434
23435@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
23436@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
23437written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
23438typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
23439and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
23440directory.
23441
23442If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
23443typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
23444subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
23445@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
23446
23447@smallexample
23448make gdb.dvi
23449@end smallexample
23450
23451Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
23452
23453@node Installing GDB
23454@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
23455@cindex installation
23456
23457@menu
23458* Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
23459* Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
23460* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
23461* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
23462* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
23463@end menu
23464
23465@node Requirements
23466@section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
23467@cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
23468
23469Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
23470Other packages will be used only if they are found.
23471
23472@heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
23473@table @asis
23474@item ISO C90 compiler
23475@value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
23476working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
23477
23478@end table
23479
23480@heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
23481@table @asis
23482@item Expat
23483@anchor{Expat}
23484@value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
23485included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
23486can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
23487The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
23488standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
23489use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
23490
23491Expat is used for:
23492
23493@itemize @bullet
23494@item
23495Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
23496@item
23497Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
23498@item
23499Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
23500@item
23501MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
23502@end itemize
23503
23504@item zlib
23505@cindex compressed debug sections
23506@value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
23507compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
23508of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
23509is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
23510information in such binaries.
23511
23512The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
23513distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
23514@url{http://zlib.net}.
23515
23516@end table
23517
23518@node Running Configure
23519@section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
23520@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
23521@value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
23522of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
23523build the @code{gdb} program.
23524@iftex
23525@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
23526@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
23527look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
23528installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
23529@end iftex
23530
23531The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
23532@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
23533appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
23534
23535For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
23536@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
23537
23538@table @code
23539@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
23540script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
23541
23542@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
23543the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
23544
23545@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
23546source for the Binary File Descriptor library
23547
23548@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
23549@sc{gnu} include files
23550
23551@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
23552source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
23553
23554@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
23555source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
23556
23557@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
23558source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
23559
23560@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
23561source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
23562
23563@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
23564source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
23565@end table
23566
23567The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
23568from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
23569this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
23570
23571First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
23572if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
23573identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
23574argument.
23575
23576For example:
23577
23578@smallexample
23579cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
23580./configure @var{host}
23581make
23582@end smallexample
23583
23584@noindent
23585where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
23586@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
23587(You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
23588correct value by examining your system.)
23589
23590Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
23591@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
23592libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
23593binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
23594
23595@need 750
23596@file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
23597system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
23598shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
23599
23600@smallexample
23601sh configure @var{host}
23602@end smallexample
23603
23604If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
23605directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
23606@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
23607@file{configure}
23608creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
23609you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
23610
23611You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
23612source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
23613@file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
23614that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
23615if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
23616of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
23617configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
23618directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
23619about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
23620
23621You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
23622However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
23623the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
23624that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
23625let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
23626
23627@node Separate Objdir
23628@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
23629
23630If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
23631you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
23632host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
23633allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
23634rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
23635handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
23636@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
23637program specified there.
23638
23639To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
23640with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
23641(You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
23642itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
23643would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
23644the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
23645
23646For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
23647separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
23648
23649@smallexample
23650@group
23651cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
23652mkdir ../gdb-sun4
23653cd ../gdb-sun4
23654../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
23655make
23656@end group
23657@end smallexample
23658
23659When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
23660directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
23661(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
23662the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
23663directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
23664@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
23665
23666Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
23667instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
23668like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
23669one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
23670build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
23671
23672One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
23673directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
23674@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
23675programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
23676You specify a cross-debugging target by
23677giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
23678
23679When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
23680it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
23681called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
23682
23683The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
23684directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
23685directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
23686directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
23687will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
23688
23689When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
23690directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
23691if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
23692with each other.
23693
23694@node Config Names
23695@section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
23696
23697The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
23698script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
23699aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
23700of information in the following pattern:
23701
23702@smallexample
23703@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
23704@end smallexample
23705
23706For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
23707or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
23708option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
23709
23710The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
23711any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
23712aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
23713@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
23714script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
23715abbreviations---for example:
23716
23717@smallexample
23718% sh config.sub i386-linux
23719i386-pc-linux-gnu
23720% sh config.sub alpha-linux
23721alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
23722% sh config.sub hp9k700
23723hppa1.1-hp-hpux
23724% sh config.sub sun4
23725sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
23726% sh config.sub sun3
23727m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
23728% sh config.sub i986v
23729Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
23730@end smallexample
23731
23732@noindent
23733@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
23734directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
23735
23736@node Configure Options
23737@section @file{configure} Options
23738
23739Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
23740are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
23741several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
23742Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
23743
23744@smallexample
23745configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
23746 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23747 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23748 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
23749 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
23750 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
23751 @var{host}
23752@end smallexample
23753
23754@noindent
23755You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
23756@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
23757@samp{--}.
23758
23759@table @code
23760@item --help
23761Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
23762
23763@item --prefix=@var{dir}
23764Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
23765@file{@var{dir}}.
23766
23767@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
23768Configure the source to install programs under directory
23769@file{@var{dir}}.
23770
23771@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
23772@need 2000
23773@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
23774@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
23775@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
23776Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
23777@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
23778build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
23779directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
23780the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
23781directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
23782the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
23783@var{dirname}.
23784
23785@item --norecursion
23786Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
23787propagate configuration to subdirectories.
23788
23789@item --target=@var{target}
23790Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
23791@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
23792programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
23793
23794There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
23795
23796@item @var{host} @dots{}
23797Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
23798
23799There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
23800@end table
23801
23802There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
23803needed for special purposes only.
23804
23805@node Maintenance Commands
23806@appendix Maintenance Commands
23807@cindex maintenance commands
23808@cindex internal commands
23809
23810In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
23811includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
23812that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
23813provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
23814messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
23815
23816@table @code
23817@kindex maint agent
23818@item maint agent @var{expression}
23819Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
23820This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
23821(@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
23822
23823@kindex maint info breakpoints
23824@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
23825Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
23826breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
23827internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
23828breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
23829is shown:
23830
23831@table @code
23832@item breakpoint
23833Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
23834
23835@item watchpoint
23836Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
23837
23838@item longjmp
23839Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
23840@code{longjmp} calls.
23841
23842@item longjmp resume
23843Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
23844
23845@item until
23846Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
23847
23848@item finish
23849Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
23850
23851@item shlib events
23852Shared library events.
23853
23854@end table
23855
23856@kindex maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23857@kindex maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23858@cindex displaced stepping support
23859@cindex out-of-line single-stepping
23860@item maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23861@itemx maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23862Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
23863if the target supports it. The default is on. Displaced stepping is
23864a way to single-step over breakpoints without removing them from the
23865inferior, by executing an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was
23866originally at the breakpoint location. It is also known as
23867out-of-line single-stepping.
23868
23869@kindex maint check-symtabs
23870@item maint check-symtabs
23871Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
23872
23873@kindex maint cplus first_component
23874@item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
23875Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
23876
23877@kindex maint cplus namespace
23878@item maint cplus namespace
23879Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
23880
23881@kindex maint demangle
23882@item maint demangle @var{name}
23883Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
23884
23885@kindex maint deprecate
23886@kindex maint undeprecate
23887@cindex deprecated commands
23888@item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
23889@itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
23890Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
23891cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
23892argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
23893favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
23894the replacement as part of the warning.
23895
23896@kindex maint dump-me
23897@item maint dump-me
23898@cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
23899Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
23900This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
23901with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
23902
23903@kindex maint internal-error
23904@kindex maint internal-warning
23905@item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23906@itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23907Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
23908or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
23909or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
23910internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
23911either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
23912@value{GDBN} session.
23913
23914These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
23915used as the text of the error or warning message.
23916
23917Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
23918
23919@smallexample
23920(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
23921@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
23922A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
23923debugging may prove unreliable.
23924Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23925Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23926(@value{GDBP})
23927@end smallexample
23928
23929@kindex maint packet
23930@item maint packet @var{text}
23931If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
23932then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
23933displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
23934@samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
23935checksum.
23936
23937@kindex maint print architecture
23938@item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23939Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
23940@var{file} names the file where the output goes.
23941
23942@kindex maint print c-tdesc
23943@item maint print c-tdesc
23944Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
23945a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
23946when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
23947
23948@kindex maint print dummy-frames
23949@item maint print dummy-frames
23950Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
23951
23952@smallexample
23953(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
23954@dots{}
23955(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
23956Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
2395758 return (a + b);
23958The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
23959@dots{}
23960(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
239610x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
23962 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
23963 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
23964(@value{GDBP})
23965@end smallexample
23966
23967Takes an optional file parameter.
23968
23969@kindex maint print registers
23970@kindex maint print raw-registers
23971@kindex maint print cooked-registers
23972@kindex maint print register-groups
23973@item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23974@itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23975@itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23976@itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23977Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
23978
23979The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
23980the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
23981includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
23982@code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
23983register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
23984@value{GDBN} Internals}.
23985
23986These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
23987write the information.
23988
23989@kindex maint print reggroups
23990@item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23991Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
23992optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
23993information.
23994
23995The register groups info looks like this:
23996
23997@smallexample
23998(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
23999 Group Type
24000 general user
24001 float user
24002 all user
24003 vector user
24004 system user
24005 save internal
24006 restore internal
24007@end smallexample
24008
24009@kindex flushregs
24010@item flushregs
24011This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
24012
24013@kindex maint print objfiles
24014@cindex info for known object files
24015@item maint print objfiles
24016Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
24017command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
24018and symtabs.
24019
24020@kindex maint print statistics
24021@cindex bcache statistics
24022@item maint print statistics
24023This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
24024about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
24025statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
24026of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
24027defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
24028the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
24029used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
24030sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
24031average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
24032savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
24033lengths.
24034
24035@kindex maint print target-stack
24036@cindex target stack description
24037@item maint print target-stack
24038A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
24039kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
24040so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
24041In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
24042until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
24043address.
24044
24045This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
24046the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
24047
24048@kindex maint print type
24049@cindex type chain of a data type
24050@item maint print type @var{expr}
24051Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
24052can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
24053that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
24054a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
24055data structures, including its flags and contained types.
24056
24057@kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
24058@kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
24059@item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
24060@itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
24061Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
24062
24063@cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
24064In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
24065produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
24066reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
24067This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
24068cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
24069compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
24070memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
24071slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
24072
24073@kindex maint set profile
24074@kindex maint show profile
24075@cindex profiling GDB
24076@item maint set profile
24077@itemx maint show profile
24078Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
24079
24080Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
24081command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
24082collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
24083exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
24084if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
24085(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
24086data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
24087
24088Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
24089compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
24090
24091@kindex maint set linux-async
24092@kindex maint show linux-async
24093@cindex asynchronous support
24094@item maint set linux-async
24095@itemx maint show linux-async
24096Control the GNU/Linux native asynchronous support
24097(@pxref{Background Execution}) of @value{GDBN}.
24098
24099GNU/Linux native asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
24100the @samp{maint set linux-async} command to enable it.
24101
24102@kindex maint set remote-async
24103@kindex maint show remote-async
24104@cindex asynchronous support
24105@item maint set remote-async
24106@itemx maint show remote-async
24107Control the remote asynchronous support
24108(@pxref{Background Execution}) of @value{GDBN}.
24109
24110Remote asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
24111the @samp{maint set remote-async} command to enable it.
24112
24113@kindex maint show-debug-regs
24114@cindex x86 hardware debug registers
24115@item maint show-debug-regs
24116Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
24117registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
24118enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
24119removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
24120triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
24121
24122@kindex maint space
24123@cindex memory used by commands
24124@item maint space
24125Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
24126nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
24127took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
24128by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
24129switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
24130
24131@kindex maint time
24132@cindex time of command execution
24133@item maint time
24134Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
24135set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
24136took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
24137The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
24138there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
24139by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
24140it's not possibly currently
24141This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
24142@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
24143
24144@kindex maint translate-address
24145@item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
24146Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
24147@var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
24148@value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
24149the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
24150the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
24151command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
24152
24153@end table
24154
24155The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
24156@value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
24157
24158@table @code
24159@item set watchdog @var{nsec}
24160@kindex set watchdog
24161@cindex watchdog timer
24162@cindex timeout for commands
24163Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
24164target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
24165reports and error and the command is aborted.
24166
24167@item show watchdog
24168Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
24169@end table
24170
24171@node Remote Protocol
24172@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
24173
24174@menu
24175* Overview::
24176* Packets::
24177* Stop Reply Packets::
24178* General Query Packets::
24179* Register Packet Format::
24180* Tracepoint Packets::
24181* Host I/O Packets::
24182* Interrupts::
24183* Packet Acknowledgment::
24184* Examples::
24185* File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
24186* Library List Format::
24187* Memory Map Format::
24188@end menu
24189
24190@node Overview
24191@section Overview
24192
24193There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
24194protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
24195machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
24196recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
24197
24198In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
24199transmitted and received data, respectively.
24200
24201@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
24202@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
24203@cindex remote serial protocol
24204All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
24205sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
24206@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
24207@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
24208
24209@smallexample
24210@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
24211@end smallexample
24212@noindent
24213
24214@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
24215@noindent
24216The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
24217characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
24218eight bit unsigned checksum).
24219
24220Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
24221specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
24222
24223@smallexample
24224@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
24225@end smallexample
24226
24227@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
24228@noindent
24229That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
24230has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
24231since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
24232
24233When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
24234response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
24235the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
24236retransmission):
24237
24238@smallexample
24239-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
24240<- @code{+}
24241@end smallexample
24242@noindent
24243
24244The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
24245once a connection is established.
24246@xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
24247
24248The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
24249debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
24250the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
24251when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
24252
24253@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
24254exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
24255exceptions).
24256
24257@cindex remote protocol, field separator
24258Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
24259@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
24260@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
24261
24262Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
24263@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
24264would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
24265
24266@cindex remote protocol, binary data
24267@anchor{Binary Data}
24268Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
24269digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
24270protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
24271Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
24272connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
24273binary data.
24274
24275The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
24276as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
24277character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
24278For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
24279bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
24280@code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
24281@samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
24282must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
24283is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
24284(described next).
24285
24286Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
24287Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
24288instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
24289repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
24290binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
24291@code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
24292produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
24293code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
24294encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
24295@samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
24296after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
242973}} more times.
24298
24299The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
24300greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
24301seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
24302five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
24303@samp{0*"00}.
24304
24305The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
24306error number. That number is not well defined.
24307
24308@cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
24309For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
24310(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
24311protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
24312on that response.
24313
24314A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
24315@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
24316optional.
24317
24318@node Packets
24319@section Packets
24320
24321The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
24322@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
24323@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
24324I/O extension of the remote protocol.
24325
24326Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
24327syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
24328include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
24329part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
24330separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
24331@var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
24332bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
24333@var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
24334@samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
24335@var{baz}.
24336
24337Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
24338letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
24339
24340Here are the packet descriptions.
24341
24342@table @samp
24343
24344@item !
24345@cindex @samp{!} packet
24346@anchor{extended mode}
24347Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
24348persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
24349debugged.
24350
24351Reply:
24352@table @samp
24353@item OK
24354The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
24355@end table
24356
24357@item ?
24358@cindex @samp{?} packet
24359Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
24360step and continue.
24361
24362Reply:
24363@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24364
24365@item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
24366@cindex @samp{A} packet
24367Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
24368specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
24369@var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
24370
24371Reply:
24372@table @samp
24373@item OK
24374The arguments were set.
24375@item E @var{NN}
24376An error occurred.
24377@end table
24378
24379@item b @var{baud}
24380@cindex @samp{b} packet
24381(Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
24382Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
24383
24384JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
24385received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
24386problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
24387
24388Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
24389it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
24390some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
24391switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
24392of view, nothing actually happened.}
24393
24394@item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
24395@cindex @samp{B} packet
24396Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
24397breakpoint at @var{addr}.
24398
24399Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
24400(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
24401
24402@item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
24403@cindex @samp{c} packet
24404Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
24405resume at current address.
24406
24407Reply:
24408@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24409
24410@item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
24411@cindex @samp{C} packet
24412Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
24413@samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
24414
24415Reply:
24416@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24417
24418@item d
24419@cindex @samp{d} packet
24420Toggle debug flag.
24421
24422Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
24423(@pxref{General Query Packets}).
24424
24425@item D
24426@cindex @samp{D} packet
24427Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
24428before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
24429
24430Reply:
24431@table @samp
24432@item OK
24433for success
24434@item E @var{NN}
24435for an error
24436@end table
24437
24438@item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
24439@cindex @samp{F} packet
24440A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
24441This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
24442Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
24443
24444@item g
24445@anchor{read registers packet}
24446@cindex @samp{g} packet
24447Read general registers.
24448
24449Reply:
24450@table @samp
24451@item @var{XX@dots{}}
24452Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
24453with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
24454each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
24455determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
24456@code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
24457specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
24458@item E @var{NN}
24459for an error.
24460@end table
24461
24462@item G @var{XX@dots{}}
24463@cindex @samp{G} packet
24464Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
24465description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
24466
24467Reply:
24468@table @samp
24469@item OK
24470for success
24471@item E @var{NN}
24472for an error
24473@end table
24474
24475@item H @var{c} @var{t}
24476@cindex @samp{H} packet
24477Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
24478@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
24479should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
24480operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
24481the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
24482
24483Reply:
24484@table @samp
24485@item OK
24486for success
24487@item E @var{NN}
24488for an error
24489@end table
24490
24491@c FIXME: JTC:
24492@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
24493@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
24494@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
24495@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
24496@c described. For example:
24497@c
24498@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
24499@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
24500@c otherwise returns current registers.
24501@c
24502@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
24503@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
24504@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
24505
24506@item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
24507@anchor{cycle step packet}
24508@cindex @samp{i} packet
24509Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
24510present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
24511step starting at that address.
24512
24513@item I
24514@cindex @samp{I} packet
24515Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
24516step packet}.
24517
24518@item k
24519@cindex @samp{k} packet
24520Kill request.
24521
24522FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
24523thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
24524thread?)}.
24525
24526@item m @var{addr},@var{length}
24527@cindex @samp{m} packet
24528Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
24529Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
24530
24531The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
24532data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
24533and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
24534use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
24535suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
24536@cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
24537@cindex size of remote memory accesses
24538@cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
24539
24540Reply:
24541@table @samp
24542@item @var{XX@dots{}}
24543Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
24544number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
24545server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
24546@item E @var{NN}
24547@var{NN} is errno
24548@end table
24549
24550@item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24551@cindex @samp{M} packet
24552Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
24553@var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
24554hexadecimal number.
24555
24556Reply:
24557@table @samp
24558@item OK
24559for success
24560@item E @var{NN}
24561for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
24562written).
24563@end table
24564
24565@item p @var{n}
24566@cindex @samp{p} packet
24567Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
24568@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
24569register value is encoded.
24570
24571Reply:
24572@table @samp
24573@item @var{XX@dots{}}
24574the register's value
24575@item E @var{NN}
24576for an error
24577@item
24578Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
24579@end table
24580
24581@item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
24582@anchor{write register packet}
24583@cindex @samp{P} packet
24584Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
24585number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
24586digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
24587
24588Reply:
24589@table @samp
24590@item OK
24591for success
24592@item E @var{NN}
24593for an error
24594@end table
24595
24596@item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
24597@itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
24598@cindex @samp{q} packet
24599@cindex @samp{Q} packet
24600General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
24601described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
24602
24603@item r
24604@cindex @samp{r} packet
24605Reset the entire system.
24606
24607Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
24608
24609@item R @var{XX}
24610@cindex @samp{R} packet
24611Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
24612This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24613
24614The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
24615
24616@item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
24617@cindex @samp{s} packet
24618Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
24619@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
24620
24621Reply:
24622@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24623
24624@item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
24625@anchor{step with signal packet}
24626@cindex @samp{S} packet
24627Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
24628requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
24629
24630Reply:
24631@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24632
24633@item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
24634@cindex @samp{t} packet
24635Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
24636@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
24637@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
24638
24639@item T @var{XX}
24640@cindex @samp{T} packet
24641Find out if the thread XX is alive.
24642
24643Reply:
24644@table @samp
24645@item OK
24646thread is still alive
24647@item E @var{NN}
24648thread is dead
24649@end table
24650
24651@item v
24652Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
24653up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
24654
24655@item vAttach;@var{pid}
24656@cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
24657Attach to a new process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
24658hexadecimal integer identifying the process. The attached process is
24659stopped.
24660
24661This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24662
24663Reply:
24664@table @samp
24665@item E @var{nn}
24666for an error
24667@item @r{Any stop packet}
24668for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24669@end table
24670
24671@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
24672@cindex @samp{vCont} packet
24673Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
24674If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
24675threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
24676specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
24677default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
24678Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
24679
24680@table @samp
24681@item c
24682Continue.
24683@item C @var{sig}
24684Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
24685@item s
24686Step.
24687@item S @var{sig}
24688Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
24689@end table
24690
24691The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
24692not supported in @samp{vCont}.
24693
24694Reply:
24695@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24696
24697@item vCont?
24698@cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
24699Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
24700
24701Reply:
24702@table @samp
24703@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
24704The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
24705command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
24706@item
24707The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
24708@end table
24709
24710@item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
24711@cindex @samp{vFile} packet
24712Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
24713see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
24714
24715@item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
24716@cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
24717Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
24718@var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
24719its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
24720flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
24721Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
24722together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
24723stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24724packet is received.
24725
24726Reply:
24727@table @samp
24728@item OK
24729for success
24730@item E @var{NN}
24731for an error
24732@end table
24733
24734@item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24735@cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
24736Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
24737is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
24738packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
24739@samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
24740not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
24741(although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
24742have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
24743@samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
24744neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
24745target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
24746
24747
24748Reply:
24749@table @samp
24750@item OK
24751for success
24752@item E.memtype
24753for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
24754@item E @var{NN}
24755for an error
24756@end table
24757
24758@item vFlashDone
24759@cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
24760Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
24761The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
24762@samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
24763@samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
24764regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24765request is completed.
24766
24767@item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
24768@cindex @samp{vRun} packet
24769Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
24770command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
24771@var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
24772(e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
24773state.
24774
24775This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24776
24777Reply:
24778@table @samp
24779@item E @var{nn}
24780for an error
24781@item @r{Any stop packet}
24782for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24783@end table
24784
24785@item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24786@anchor{X packet}
24787@cindex @samp{X} packet
24788Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
24789@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
24790@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
24791
24792Reply:
24793@table @samp
24794@item OK
24795for success
24796@item E @var{NN}
24797for an error
24798@end table
24799
24800@item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24801@itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24802@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
24803@cindex @samp{z} packet
24804@cindex @samp{Z} packets
24805Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
24806watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
24807@var{length} bytes.
24808
24809Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
24810separately.
24811
24812@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
24813for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
24814remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
24815@samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
24816avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
24817be implemented in an idempotent way.}
24818
24819@item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24820@itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
24821@cindex @samp{z0} packet
24822@cindex @samp{Z0} packet
24823Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
24824@var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24825
24826A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
24827@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
24828@var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
24829breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
24830@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
24831
24832@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
24833code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
24834overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
24835target, is not defined.}
24836
24837Reply:
24838@table @samp
24839@item OK
24840success
24841@item
24842not supported
24843@item E @var{NN}
24844for an error
24845@end table
24846
24847@item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24848@itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
24849@cindex @samp{z1} packet
24850@cindex @samp{Z1} packet
24851Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
24852address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
24853
24854A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
24855dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
24856
24857@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
24858movement.}
24859
24860Reply:
24861@table @samp
24862@item OK
24863success
24864@item
24865not supported
24866@item E @var{NN}
24867for an error
24868@end table
24869
24870@item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24871@itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
24872@cindex @samp{z2} packet
24873@cindex @samp{Z2} packet
24874Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
24875
24876Reply:
24877@table @samp
24878@item OK
24879success
24880@item
24881not supported
24882@item E @var{NN}
24883for an error
24884@end table
24885
24886@item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24887@itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
24888@cindex @samp{z3} packet
24889@cindex @samp{Z3} packet
24890Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
24891
24892Reply:
24893@table @samp
24894@item OK
24895success
24896@item
24897not supported
24898@item E @var{NN}
24899for an error
24900@end table
24901
24902@item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24903@itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
24904@cindex @samp{z4} packet
24905@cindex @samp{Z4} packet
24906Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
24907
24908Reply:
24909@table @samp
24910@item OK
24911success
24912@item
24913not supported
24914@item E @var{NN}
24915for an error
24916@end table
24917
24918@end table
24919
24920@node Stop Reply Packets
24921@section Stop Reply Packets
24922@cindex stop reply packets
24923
24924The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
24925receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
24926@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
24927when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
24928number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
24929@value{GDBN} source code.
24930
24931As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
24932reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
24933syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
24934components.
24935
24936@table @samp
24937
24938@item S @var{AA}
24939The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24940number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
24941@var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
24942
24943@item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
24944@cindex @samp{T} packet reply
24945The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24946number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
24947@samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
24948and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
24949round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
24950this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
24951
24952@itemize @bullet
24953@item
24954If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
24955corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
24956series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
24957two-digit hex number.
24958
24959@item
24960If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
24961hex.
24962
24963@item
24964If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
24965specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
24966reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
24967signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
24968
24969@item
24970Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
24971and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
24972future.
24973@end itemize
24974
24975The currently defined stop reasons are:
24976
24977@table @samp
24978@item watch
24979@itemx rwatch
24980@itemx awatch
24981The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
24982hex.
24983
24984@cindex shared library events, remote reply
24985@item library
24986The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
24987@value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
24988list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
24989@end table
24990
24991@item W @var{AA}
24992The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
24993applicable to certain targets.
24994
24995@item X @var{AA}
24996The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
24997
24998@item O @var{XX}@dots{}
24999@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
25000written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
25001while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
25002for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
25003
25004@item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
25005@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
25006be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
25007correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
25008@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
25009system calls.
25010
25011@samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
25012this very system call.
25013
25014The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
25015call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
25016with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
25017reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
25018or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
25019Protocol Extension}, for more details.
25020
25021@end table
25022
25023@node General Query Packets
25024@section General Query Packets
25025@cindex remote query requests
25026
25027Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
25028packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
25029query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
25030sending information to and from the stub.
25031
25032The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
25033indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
25034@value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
25035definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
25036conventions:
25037
25038@itemize @bullet
25039@item
25040The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
25041@item
25042Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
25043letter.
25044@item
25045The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
25046lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
25047the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
25048foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
25049@end itemize
25050
25051The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
25052parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
25053separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
25054full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
25055in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
25056with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
25057packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
25058for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
25059are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
25060existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
25061packet.}.
25062
25063Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
25064has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
25065explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
25066templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
25067@value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
25068
25069Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
25070
25071@table @samp
25072
25073@item qC
25074@cindex current thread, remote request
25075@cindex @samp{qC} packet
25076Return the current thread id.
25077
25078Reply:
25079@table @samp
25080@item QC @var{pid}
25081Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
25082@item @r{(anything else)}
25083Any other reply implies the old pid.
25084@end table
25085
25086@item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
25087@cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
25088@cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
25089Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
25090Reply:
25091@table @samp
25092@item E @var{NN}
25093An error (such as memory fault)
25094@item C @var{crc32}
25095The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
25096@end table
25097
25098@item qfThreadInfo
25099@itemx qsThreadInfo
25100@cindex list active threads, remote request
25101@cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
25102@cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
25103Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
25104may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
25105works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
25106obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
25107be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
25108sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
25109
25110NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
25111
25112Reply:
25113@table @samp
25114@item m @var{id}
25115A single thread id
25116@item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
25117a comma-separated list of thread ids
25118@item l
25119(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
25120@end table
25121
25122In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
25123more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
25124@value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
25125ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
25126with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
25127
25128@item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
25129@cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
25130@cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
25131Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
25132by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
25133
25134@var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
25135thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
25136
25137@var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
25138thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
25139information associated with the variable.)
25140
25141@var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
25142the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
25143a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
25144object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
25145Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
25146differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
25147
25148Reply:
25149@table @samp
25150@item @var{XX}@dots{}
25151Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
25152local storage requested.
25153
25154@item E @var{nn}
25155An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
25156
25157@item
25158An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
25159@end table
25160
25161@item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
25162Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
25163digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
25164subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
25165number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
25166(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
25167returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
25168
25169Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
25170
25171Reply:
25172@table @samp
25173@item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
25174Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
25175returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
25176and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
25177digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
25178is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
25179digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
25180@end table
25181
25182@item qOffsets
25183@cindex section offsets, remote request
25184@cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
25185Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
25186image.
25187
25188Reply:
25189@table @samp
25190@item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
25191Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
25192Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
25193If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
25194@samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
25195segments by the supplied offsets.
25196
25197@emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
25198@value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
25199to the @code{Bss} section.}
25200
25201@item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
25202Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
25203contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
25204@samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
25205conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
25206@var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
25207does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
25208as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
25209kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
25210@end table
25211
25212@item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
25213@cindex thread information, remote request
25214@cindex @samp{qP} packet
25215Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
25216encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
25217
25218Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
25219(see below).
25220
25221Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
25222
25223@item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
25224@cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
25225@cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
25226@anchor{QPassSignals}
25227Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
25228Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
25229(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
25230strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
25231the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
25232reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
25233combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
25234new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
25235@var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
25236
25237Reply:
25238@table @samp
25239@item OK
25240The request succeeded.
25241
25242@item E @var{nn}
25243An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
25244
25245@item
25246An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
25247the stub.
25248@end table
25249
25250Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
25251command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
25252This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25253by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25254
25255@item qRcmd,@var{command}
25256@cindex execute remote command, remote request
25257@cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
25258@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
25259execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
25260string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
25261with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
25262packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
25263stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
25264
25265Reply:
25266@table @samp
25267@item OK
25268A command response with no output.
25269@item @var{OUTPUT}
25270A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
25271@item E @var{NN}
25272Indicate a badly formed request.
25273@item
25274An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
25275@end table
25276
25277(Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
25278command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
25279conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
25280packets.)
25281
25282@item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
25283@cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
25284@cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
25285@anchor{qSearch memory}
25286Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
25287@var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
25288@var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
25289
25290Reply:
25291@table @samp
25292@item 0
25293The pattern was not found.
25294@item 1,address
25295The pattern was found at @var{address}.
25296@item E @var{NN}
25297A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
25298@item
25299An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
25300@end table
25301
25302@item QStartNoAckMode
25303@cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
25304@anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
25305Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
25306protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
25307
25308Reply:
25309@table @samp
25310@item OK
25311The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
25312@value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
25313but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
25314@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
25315@item
25316An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
25317@end table
25318
25319@item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
25320@cindex supported packets, remote query
25321@cindex features of the remote protocol
25322@cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
25323@anchor{qSupported}
25324Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
25325query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
25326@value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
25327features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
25328at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
25329packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
25330high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
25331be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
25332stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
25333automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
25334reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
25335unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
25336helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
25337versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
25338
25339Reply:
25340@table @samp
25341@item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
25342The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
25343depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
25344possible forms).
25345@item
25346An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
25347or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
25348@end table
25349
25350The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
25351@samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
25352are:
25353
25354@table @samp
25355@item @var{name}=@var{value}
25356The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
25357with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
25358on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
25359@item @var{name}+
25360The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
25361need an associated value.
25362@item @var{name}-
25363The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
25364@item @var{name}?
25365The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
25366@value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
25367needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
25368but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
25369@end table
25370
25371Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
25372supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
25373request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
25374state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
25375a different version of @value{GDBN}.
25376
25377No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
25378are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
25379@var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
25380packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
25381versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
25382for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
25383advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
25384improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
25385responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
25386the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
25387of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
25388describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
25389all the features it supports.
25390
25391Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
25392responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
25393
25394Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
25395should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
25396require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
25397form response.
25398
25399Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
25400@samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
25401in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
25402stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
25403
25404Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
25405mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
25406architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
25407about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
25408stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
25409
25410These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
25411
25412@multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
25413@c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
25414@c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
25415@item Feature Name
25416@tab Value Required
25417@tab Default
25418@tab Probe Allowed
25419
25420@item @samp{PacketSize}
25421@tab Yes
25422@tab @samp{-}
25423@tab No
25424
25425@item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
25426@tab No
25427@tab @samp{-}
25428@tab Yes
25429
25430@item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
25431@tab No
25432@tab @samp{-}
25433@tab Yes
25434
25435@item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
25436@tab No
25437@tab @samp{-}
25438@tab Yes
25439
25440@item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25441@tab No
25442@tab @samp{-}
25443@tab Yes
25444
25445@item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
25446@tab No
25447@tab @samp{-}
25448@tab Yes
25449
25450@item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
25451@tab No
25452@tab @samp{-}
25453@tab Yes
25454
25455@item @samp{QPassSignals}
25456@tab No
25457@tab @samp{-}
25458@tab Yes
25459
25460@item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
25461@tab No
25462@tab @samp{-}
25463@tab Yes
25464
25465@end multitable
25466
25467These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
25468
25469@table @samp
25470@cindex packet size, remote protocol
25471@item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
25472The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
25473length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
25474transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
25475data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
25476There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
25477stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
25478byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
25479@value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
25480
25481@item qXfer:auxv:read
25482The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
25483(@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
25484
25485@item qXfer:features:read
25486The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
25487(@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
25488
25489@item qXfer:libraries:read
25490The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
25491(@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
25492
25493@item qXfer:memory-map:read
25494The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
25495(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
25496
25497@item qXfer:spu:read
25498The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
25499(@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
25500
25501@item qXfer:spu:write
25502The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
25503(@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
25504
25505@item QPassSignals
25506The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
25507(@pxref{QPassSignals}).
25508
25509@item QStartNoAckMode
25510The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
25511prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
25512
25513@end table
25514
25515@item qSymbol::
25516@cindex symbol lookup, remote request
25517@cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
25518Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
25519requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
25520
25521Reply:
25522@table @samp
25523@item OK
25524The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
25525@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
25526The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
25527@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
25528@samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
25529below.
25530@end table
25531
25532@item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
25533Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
25534
25535@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
25536target has previously requested.
25537
25538@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
25539@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
25540will be empty.
25541
25542Reply:
25543@table @samp
25544@item OK
25545The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
25546@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
25547The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
25548encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
25549(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
25550@end table
25551
25552@item QTDP
25553@itemx QTFrame
25554@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
25555
25556@item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
25557@cindex thread attributes info, remote request
25558@cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
25559Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
25560the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
25561string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
25562for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
25563displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
25564examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
25565@samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
25566
25567Reply:
25568@table @samp
25569@item @var{XX}@dots{}
25570Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
25571comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
25572the thread's attributes.
25573@end table
25574
25575(Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
25576the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
25577conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
25578packets.)
25579
25580@item QTStart
25581@itemx QTStop
25582@itemx QTinit
25583@itemx QTro
25584@itemx qTStatus
25585@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
25586
25587@item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25588@cindex read special object, remote request
25589@cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
25590@anchor{qXfer read}
25591Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
25592identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
25593starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
25594encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
25595additional details about what data to access.
25596
25597Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
25598@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
25599formats, listed below.
25600
25601@table @samp
25602@item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
25603@anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
25604Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
25605auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
25606
25607This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25608by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25609
25610@item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25611@anchor{qXfer target description read}
25612Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
25613annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
25614always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
25615
25616This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25617by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25618
25619@item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25620@anchor{qXfer library list read}
25621Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
25622The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
25623(@pxref{qXfer read}).
25624
25625Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
25626not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
25627the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
25628
25629This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25630by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25631
25632@item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
25633@anchor{qXfer memory map read}
25634Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
25635annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
25636(@pxref{qXfer read}).
25637
25638This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25639by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25640
25641@item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25642@anchor{qXfer spu read}
25643Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
25644annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
25645@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
25646in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
25647in that context to be accessed.
25648
25649This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25650by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25651@end table
25652
25653Reply:
25654@table @samp
25655@item m @var{data}
25656Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
25657target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
25658it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
25659block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
25660@var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
25661request.
25662
25663@item l @var{data}
25664Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
25665There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
25666than the @var{length} in the request.
25667
25668@item l
25669The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
25670There is no more data to be read.
25671
25672@item E00
25673The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
25674
25675@item E @var{nn}
25676The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
25677@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
25678
25679@item
25680An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
25681the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
25682@end table
25683
25684@item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
25685@cindex write data into object, remote request
25686Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
25687identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
25688into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
25689(@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
25690is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
25691to access.
25692
25693Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
25694@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
25695formats, listed below.
25696
25697@table @samp
25698@item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
25699@anchor{qXfer spu write}
25700Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
25701annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
25702@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
25703in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
25704in that context to be accessed.
25705
25706This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25707by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25708@end table
25709
25710Reply:
25711@table @samp
25712@item @var{nn}
25713@var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
25714This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
25715
25716@item E00
25717The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
25718
25719@item E @var{nn}
25720The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
25721@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
25722
25723@item
25724An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
25725recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
25726@end table
25727
25728@item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
25729Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
25730not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
25731@var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
25732must respond with an empty packet.
25733
25734@end table
25735
25736@node Register Packet Format
25737@section Register Packet Format
25738
25739The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
25740In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
25741sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
25742to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
25743byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
25744most-significant - least-significant.
25745
25746@table @r
25747
25748@item MIPS32
25749
25750All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
2575132 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
25752registers; fsr; fir; fp.
25753
25754@item MIPS64
25755
25756All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
25757thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
25758as @code{MIPS32}.
25759
25760@end table
25761
25762@node Tracepoint Packets
25763@section Tracepoint Packets
25764@cindex tracepoint packets
25765@cindex packets, tracepoint
25766
25767Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
25768tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
25769
25770@table @samp
25771
25772@item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
25773Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
25774is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
25775the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
25776count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
25777present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
25778tracepoint's actions.
25779
25780Replies:
25781@table @samp
25782@item OK
25783The packet was understood and carried out.
25784@item
25785The packet was not recognized.
25786@end table
25787
25788@item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
25789Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
25790@var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
25791this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
25792another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
25793trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
25794specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
25795
25796In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
25797can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
25798is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
25799actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
25800taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
25801@samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
25802tracepoint actions.
25803
25804The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
25805actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
25806following forms:
25807
25808@table @samp
25809
25810@item R @var{mask}
25811Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
25812a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
25813@var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
25814zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
25815not fit in a 32-bit word.
25816
25817@item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
25818Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
25819number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
25820@samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
25821address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
25822@var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
25823values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
25824
25825@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
25826Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
25827it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
25828@ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
25829two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
25830in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
25831packet).
25832
25833@end table
25834
25835Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
25836packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
25837length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
25838action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
25839actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
25840must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
25841``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
25842separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
25843
25844Replies:
25845@table @samp
25846@item OK
25847The packet was understood and carried out.
25848@item
25849The packet was not recognized.
25850@end table
25851
25852@item QTFrame:@var{n}
25853Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
25854register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
25855request packets from @value{GDBN}.
25856
25857A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
25858requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
25859without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
25860one of the following forms:
25861
25862@table @samp
25863@item F @var{f}
25864The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
25865@var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
25866was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
25867
25868@item T @var{t}
25869The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
25870@var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
25871
25872@end table
25873
25874@item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
25875Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25876currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
25877@var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
25878
25879@item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
25880Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25881currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
25882is a hexadecimal number.
25883
25884@item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
25885Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
25886currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
25887and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
25888numbers.
25889
25890@item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
25891Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
25892frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
25893
25894@item QTStart
25895Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
25896hits in the trace frame buffer.
25897
25898@item QTStop
25899End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
25900
25901@item QTinit
25902Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
25903
25904@item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
25905Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
25906will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
25907if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
25908
25909@value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
25910containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
25911still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
25912there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
25913
25914@item qTStatus
25915Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
25916
25917Replies:
25918@table @samp
25919@item T0
25920There is no trace experiment running.
25921@item T1
25922There is a trace experiment running.
25923@end table
25924
25925@end table
25926
25927
25928@node Host I/O Packets
25929@section Host I/O Packets
25930@cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
25931@cindex file transfer, remote protocol
25932
25933The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
25934operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
25935used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
25936filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
25937layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
25938Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
25939protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
25940Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
25941target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
25942Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
25943
25944The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
25945its arguments. They have this format:
25946
25947@table @samp
25948
25949@item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
25950@var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
25951should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
25952for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
25953the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
25954numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
25955used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
25956hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
25957buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
25958
25959@end table
25960
25961The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
25962
25963@table @samp
25964
25965@item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
25966@var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
25967non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
25968@var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
25969value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
25970operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
25971binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
25972normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
25973documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
25974@var{attachment}.
25975
25976@item
25977An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
25978
25979@end table
25980
25981These are the supported Host I/O operations:
25982
25983@table @samp
25984@item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
25985Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
25986return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
25987@var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
25988(@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
25989of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
25990@xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
25991
25992@item vFile:close: @var{fd}
25993Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
25994-1 if an error occurs.
25995
25996@item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
25997Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
25998@var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
25999relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
26000common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
26001condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
26002returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
26003@var{count} was zero.
26004
26005The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
26006If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
26007attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
26008number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
26009some characters were escaped.
26010
26011@item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
26012Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
26013to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
26014file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
26015separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
26016packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
26017which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
26018error occurred.
26019
26020@item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
26021Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
26022or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
26023
26024@end table
26025
26026@node Interrupts
26027@section Interrupts
26028@cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
26029
26030When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
26031attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
26032control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
26033setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
26034
26035The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
26036mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
26037not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
26038interfaces.
26039
26040@samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
26041transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
26042@code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
26043the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
26044transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
26045and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
26046(@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
26047@code{0x03} as part of its packet.
26048
26049Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
26050precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
26051implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
26052running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
26053Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
26054of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
26055program is stopped will be discarded.
26056
26057@node Packet Acknowledgment
26058@section Packet Acknowledgment
26059
26060@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
26061@cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
26062By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
26063the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
26064the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
26065This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
26066unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
26067
26068In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
26069TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
26070It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
26071overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
26072@samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
26073
26074When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
26075expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
26076and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
26077@ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
26078
26079If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
26080no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
26081by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
26082@pxref{qSupported}.
26083If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
26084disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
26085(@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
26086@value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
26087Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
26088@value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
26089response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
26090
26091Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
26092between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
26093it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
26094connection.
26095Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
26096new connection is established,
26097there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
26098for the current connection, once disabled.
26099
26100
26101@node Examples
26102@section Examples
26103
26104Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
26105does not get any direct output:
26106
26107@smallexample
26108-> @code{R00}
26109<- @code{+}
26110@emph{target restarts}
26111-> @code{?}
26112<- @code{+}
26113<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
26114-> @code{+}
26115@end smallexample
26116
26117Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
26118
26119@smallexample
26120-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
26121<- @code{+}
26122-> @code{s}
26123<- @code{+}
26124@emph{time passes}
26125<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
26126-> @code{+}
26127-> @code{g}
26128<- @code{+}
26129<- @code{1455@dots{}}
26130-> @code{+}
26131@end smallexample
26132
26133@node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
26134@section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
26135@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
26136
26137@menu
26138* File-I/O Overview::
26139* Protocol Basics::
26140* The F Request Packet::
26141* The F Reply Packet::
26142* The Ctrl-C Message::
26143* Console I/O::
26144* List of Supported Calls::
26145* Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
26146* Constants::
26147* File-I/O Examples::
26148@end menu
26149
26150@node File-I/O Overview
26151@subsection File-I/O Overview
26152@cindex file-i/o overview
26153
26154The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
26155target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
26156system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
26157remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
26158actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
26159This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
26160
26161The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
26162It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
26163@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
26164translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
26165protocol representations when data is transmitted.
26166
26167The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
26168@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
26169or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
26170the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
26171memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
26172the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
26173(@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
26174
26175The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
26176the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
26177after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
26178previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
26179request from @value{GDBN} is required.
26180
26181@smallexample
26182(@value{GDBP}) continue
26183 <- target requests 'system call X'
26184 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
26185 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
26186 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
26187 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
26188@end smallexample
26189
26190The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
26191the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
26192named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
26193system are not supported by this protocol.
26194
26195@node Protocol Basics
26196@subsection Protocol Basics
26197@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
26198
26199The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
26200as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
26201@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
26202the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
26203of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
26204This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
26205to call the appropriate host system call:
26206
26207@itemize @bullet
26208@item
26209A unique identifier for the requested system call.
26210
26211@item
26212All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
26213in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
26214pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
26215Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
26216
26217@end itemize
26218
26219At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
26220
26221@itemize @bullet
26222@item
26223If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
26224system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
26225standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
26226expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
26227packet.
26228
26229@item
26230@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
26231representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
26232
26233@item
26234@value{GDBN} calls the system call.
26235
26236@item
26237It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
26238
26239@item
26240If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
26241by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
26242target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
26243by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
26244packet.
26245
26246@end itemize
26247
26248Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
26249necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
26250
26251@itemize @bullet
26252@item
26253Return value.
26254
26255@item
26256@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
26257
26258@item
26259``Ctrl-C'' flag.
26260
26261@end itemize
26262
26263After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
26264the latest continue or step action.
26265
26266@node The F Request Packet
26267@subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
26268@cindex file-i/o request packet
26269@cindex @code{F} request packet
26270
26271The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
26272
26273@table @samp
26274@item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
26275
26276@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
26277This is just the name of the function.
26278
26279@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
26280Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
26281of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
26282datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
26283of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
26284comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
26285string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
26286
26287@end table
26288
26289
26290
26291@node The F Reply Packet
26292@subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
26293@cindex file-i/o reply packet
26294@cindex @code{F} reply packet
26295
26296The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
26297
26298@table @samp
26299
26300@item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
26301
26302@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
26303
26304@var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
26305representation.
26306This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
26307
26308@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
26309case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
26310The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
26311
26312@smallexample
26313F0,0,C
26314@end smallexample
26315
26316@noindent
26317or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
26318
26319@smallexample
26320F-1,4,C
26321@end smallexample
26322
26323@noindent
26324assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
26325
26326@end table
26327
26328
26329@node The Ctrl-C Message
26330@subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
26331@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
26332
26333If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
26334reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
26335the target should behave as if it had
26336gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
26337interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
26338(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
26339packet.
26340
26341It's important for the target to know in which
26342state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
26343
26344@itemize @bullet
26345@item
26346The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
26347
26348@item
26349The system call on the host has been finished.
26350
26351@end itemize
26352
26353These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
26354returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
26355call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
26356on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
26357system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
26358as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
26359
26360@value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
26361yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
26362@code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
26363before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
26364@value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
26365The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
26366or the full action has been completed.
26367
26368@node Console I/O
26369@subsection Console I/O
26370@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
26371
26372By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
26373descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
26374on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
26375(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
26376by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
263770 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
26378conditions is met:
26379
26380@itemize @bullet
26381@item
26382The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
26383@code{read}
26384system call is treated as finished.
26385
26386@item
26387The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
26388newline.
26389
26390@item
26391The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
26392character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
26393
26394@end itemize
26395
26396If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
26397the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
26398either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
26399is stopped at the user's request.
26400
26401
26402@node List of Supported Calls
26403@subsection List of Supported Calls
26404@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
26405
26406@menu
26407* open::
26408* close::
26409* read::
26410* write::
26411* lseek::
26412* rename::
26413* unlink::
26414* stat/fstat::
26415* gettimeofday::
26416* isatty::
26417* system::
26418@end menu
26419
26420@node open
26421@unnumberedsubsubsec open
26422@cindex open, file-i/o system call
26423
26424@table @asis
26425@item Synopsis:
26426@smallexample
26427int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
26428int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
26429@end smallexample
26430
26431@item Request:
26432@samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
26433
26434@noindent
26435@var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
26436
26437@table @code
26438@item O_CREAT
26439If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
26440rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
26441are concerned.
26442
26443@item O_EXCL
26444When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
26445an error and open() fails.
26446
26447@item O_TRUNC
26448If the file already exists and the open mode allows
26449writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
26450truncated to zero length.
26451
26452@item O_APPEND
26453The file is opened in append mode.
26454
26455@item O_RDONLY
26456The file is opened for reading only.
26457
26458@item O_WRONLY
26459The file is opened for writing only.
26460
26461@item O_RDWR
26462The file is opened for reading and writing.
26463@end table
26464
26465@noindent
26466Other bits are silently ignored.
26467
26468
26469@noindent
26470@var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
26471
26472@table @code
26473@item S_IRUSR
26474User has read permission.
26475
26476@item S_IWUSR
26477User has write permission.
26478
26479@item S_IRGRP
26480Group has read permission.
26481
26482@item S_IWGRP
26483Group has write permission.
26484
26485@item S_IROTH
26486Others have read permission.
26487
26488@item S_IWOTH
26489Others have write permission.
26490@end table
26491
26492@noindent
26493Other bits are silently ignored.
26494
26495
26496@item Return value:
26497@code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
26498occurred.
26499
26500@item Errors:
26501
26502@table @code
26503@item EEXIST
26504@var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
26505
26506@item EISDIR
26507@var{pathname} refers to a directory.
26508
26509@item EACCES
26510The requested access is not allowed.
26511
26512@item ENAMETOOLONG
26513@var{pathname} was too long.
26514
26515@item ENOENT
26516A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
26517
26518@item ENODEV
26519@var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
26520
26521@item EROFS
26522@var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
26523write access was requested.
26524
26525@item EFAULT
26526@var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
26527
26528@item ENOSPC
26529No space on device to create the file.
26530
26531@item EMFILE
26532The process already has the maximum number of files open.
26533
26534@item ENFILE
26535The limit on the total number of files open on the system
26536has been reached.
26537
26538@item EINTR
26539The call was interrupted by the user.
26540@end table
26541
26542@end table
26543
26544@node close
26545@unnumberedsubsubsec close
26546@cindex close, file-i/o system call
26547
26548@table @asis
26549@item Synopsis:
26550@smallexample
26551int close(int fd);
26552@end smallexample
26553
26554@item Request:
26555@samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
26556
26557@item Return value:
26558@code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
26559
26560@item Errors:
26561
26562@table @code
26563@item EBADF
26564@var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
26565
26566@item EINTR
26567The call was interrupted by the user.
26568@end table
26569
26570@end table
26571
26572@node read
26573@unnumberedsubsubsec read
26574@cindex read, file-i/o system call
26575
26576@table @asis
26577@item Synopsis:
26578@smallexample
26579int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
26580@end smallexample
26581
26582@item Request:
26583@samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
26584
26585@item Return value:
26586On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
26587Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
26588returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
26589
26590@item Errors:
26591
26592@table @code
26593@item EBADF
26594@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
26595reading.
26596
26597@item EFAULT
26598@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26599
26600@item EINTR
26601The call was interrupted by the user.
26602@end table
26603
26604@end table
26605
26606@node write
26607@unnumberedsubsubsec write
26608@cindex write, file-i/o system call
26609
26610@table @asis
26611@item Synopsis:
26612@smallexample
26613int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
26614@end smallexample
26615
26616@item Request:
26617@samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
26618
26619@item Return value:
26620On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
26621Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
26622is returned.
26623
26624@item Errors:
26625
26626@table @code
26627@item EBADF
26628@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
26629writing.
26630
26631@item EFAULT
26632@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26633
26634@item EFBIG
26635An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
26636host-specific maximum file size allowed.
26637
26638@item ENOSPC
26639No space on device to write the data.
26640
26641@item EINTR
26642The call was interrupted by the user.
26643@end table
26644
26645@end table
26646
26647@node lseek
26648@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
26649@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
26650
26651@table @asis
26652@item Synopsis:
26653@smallexample
26654long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
26655@end smallexample
26656
26657@item Request:
26658@samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
26659
26660@var{flag} is one of:
26661
26662@table @code
26663@item SEEK_SET
26664The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
26665
26666@item SEEK_CUR
26667The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
26668bytes.
26669
26670@item SEEK_END
26671The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
26672bytes.
26673@end table
26674
26675@item Return value:
26676On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
26677the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
26678value of -1 is returned.
26679
26680@item Errors:
26681
26682@table @code
26683@item EBADF
26684@var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
26685
26686@item ESPIPE
26687@var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
26688
26689@item EINVAL
26690@var{flag} is not a proper value.
26691
26692@item EINTR
26693The call was interrupted by the user.
26694@end table
26695
26696@end table
26697
26698@node rename
26699@unnumberedsubsubsec rename
26700@cindex rename, file-i/o system call
26701
26702@table @asis
26703@item Synopsis:
26704@smallexample
26705int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
26706@end smallexample
26707
26708@item Request:
26709@samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
26710
26711@item Return value:
26712On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26713
26714@item Errors:
26715
26716@table @code
26717@item EISDIR
26718@var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
26719directory.
26720
26721@item EEXIST
26722@var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
26723
26724@item EBUSY
26725@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
26726process.
26727
26728@item EINVAL
26729An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
26730of itself.
26731
26732@item ENOTDIR
26733A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
26734path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
26735and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
26736
26737@item EFAULT
26738@var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
26739
26740@item EACCES
26741No access to the file or the path of the file.
26742
26743@item ENAMETOOLONG
26744
26745@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
26746
26747@item ENOENT
26748A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
26749
26750@item EROFS
26751The file is on a read-only filesystem.
26752
26753@item ENOSPC
26754The device containing the file has no room for the new
26755directory entry.
26756
26757@item EINTR
26758The call was interrupted by the user.
26759@end table
26760
26761@end table
26762
26763@node unlink
26764@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
26765@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
26766
26767@table @asis
26768@item Synopsis:
26769@smallexample
26770int unlink(const char *pathname);
26771@end smallexample
26772
26773@item Request:
26774@samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
26775
26776@item Return value:
26777On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26778
26779@item Errors:
26780
26781@table @code
26782@item EACCES
26783No access to the file or the path of the file.
26784
26785@item EPERM
26786The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
26787
26788@item EBUSY
26789The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
26790being used by another process.
26791
26792@item EFAULT
26793@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26794
26795@item ENAMETOOLONG
26796@var{pathname} was too long.
26797
26798@item ENOENT
26799A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
26800
26801@item ENOTDIR
26802A component of the path is not a directory.
26803
26804@item EROFS
26805The file is on a read-only filesystem.
26806
26807@item EINTR
26808The call was interrupted by the user.
26809@end table
26810
26811@end table
26812
26813@node stat/fstat
26814@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
26815@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
26816@cindex stat, file-i/o system call
26817
26818@table @asis
26819@item Synopsis:
26820@smallexample
26821int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
26822int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
26823@end smallexample
26824
26825@item Request:
26826@samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
26827@samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
26828
26829@item Return value:
26830On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26831
26832@item Errors:
26833
26834@table @code
26835@item EBADF
26836@var{fd} is not a valid open file.
26837
26838@item ENOENT
26839A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
26840path is an empty string.
26841
26842@item ENOTDIR
26843A component of the path is not a directory.
26844
26845@item EFAULT
26846@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26847
26848@item EACCES
26849No access to the file or the path of the file.
26850
26851@item ENAMETOOLONG
26852@var{pathname} was too long.
26853
26854@item EINTR
26855The call was interrupted by the user.
26856@end table
26857
26858@end table
26859
26860@node gettimeofday
26861@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
26862@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
26863
26864@table @asis
26865@item Synopsis:
26866@smallexample
26867int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
26868@end smallexample
26869
26870@item Request:
26871@samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
26872
26873@item Return value:
26874On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
26875
26876@item Errors:
26877
26878@table @code
26879@item EINVAL
26880@var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
26881
26882@item EFAULT
26883@var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26884@end table
26885
26886@end table
26887
26888@node isatty
26889@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
26890@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
26891
26892@table @asis
26893@item Synopsis:
26894@smallexample
26895int isatty(int fd);
26896@end smallexample
26897
26898@item Request:
26899@samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
26900
26901@item Return value:
26902Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
26903
26904@item Errors:
26905
26906@table @code
26907@item EINTR
26908The call was interrupted by the user.
26909@end table
26910
26911@end table
26912
26913Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
269141 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
26915to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
26916would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
26917needed.
26918
26919
26920@node system
26921@unnumberedsubsubsec system
26922@cindex system, file-i/o system call
26923
26924@table @asis
26925@item Synopsis:
26926@smallexample
26927int system(const char *command);
26928@end smallexample
26929
26930@item Request:
26931@samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
26932
26933@item Return value:
26934If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
26935available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
26936For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
26937return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
26938command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
26939return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
26940@file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
26941
26942@item Errors:
26943
26944@table @code
26945@item EINTR
26946The call was interrupted by the user.
26947@end table
26948
26949@end table
26950
26951@value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
26952to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
26953the host is simplified before it's returned
26954to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
26955is discarded, and the return value consists
26956entirely of the exit status of the called command.
26957
26958Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
26959by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
26960@code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
26961
26962@table @code
26963@item set remote system-call-allowed
26964@kindex set remote system-call-allowed
26965Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
26966protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
26967
26968@item show remote system-call-allowed
26969@kindex show remote system-call-allowed
26970Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
26971protocol.
26972@end table
26973
26974@node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26975@subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
26976@cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26977
26978@menu
26979* Integral Datatypes::
26980* Pointer Values::
26981* Memory Transfer::
26982* struct stat::
26983* struct timeval::
26984@end menu
26985
26986@node Integral Datatypes
26987@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
26988@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
26989
26990The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
26991@code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
26992@code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
26993
26994@code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
26995implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
26996
26997@code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
26998
26999@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
27000in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
27001
27002@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
27003
27004All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
27005structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
27006byte order.
27007
27008@node Pointer Values
27009@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
27010@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
27011
27012Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
27013is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
27014transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
27015are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
27016
27017@smallexample
27018@code{1aaf/12}
27019@end smallexample
27020
27021@noindent
27022which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
27023The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
27024the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
27025at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
27026
27027@smallexample
27028@code{123456/d}
27029@end smallexample
27030
27031@node Memory Transfer
27032@unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
27033@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
27034
27035Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
27036example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
27037with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
27038this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
27039packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
27040it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
27041data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
27042
27043
27044@node struct stat
27045@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
27046@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
27047
27048The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
27049is defined as follows:
27050
27051@smallexample
27052struct stat @{
27053 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
27054 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
27055 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
27056 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
27057 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
27058 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
27059 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
27060 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
27061 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
27062 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
27063 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
27064 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
27065 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
27066@};
27067@end smallexample
27068
27069The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
27070appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
27071structure is of size 64 bytes.
27072
27073The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
27074range of values.
27075
27076@table @code
27077
27078@item st_dev
27079A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
27080
27081@item st_ino
27082No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
27083
27084@item st_mode
27085Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
27086bits have currently no meaning for the target.
27087
27088@item st_uid
27089@itemx st_gid
27090@itemx st_rdev
27091No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
27092
27093@item st_atime
27094@itemx st_mtime
27095@itemx st_ctime
27096These values have a host and file system dependent
27097accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
27098support exact timing values.
27099@end table
27100
27101The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
27102responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
27103continuing.
27104
27105Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
27106representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
27107get truncated on the target.
27108
27109@node struct timeval
27110@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
27111@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
27112
27113The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
27114is defined as follows:
27115
27116@smallexample
27117struct timeval @{
27118 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
27119 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
27120@};
27121@end smallexample
27122
27123The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
27124appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
27125structure is of size 8 bytes.
27126
27127@node Constants
27128@subsection Constants
27129@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
27130
27131The following values are used for the constants inside of the
27132protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
27133values before and after the call as needed.
27134
27135@menu
27136* Open Flags::
27137* mode_t Values::
27138* Errno Values::
27139* Lseek Flags::
27140* Limits::
27141@end menu
27142
27143@node Open Flags
27144@unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
27145@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
27146
27147All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
27148
27149@smallexample
27150 O_RDONLY 0x0
27151 O_WRONLY 0x1
27152 O_RDWR 0x2
27153 O_APPEND 0x8
27154 O_CREAT 0x200
27155 O_TRUNC 0x400
27156 O_EXCL 0x800
27157@end smallexample
27158
27159@node mode_t Values
27160@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
27161@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
27162
27163All values are given in octal representation.
27164
27165@smallexample
27166 S_IFREG 0100000
27167 S_IFDIR 040000
27168 S_IRUSR 0400
27169 S_IWUSR 0200
27170 S_IXUSR 0100
27171 S_IRGRP 040
27172 S_IWGRP 020
27173 S_IXGRP 010
27174 S_IROTH 04
27175 S_IWOTH 02
27176 S_IXOTH 01
27177@end smallexample
27178
27179@node Errno Values
27180@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
27181@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
27182
27183All values are given in decimal representation.
27184
27185@smallexample
27186 EPERM 1
27187 ENOENT 2
27188 EINTR 4
27189 EBADF 9
27190 EACCES 13
27191 EFAULT 14
27192 EBUSY 16
27193 EEXIST 17
27194 ENODEV 19
27195 ENOTDIR 20
27196 EISDIR 21
27197 EINVAL 22
27198 ENFILE 23
27199 EMFILE 24
27200 EFBIG 27
27201 ENOSPC 28
27202 ESPIPE 29
27203 EROFS 30
27204 ENAMETOOLONG 91
27205 EUNKNOWN 9999
27206@end smallexample
27207
27208 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
27209 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
27210
27211@node Lseek Flags
27212@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
27213@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
27214
27215@smallexample
27216 SEEK_SET 0
27217 SEEK_CUR 1
27218 SEEK_END 2
27219@end smallexample
27220
27221@node Limits
27222@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
27223@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
27224
27225All values are given in decimal representation.
27226
27227@smallexample
27228 INT_MIN -2147483648
27229 INT_MAX 2147483647
27230 UINT_MAX 4294967295
27231 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
27232 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
27233 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
27234@end smallexample
27235
27236@node File-I/O Examples
27237@subsection File-I/O Examples
27238@cindex file-i/o examples
27239
27240Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
27241address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
27242
27243@smallexample
27244<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
27245@emph{request memory read from target}
27246-> @code{m1234,6}
27247<- XXXXXX
27248@emph{return "6 bytes written"}
27249-> @code{F6}
27250@end smallexample
27251
27252Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
27253address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
27254
27255@smallexample
27256<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
27257@emph{request memory write to target}
27258-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
27259@emph{return "6 bytes read"}
27260-> @code{F6}
27261@end smallexample
27262
27263Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
27264file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
27265
27266@smallexample
27267<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
27268-> @code{F-1,9}
27269@end smallexample
27270
27271Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
27272host is called:
27273
27274@smallexample
27275<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
27276-> @code{F-1,4,C}
27277<- @code{T02}
27278@end smallexample
27279
27280Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
27281host is called:
27282
27283@smallexample
27284<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
27285-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
27286<- @code{T02}
27287@end smallexample
27288
27289@node Library List Format
27290@section Library List Format
27291@cindex library list format, remote protocol
27292
27293On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
27294same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
27295@value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
27296operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
27297platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
27298@value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
27299through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
27300packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
27301queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
27302are loaded.
27303
27304The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
27305lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
27306associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
27307which report where the library was loaded in memory.
27308
27309For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
27310library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
27311dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
27312should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
27313section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
27314depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
27315
27316@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
27317library lists. @xref{Expat}.
27318
27319A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
27320offset, looks like this:
27321
27322@smallexample
27323<library-list>
27324 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
27325 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
27326 </library>
27327</library-list>
27328@end smallexample
27329
27330Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
27331allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
27332
27333@smallexample
27334<library-list>
27335 <library name="sharedlib.o">
27336 <section address="0x10000000"/>
27337 <section address="0x20000000"/>
27338 <section address="0x30000000"/>
27339 </library>
27340</library-list>
27341@end smallexample
27342
27343The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
27344
27345@smallexample
27346<!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
27347<!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
27348<!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
27349<!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
27350<!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
27351<!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
27352<!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
27353<!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
27354<!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
27355@end smallexample
27356
27357In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
27358single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
27359section for each library.
27360
27361@node Memory Map Format
27362@section Memory Map Format
27363@cindex memory map format
27364
27365To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
27366memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
27367memory map.
27368
27369The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
27370(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
27371lists memory regions.
27372
27373@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
27374memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
27375
27376The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
27377
27378@smallexample
27379<?xml version="1.0"?>
27380<!DOCTYPE memory-map
27381 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
27382 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
27383<memory-map>
27384 region...
27385</memory-map>
27386@end smallexample
27387
27388Each region can be either:
27389
27390@itemize
27391
27392@item
27393A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
27394bytes from there:
27395
27396@smallexample
27397<memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
27398@end smallexample
27399
27400
27401@item
27402A region of read-only memory:
27403
27404@smallexample
27405<memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
27406@end smallexample
27407
27408
27409@item
27410A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
27411bytes in length:
27412
27413@smallexample
27414<memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
27415 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
27416</memory>
27417@end smallexample
27418
27419@end itemize
27420
27421Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
27422by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
27423packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
27424
27425The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
27426
27427@smallexample
27428<!-- ................................................... -->
27429<!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
27430<!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
27431<!-- .................................... .............. -->
27432<!-- memory-map.dtd -->
27433<!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
27434<!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
27435<!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
27436<!ELEMENT memory (property)>
27437<!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
27438 and its type, or device. -->
27439<!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
27440 start CDATA #REQUIRED
27441 length CDATA #REQUIRED
27442 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
27443<!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
27444<!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
27445<!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
27446@end smallexample
27447
27448@include agentexpr.texi
27449
27450@node Target Descriptions
27451@appendix Target Descriptions
27452@cindex target descriptions
27453
27454@strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
27455and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
27456The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
27457
27458One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
27459is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
27460architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
27461a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
27462and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
27463architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
27464vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
27465
27466@itemize @bullet
27467@item
27468With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
27469the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
27470@item
27471Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
27472audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
27473variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
27474@item
27475When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
27476at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
27477@command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
27478@end itemize
27479
27480To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
27481target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
27482actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
27483processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
27484descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
27485
27486@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
27487target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
27488
27489@menu
27490* Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
27491* Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
27492* Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
27493 descriptions.
27494* Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
27495@end menu
27496
27497@node Retrieving Descriptions
27498@section Retrieving Descriptions
27499
27500Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
27501specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
27502description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
27503protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
27504qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
27505@samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
27506XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
27507Format}.
27508
27509Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
27510If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
27511specify a file are:
27512
27513@table @code
27514@cindex set tdesc filename
27515@item set tdesc filename @var{path}
27516Read the target description from @var{path}.
27517
27518@cindex unset tdesc filename
27519@item unset tdesc filename
27520Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
27521will use the description supplied by the current target.
27522
27523@cindex show tdesc filename
27524@item show tdesc filename
27525Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
27526@end table
27527
27528
27529@node Target Description Format
27530@section Target Description Format
27531@cindex target descriptions, XML format
27532
27533A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
27534document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
27535the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
27536means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
27537check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
27538However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
27539their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
27540
27541Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
27542and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
27543sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
27544target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
27545
27546Here is a simple target description:
27547
27548@smallexample
27549<target version="1.0">
27550 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
27551</target>
27552@end smallexample
27553
27554@noindent
27555This minimal description only says that the target uses
27556the x86-64 architecture.
27557
27558A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
27559optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
27560are explained further below.
27561
27562@smallexample
27563<?xml version="1.0"?>
27564<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
27565<target version="1.0">
27566 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
27567 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
27568</target>
27569@end smallexample
27570
27571@noindent
27572The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
27573breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
27574declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
27575(@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
27576useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
27577@samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
27578including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
27579revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
27580the version mismatch.
27581
27582@subsection Inclusion
27583@cindex target descriptions, inclusion
27584@cindex XInclude
27585@ifnotinfo
27586@cindex <xi:include>
27587@end ifnotinfo
27588
27589It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
27590several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
27591share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
27592divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
27593the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
27594
27595@smallexample
27596<xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
27597@end smallexample
27598
27599@noindent
27600When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
27601the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
27602the contents of that document. If the current description was read
27603using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
27604@var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
27605current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
27606@var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
27607original description.
27608
27609@subsection Architecture
27610@cindex <architecture>
27611
27612An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
27613
27614@smallexample
27615 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
27616@end smallexample
27617
27618@var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
27619accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
27620Debugging Target}).
27621
27622@subsection Features
27623@cindex <feature>
27624
27625Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
27626system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
27627registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
27628has this form:
27629
27630@smallexample
27631<feature name="@var{name}">
27632 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
27633 @var{reg}@dots{}
27634</feature>
27635@end smallexample
27636
27637@noindent
27638Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
27639of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
27640knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
27641should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
27642
27643@subsection Types
27644
27645Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
27646interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
27647but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
27648Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
27649Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
27650
27651Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
27652a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
27653Types must be defined before they are used.
27654
27655@cindex <vector>
27656Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
27657of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
27658specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
27659@var{count}:
27660
27661@smallexample
27662<vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
27663@end smallexample
27664
27665@cindex <union>
27666If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
27667with a union type containing the useful representations. The
27668@samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
27669each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
27670
27671@smallexample
27672<union id="@var{id}">
27673 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
27674 @dots{}
27675</union>
27676@end smallexample
27677
27678@subsection Registers
27679@cindex <reg>
27680
27681Each register is represented as an element with this form:
27682
27683@smallexample
27684<reg name="@var{name}"
27685 bitsize="@var{size}"
27686 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
27687 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
27688 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
27689 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
27690@end smallexample
27691
27692@noindent
27693The components are as follows:
27694
27695@table @var
27696
27697@item name
27698The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
27699
27700@item bitsize
27701The register's size, in bits.
27702
27703@item regnum
27704The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
27705than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
27706a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
27707defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
27708the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
27709packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
27710in order of increasing register number.
27711
27712@item save-restore
27713Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
27714calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
27715@code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
27716some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
27717ABI.
27718
27719@item type
27720The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
27721defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
27722and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
27723for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
27724architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
27725@var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
27726
27727@item group
27728The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
27729be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
27730@var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
27731in @code{info registers}.
27732
27733@end table
27734
27735@node Predefined Target Types
27736@section Predefined Target Types
27737@cindex target descriptions, predefined types
27738
27739Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
27740from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
27741standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
27742types. The currently supported types are:
27743
27744@table @code
27745
27746@item int8
27747@itemx int16
27748@itemx int32
27749@itemx int64
27750@itemx int128
27751Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
27752
27753@item uint8
27754@itemx uint16
27755@itemx uint32
27756@itemx uint64
27757@itemx uint128
27758Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
27759
27760@item code_ptr
27761@itemx data_ptr
27762Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
27763any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
27764pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
27765address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
27766may be marked as data pointers.
27767
27768@item ieee_single
27769Single precision IEEE floating point.
27770
27771@item ieee_double
27772Double precision IEEE floating point.
27773
27774@item arm_fpa_ext
27775The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
27776
27777@end table
27778
27779@node Standard Target Features
27780@section Standard Target Features
27781@cindex target descriptions, standard features
27782
27783A target description must contain either no registers or all the
27784target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
27785@value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
27786the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
27787default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
27788described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
27789can recognize them.
27790
27791This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
27792which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
27793with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
27794if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
27795feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
27796description. You can add additional registers to any of the
27797standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
27798they were added to an unrecognized feature.
27799
27800This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
27801Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
27802@value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
27803
27804Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
27805company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
27806architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
27807containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
27808
27809The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
27810of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
27811registers using the capitalization used in the description.
27812
27813@menu
27814* ARM Features::
27815* MIPS Features::
27816* M68K Features::
27817* PowerPC Features::
27818@end menu
27819
27820
27821@node ARM Features
27822@subsection ARM Features
27823@cindex target descriptions, ARM features
27824
27825The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
27826It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
27827@samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
27828
27829The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
27830should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
27831
27832The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
27833it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
27834@samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
27835@samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
27836
27837@node MIPS Features
27838@subsection MIPS Features
27839@cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
27840
27841The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
27842It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
27843@samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
27844on the target.
27845
27846The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
27847contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
27848registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27849
27850The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
27851it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
27852contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
27853@samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27854
27855The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
27856contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
27857Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
27858
27859@node M68K Features
27860@subsection M68K Features
27861@cindex target descriptions, M68K features
27862
27863@table @code
27864@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
27865@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
27866@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
27867One of those features must be always present.
27868The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
27869used. The feature that is present should contain registers
27870@samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
27871@samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
27872
27873@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
27874This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
27875@samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
27876@samp{fpiaddr}.
27877@end table
27878
27879@node PowerPC Features
27880@subsection PowerPC Features
27881@cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
27882
27883The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
27884targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
27885@samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
27886@samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
27887
27888The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
27889contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
27890
27891The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
27892contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
27893and @samp{vrsave}.
27894
27895The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
27896contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
27897will combine these registers with the floating point registers
27898(@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
27899through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
27900through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
27901
27902The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
27903contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
27904@samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
27905@samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
27906@samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
27907these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
27908user.
27909
27910@include gpl.texi
27911
27912@raisesections
27913@include fdl.texi
27914@lowersections
27915
27916@node Index
27917@unnumbered Index
27918
27919@printindex cp
27920
27921@tex
27922% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
27923% meantime:
27924\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
27925\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
27926\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
27927\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
27928\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
27929\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
27930\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
27931\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
27932\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
27933\page\colophon
27934% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
27935@end tex
27936
27937@bye
This page took 0.135404 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.